naac – self study report (ssr)

220
L.J INSTITUTE OF MANAGEMENT STUDIES AHMEDABAD Self Study Report (SSR) -

Upload: lamhuong

Post on 31-Dec-2016

278 views

Category:

Documents


0 download

TRANSCRIPT

Page 1: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

L.J INSTITUTE OF MANAGEMENT STUDIES

AHMEDABAD

Self Study Report (SSR)

-

Page 2: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Self-Study Report (SSR)

SUBMITTED TO

NATIONAL ASSESSMENT AND ACCREDITATION

COUNCIL

SUBMITTED BY:

L.J INSTITUTE OF MANAGEMENT STUDIES,

SARKHEJ-GANDHINAGAR HIGHWAY,

AHMEDABAD, GUJARAT

Page 3: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

CONTENTS

CONTENTS PAGE No.

Preface

Declaration by the Director

Compliance Report

Executive Summary and SWOC Analysis

1. Profile of the Institute

2. Criteria – Wise Inputs

Criterion 1: Curricular Aspects

Criterion 2: Teaching-Learning and Evaluation

Criterion 3: Research, Consultancy and Extension

Criterion 4: Infrastructure and Learning Resources

Criterion 5: Student Support and Progression

Criterion 6: Governance Leadership and Management

Criterion 7: Innovations and Best Practices

3. Evaluative Reports of the Departments

Page 4: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

PREFACE

Page 5: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

PREFACE

L.J Institute of Management Studies (LJIMS), a part of the L.J Group of Institutes, is

promoted and managed by Lok Jagruti Kendra, a charitable Trust and a Registered

Society founded by eminent educationists and professionals who envisioned it as “a

key player in education and social development by promoting and nurturing

creativity, scholarship, innovation and excellence through a chain of quality

institutes.”

With its role defined in this context, LJIMS was established in 2001. The institute

soon put in place its “Quality Policy” followed it by developing several systems and

processes towards achieving quality in varied activities, and trying to meet the

expectations of all stakeholders.

At LJIMS, we have been evolving internal mechanisms for monitoring and review

over the past years. In the light we undertook the exercise of preparing the Self Study

Report (SSR). The entire faculty and the non-teaching staff have actively

participated and contributed to the SSR, for whom it was it was great challenge as

well as a learning opportunity. After necessary discussions with the Trustees and

office bearers of the Governing Body, a Steering Committee of senior faculty

members was constituted. Then, criterion-wise seven Task Forces were constituted.

Each task force had one member of the Steering Committee as Coordinator and other

faculties as members. Keeping the NAAC guidelines in mind each Task Force

collected relevant information and documents, held internal discussions and prepared

the respective write-ups of the allocated criterion. Criterion-wise drafts were

reviewed at two levels: by the Chairman and Coordinator of the Steering Committee,

and finally by the Director. The drafts were resubmitted after necessary revisions.

The resubmitted drafts were reviewed and the SSR was finalized by the Steering

Committee after due briefing to the Governing Body.

The whole process has been extremely rewarding experience both for the institute

and the individuals involved in the preparation of the SSR. I take this opportunity to

compliment all members of the teaching as well as non-teaching staff for the

dedication and commitment shown by them in preparing the SSR. I also appreciate

the efforts of the Steering Committee who have tirelessly worked by editing,

correcting, facilitating Task Forces and accomplishing the completion of the first

stage of the accreditation process. I also thank the Trustees of Lok Jagruti Kendra for

encouraging, guiding and supporting throughout the process.

(P.K Mehta)

Director

Page 6: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

DECLARATION

BY THE

DIRECTOR

Page 7: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Compliance

Report

Page 8: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Executive

Summary and

SWOC

Analysis

Page 9: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

EXECUTIVE SUMMARY

The forces of globalization have influenced professional institutes in undertaking quality

assurance initiatives to compete internationally. Creating opportunities and systems for

exploitation of talents of students and providing access to quality education to these talented

students of socially, economically and geographically disadvantaged sections has been the

primary objectives of the institute. These objectives further lead to national development in

general and skills development of students in particular. The institute has always strived to

develop as a Centre of Excellence and the quest for this Excellence started when institute

decided to obtain accreditation from NAAC. A Steering Committee comprising of senior

faculty members was established in July 2014 in view of the accreditation process. The

institute further constituted self-managed task forces for preparation of Self Study Report

(SSR). The preparation of the SSR was a collective effort wherein all the faculties were

involved. Each task force was given a specific criteria and the coordinator of the task force

was a member from the Steering Committee. While developing the SSR the Steering

Committee primarily focused on identification of the strengths and weaknesses in the

teaching-learning and other processes as carried out by the institution.

ABOUT THE INSTITUTE:

L.J Institute of Management Studies (LJIMS) was established in the year 2001 under the

aegis of Lok Jagruti Kendra trust as an AICTE approved prost graduate centre of Gujarat

University imparting a two year full time MBA program. Lok Jagruti Kendra has a rich and

glorious history of nurturing educational institutes. LJK has achieved excellence in education

largely due to the efforts of its visionary founders like Prof. B.M Peerzada. Padma Vibushana

Lord Meghnad Desai, Prof. Gautam Appa, Laate Prof. M.S. Trivedi and renowed jurish Shri

Girish B. Patel and Shri Subodh Shah.

Spread across a sprawling 560000 sq yard campus, LJIMS has lush green surroundings, neat

internal access roads and the vivacious hunt of knowledge by the young aspirants which

provides the perfect academic ambience.

The Self Study Report consists of following criteria giving details of the core functions and

activities of the institute pertaining to curricular aspects, teaching-learning, research,

community development and holistic development of the students:

1. CURRICULAR ASPECTS

LJIMS intends to generate educational excellence in management education and create

dynamic managerial leaders for the society which is clearly indicated in its vision and

mission mentioned below.

Vision: LJIMS will be a key player in management education and corporate development by

promoting creativity, scholarship, innovation and excellence.

Page 10: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Mission: LJIMS will endeavor to create dynamic professionals equipped with conceptual

clarity, practical knowledge, effective soft skills, self confidence, innovativeness and ethical

concern.

At the institute, the academic curriculum is implemented in a manner that ensures proper

student learning. The faculty chooses the subject as per teaching interest and prepares an

academic plan where teaching objectives, detailed syllabus, session required, teaching

pedagogy and reading material is specified. In order to ensure correct implementation of the

teaching plan, an academic review process (ARP) is carried out after to audit the actual

implementation. The Institute organizes faculty development programs and corporate

interactions in order to generate innovative teaching practices. The faculty also participates in

syllabus development at university level. The faculty members developed a new assessment

scheme for the MBA program which was implemented at Gujarat Technological University.

The Institute has developed several novel and innovative initiatives like Marketing

Excellence Series (MAX), Financial Excellence Series (FINEX), Human Resource

Excellence Series (HRX), CRADLE (Capability Recognition and Development Lessons in

Entrepreneurship) in the areas of marketing, finance, human resource management and

entrepreneurship where the focus is on developing skills among students. The Institute had

initiated several innovative measures like Prashikshan(The Immersion Program), Vikalpa

(The case study forum), Vimarsh(The Debate forum), Reincarnation (The Role Play),

Mindstein (The Quiz Competition), Parivartan (The Extension Activity), Kshitij (The Wall

Magazine), Envisage (The Poster Making Competition) and XCEL (The Movie Club). All

these activities are focused on providing learning and holistic developmental activities to the

students. The Institute also has a strong feedback mechanism where feedback is taken from

different stakeholders like students, employers, parents and alumni on issues like summer

internship, final placement, teaching and infrastructure.

2. TEACHING –LEARNING AND EVALUATION

The Institute has a rigorous teaching, learning and evaluation process. Candidates who have

appeared in Common Management Admission Test (CMAT) secure admission through a

committee called “Admission Committee for Professional Courses (ACPC)”. The Institute

has been sanctioned 180 seats in the first shift and 120 seats in the second shift. For the

purpose of admission to the first year, 75% of the total sanctioned seats are open seats, while

the rest 25 % are in the management quota.

The Institute works extensively on the student to ensure proper understanding of student

requirement. The student’s profile is collected as a part of the reporting procedure at the Institute. An intake analysis is done to study the composition of the students in terms of their

basic field of graduation, additional qualification, achievements, work experience etc. This

helps to identify if there is any need for Bridge/remedial courses to enable them to cope with

the MBA programme. As a part of the Induction Programme for the fresh entrants to the

MBA programme, the first phase of Executive Personality Development Programme (EPDP)

is conducted. The program is targeted at recognizing student’s true potential by identifying their strength and weaknesses. The students are evaluated on the basis of following criteria-

Page 11: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

analytical skills, presentation skills, communication skills (Both verbal and non-verbal),

techniques of facing interviews and group discussions.

The Institute works extensively for student placement. A need assessment is done for the

students and once the need is being correctly identified, various programmes like Placement

Assistance Program are designed to impart knowledge and improve their presentation and

communication skills. Placement Assistance Programme is specifically aimed at updating

students with current trends of industry by providing in-depth knowledge of conduct and

techniques necessary to crack Group Discussions and different types of Interviews. This

programme includes activities like- CV Writing, Techniques for Group Discussion,

Techniques to crack a Personal Interview, Mock GD’s and PI’s and Interaction with Industry Experts. Another program called Student Ability Mapping Interviews is also conducted

where interviews are conducted for all the students by faculty members and external experts

before their summer internship programme and final placement. The entire interview of each

student is captured as a video and is used to give the student feedback regarding his/her

performance. The weak points and improvement areas in terms of communication, attitude,

knowledge, etiquettes and body language are shared with the student in order to make

corrective improvements.

The importance of soft skills is stressed amongst the students throughout the year. During the

first week of every odd semester, faculties engage in lectures for assessing student as a part of

EPDP Programme. Different activities like aptitude test, prose-writing test, mock interviews,

micro presentation, group discussions, and team building exercises are conducted to assess

their aptitude, communications skills, areas of interest and also weak areas. Further, extra

sessions are conducted by the specially engaged full-time soft skill trainer for developing the

communication skills among students, their strengths and weaknesses are identified

appropriate remedial steps are taken.

The institute is having a Student Mentorship Programme in order to enhance student

academic performance. The mechanism comprises of a senior faculty who acts as the Section

Head for each class. The Section Heads meet the students of respective sections twice a week

to discuss academic and other related issues. Every fifteen days individual subject faculty

reports the student academic performance and attendance to the respective Section Heads.

Further, the Section Heads discuss each individual case with the Dean and Director to take

appropriate actions. Mentoring of the students is done by the Section Heads and the Dean.

For slow learners, additional sessions are arranged.

Besides the regular class-room teaching methods like delivering lectures, power point

presentations, case studies, group discussions and role plays, the faculties also adopt

innovative teaching approaches like peer learning, live projects and live case studies and take

students for educational trips to various industries to give them a real time exposure to

different areas of management. Faculty members use a range of innovative teaching

techniques as mentioned below: Opinionated Case Study, Self Positioning Statement, Live

Research Projects, Cue cards, Theater Workshop, Flash cards, Peer Learning, Film Review,

Live stock market trading, Scrap Book on an International Theme, weekly news sharing and

Movie Analysis.

Page 12: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

The Institute has a rich library containing over 20000 books, 35 magazines 69

journals and 659 CDs & DVDs. All these resources are effectively used by the faculties as

well as students for the teaching and learning process. To ensure the right kind of academic

processes, regular interactions take place between the Director and faculties, wherein the

Director spends considerable time in mentoring the newly appointed faculties and motivating

them to undertake research and involve in continuous improvement. A full-fledged Faculty

Mentorship Programme is in place, wherein the newly appointed faculties are allocated

domain specific senior professor as Mentors for a minimum period of two years. The

objective is to make the new faculties comfortable in the work set-up and aid them in

delivering lectures in a better manner by suggesting appropriate pedagogical tools and

materials. This scheme includes academic guidance, development of materials and delivery

strategies, learning new tools and methods and also gives a scope for collaborative research.

At the end of the term, the mentors are required to submit a report regarding the progress of

the mentee to the Director. Systemic feedback is obtained from both Mentors and Mentees in

prescribed formats.

The institution provides dedicated computer systems with latest configuration and un-

interrupted internet access. One computer lab out of the five labs is dedicated to internet

access by students to enumerate research activities involving computer systems. In order to

make the environment more conducive, Wi-Fi connectivity is provided. The students get

access to computing and internet facility through a computer lab which houses many

computers.The faculty is fully equipped to handle all kinds of multi-media aids like OHP,

LCD projectors, multi-media systems. Faculties are also duly trained to use advanced

packages like SPSS for individual research and also in classes. Faculty members are very

active in research and actively participate in seminars and conferences. Almost all faculty

members engage in research and present papers in different conferences.

3. RESEARCH, CONSULTANCY AND EXTENSION

The Institute has a research committee to monitor and address the issues of research, and also

to encourage research culture among faculty members and students. The Institute has started

an initiative named VIKALPA wherein faculty members along with a group of fifteen

students are encouraged to visit different companies and write case studies on the same. In

order to promote case writing skills, special workshops for the faculty members are

conducted and experts are invited to mentor the faculty members in case writing. The trust

has started working on its own annual research journal wherein faculties have been invited to

publish their research papers. The faculty is encouraged to attend conferences and seminars

for paper presentation and duty leaves are granted to them for the same. The faculty is also

paid one side 3 Tier AC fare for travelling. The institute has also purchased the licensed

version of SYSTAT with life time validity to facilitate statistical analysis for research. The

institution has a rich collection of the student reports with over 1000 Comprehensive Project

reports and over 1500 Summer Internship Programme reports on different areas of Finance,

Marketing, Human Resource and Information Technology. Over 170 Global Country Study

reports on different sectors are also available in the library.

LJIMS believes that the research output of the institute is a major criterion for growth and

sustainability in the future. The institute faculty collectively has published over 90 papers in

national and international peer reviewed journals, presented over 80 papers in national and

Page 13: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

international conferences, participated in 30 FDPs, workshops and seminars, and authored/

co-authored 7 national/ international books.

4. INFRASTRUCTURE AND LEARNING RESOURCES

The Institute has state of art infrastructure that facilitates the student’s quest for learning. The institute has properly ventilated and spacious classrooms with comfortable seating

arrangements, black boards and soft boards. Technology enabled learning spaces have been

created by providing dedicated computer systems, permanently installed LCD projectors &

screens and CCTV cameras in all classrooms. There are tutorial rooms for conducting and

small group interactions. The institute has a well equipped and fully air conditioned

auditorium with a capacity of 450 people and a seminar hall with capacity of 250 people.

Specialized facilities and equipments like collar microphones, Language Laboratory, IIPC,

Business Incubator, SYSTAT Station have been made available for teaching, learning,

research and industry interaction. There is a Health Centre on the campus with all minimum

necessary equipments, medicines, and a qualified doctor. “L.J. Arogya Kendra”, a mobile van

of LJK Trust, for providing all medical services and medicines to the slum dwellers of Vadaj

locality of Ahmedabad. It is also available for students and staff. The timings of the van are

from 8 am to 12 noon and the medicines are distributed at a subsidized rate. Health awareness

camps are also conducted for the slum dwellers. LJK Trust has a tie up with a pathological

laboratory for conducting health check-ups and tests at subsidized rates.

5. STUDENT SUPPORT AND PROGRESSION

The criterion highlights the efforts of the institution in providing necessary assistance to

students to promote their holistic development and progression.

The institution prepares its updated prospectus before the commencement of every academic

year providing information to students about location, contact details, courses, intake,

timings, vision, mission, Quality Policy, approval status, academic systems and processes,

co-curricular and extra-curricular activities, student welfare measures, placement activity,

alumni, faculty details, faculty development programme, research and extension activities,

innovations and initiatives, fee structure, infrastructure facilities, computer laboratories,

library resources, sports facilities, medical and healthcare facilities, conferencing facilities,

canteen, Women Development Cell, Grievance Redressal mechanism, Feedback Mechanism,

institutional achievements etc.

Institute provides personal, career and psycho-social counselling services to the students.

Student counselling is done at several levels. In order to provide counselling and mentoring

by maintaining one-to-one interaction with students, the institute has designed a unique

Section Head mechanism wherein each senior faculty member is assigned one class of 60

students. The Section Head is a contact point for students who regularly interacts with the

students. They provide personal and academic counselling, monitor attendance, overall

progress, and help them overcome challenges (if any).

The institute is committed towards providing financial assistance to needy and

deserving students. It provides support to students in three ways:

Page 14: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

One, the institute is an intermediary for the state government scholarships provided to

students from SC, ST, OBC and minority communities. These scholarships are

channelized through the institution.

Two, many students take an education loan to finance the cost of education. The

institute provides all administrative support required by the banks to process the

loans.

Three, LJ Kendra has supported needy but deserving students by providing fee

concessions and/or by giving an option of paying fees in easy installments and/or by

providing infrastructural facility at concession rate.

The institution has taken various initiatives and created mechanisms to facilitate student

progression towards employment or self-employment. There is an Industry Interaction and

Placement Cell (IIPC), and a separate dedicated Placement Cell for LJMBA to plan and

execute pre-placement and placement services and provide all necessary support to students.

Various programmes are conducted in a planned way to ensure students’ effective progression to their desired goal.

The institution promotes participation of students in extracurricular and co-curricular

activities such as sports, games, quiz competitions, debate and discussions, cultural activities

etc. It organizes co-curricular and extra-curricular activities for ensuring the overall

development of students during an academic year. Students are encouraged to participate in

youth festival and sports meet organized by the university as well as cultural

festivals/technical events and other academic programmes organized by other B Schools of

the country. Institute provides incentives, relaxations and support to students for participation

as well to give special awards to those who excel at the University/inter-university/national

level. Academic support is provided by organizing special sessions for students who may

have missed their studies due to participation in activities at the university/inter-university

level.

6. GOVERNANCE, LEADERSHIP AND MANAGEMENT

The institute has a formally stated Quality Policy. It was developed after a series of

interactions with the members of Trust and the teaching fraternity for continuous

improvement of the institute in all aspects of the field. The Institute strives to translate

quality to its various administrative and academic activities and thereby convert its

vision into reality. In order to reinforce and create a permanent reminder to the

espousal of the Quality Policy, the same has been framed and displayed at various

places in the institute.

The institute delegates authority and provides operational autonomy to all units. In

view of the academic activities and operations, the governance of the institute is

decentralized. The academic operations of the institute are divided into the following

specialized areas: marketing, finance, human resources and general management.

Complete authority is delegated to each specialized area to work out their independent

pedagogical system.

Management encourages and supports involvement of the staff in improving the

effectiveness and efficiency of the institutional processes. Involvement of staff in

improving the effectiveness and efficiency of the institutional processes is done by

Page 15: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

providing all necessary support by the Institute. Apart from being actively involved in

classroom teaching activity, the teaching staff is invited to participate in the various

functional activities like MAX, FINEX, HRX, etc and their suggestions are always

accepted by the management for further improvement. The institute staff also supports

the students in their entrepreneurial ventures through the Business Incubator -

Antrapreneur.

The institute makes continuous efforts made to enhance the professional development

of its staff. There is continuous encouragement by the top management including the

Director for the teaching and non-teaching staff to enhance their qualification and

skills. For achieving this, the institute has taken several initiatives like organizing

FDPs, having provision for Faculty Mentorship Program, organizing regular faculty

seminars, encouraging faculty for pursuing PhD. At present almost all faculty

members have either completed their PhD or are pursuing it. The institute also

provides all necessary financial and administrative support for attending conferences

and seminars. Incentives are provided to faculty for presenting their papers in such

events

7. INNOVATIONS AND BEST PRACTICES This criterion provides information reflecting environmental consciousness of the

institute and various innovative initiatives undertaken by the institute in achieving

academic excellence.

The institute has engaged itself in various environmental management initiatives that

have improved its environmental performance and has also led to other benefits like

financial savings and reduced risk of liability. These environmental management

initiatives or “Green Initiatives” as we call them primarily seek to deepen students’ understanding of today’s environmental challenges and assist them in developing effective solutions.

Capability Recognition And Development Lessons for Entrepreneurship (CRADLE),

Executive Personality Development Programme (EPDP), Employability Enhancement

Programme (EEP), ARCHETYPE – the Management Model Competition, VIKALPA

are some of the innovative practices initiated by the institute.

The criterion also provides details on two best practices adopted by the institute for

achieving quality assurance. ‘Summer Internship Project (SIP) Audit’ and ‘Developing an Entrepreneurial Ecosystem’ are the two best practices that have led to quality improvement and have had a significant impact on overall quality of the

institute.

Page 16: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

SWOC analysis:

The SWOC analysis is discussed as under

Strengths

Excellent infrastructure

Well qualified and experienced faculty members

Rich library and well equipped computer laboratories

2500 plus alumni base

Rigorous academic process that focuses on conceptual learning and skill development

Weakness

No control over quality of student intake as the admission process is controlled by ACPC (A

Committee of Professional Courses)

No autonomy of deciding syllabus as it is controlled by the affiliating University

Opportunity

To tie up with corporate and develop industry ready management graduates.

Establish international footprints by tie up with top foreign universities.

Challenges

Bridging the gap between management education and the ever changing and dynamic

requirement of the corporate world.

Page 17: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

\

1. Profile of

the Institute

Page 18: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Profile of the Affiliated / Constituent College

1. Name and Address of the College:

Name : L.J Institute of Management Studies

Address : Near Nagdev Kalyan mandir, Sarkhej Gandhinagar Highway, Sanand

Cross roads, Ahmedabad

City : Pin :382210 State : Gujarat

Website : www.ljinstitutes.org

2. For Communication:

Designation Name Telephone

with STD code

Mobile F

a

x

Email

Principal Dr. P.K Mehta O:07929096840 R:

9426511132 079-

26750417

pramodmehta0@g

mail.com

Vice Principal Dr. Siddarth

Singh Bist O:079 29096840

R: 0727660081

9824029413 079-

26750417

siddarth_bist@yaho

o.com

Steering

Committee

Co-

ordinator

Dr. Manisha Jalla

Dhar O: 07929096840

R: 07926740475

9824025753 079-

26750417

manisha_jalla@yah

oo.com

3. Status of the Institution:

Affiliated College : YES

Constituent College

Any other (specify)

4. Type of Institution:

a. By Gender

i. For Men

ii. iii.

For Women Co-education YES

b. By Shift i. Regular: YES ii. Day: YES iii. Evening

Page 19: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)
Page 20: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

5. It is a recognized minority institution?

No

If yes specify the minority status (Religious/linguistic/ any other) and provide documentary

evidence.

6. Sources of

funding:

Government

Grant-in-aid

Self-financing

YES Any other

7. a. Date of establishment of the college: ……23/8/2001………

b. University to which the college is affiliated /or which governs the college (If it is a

constituent college) GUJARAT TECHNOLOGICAL UNIVERSITY

c. Details of UGC recognition: N.A.

Under Section Date, Month & Year

(dd-mm-yyyy)

Remarks(If any)

i. 2 (f)

ii. 12 (B)

(Enclose the Certificate of recognition u/s 2 (f) and 12 (B) of the UGC Act)

d. Details of recognition/approval by statutory/regulatory bodies other than UGC (AICTE,

NCTE, MCI, DCI, PCI, RCI etc.)

Under Section/

clause

Recognition/Approval

details

Institution/Department

Programme

(AICTE )

Day, Month

and Year

(dd-mm-yyyy)

Validity

Remarks

i. MBA (1st shift) 23/8/2001 Annual Extension of

approval from

AICTE has to

be sought

every year

Page 21: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

ii. MBA (2nd

shift) Annual Extension of

approval from

AICTE has to

be sought

every year

iii. MCA Annual Extension of

approval from

AICTE has to

be sought

every year

iv. MAM Annual Extension of

approval from

AICTE has to

be sought

every year

8. Does the affiliating university Act provide for conferment of autonomy (as recognized by the

UGC), on its affiliated colleges?

Yes No √

If yes, has the College applied for availing the autonomous status?

Yes No

9. Is the college recognized

a. by UGC as a College with Potential for Excellence (CPE)?

Yes No √

If yes, date of recognition: …………………… (dd/mm/yyyy)

b. for its performance by any other governmental agency?

No √

If yes, Name of the agency …………………… and

Date of recognition: …………………… (dd/mm/yyyy)

10. Location of the campus and area in sq.mts:

Location * URBAN

Campus area in sq. mts. 45025.32 sq. mts. (11.126 acres)

Page 22: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Built up area in sq. mts. 4572 sq. mts.

(* Urban, Semi-urban, Rural, Tribal, Hilly Area, Any others specify)

11. Facilities available on the campus (Tick the available facility and provide numbers or

other details at appropriate places) or in case the institute has an agreement with other

agencies in using any of the listed facilities provide information on the facilities covered

under the agreement.

• Auditorium/seminar complex with infrastructural facilities √

• Sports facilities ∗ play ground √ ∗ swimming pool ∗ gymnasium

Page 23: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

• Hostel

∗ Boys’ hostel

i. Number of hostels

ii. Number of inmates

iii. Facilities (mention available facilities)

∗ Girls’ hostel

i. Number of hostels

ii. Number of inmates

iii. Facilities (mention available facilities)

∗ Working women’s hostel

i. Number of inmates

ii. Facilities (mention available facilities)

• Residential facilities for teaching and non-teaching staff (give numbers available

— cadre wise)

• Cafeteria —√

• Health centre –√

First aid, Inpatient, Outpatient, Emergency care facility, Ambulance……. Health

centre staff –

Qualified doctor

Full time

Part-time YES

Qualified Nurse Full time Part-time

• Facilities like banking, post office, book shops

• Transport facilities to cater to the needs of students and staff

• Animal house

• Biological waste disposal

• Generator or other facility for management/regulation of electricity and voltage√

• Solid waste management facility√

• Waste water management√

• Water harvesting√

12. Details of programmes offered by the college (Give data for current academic year)

Page 24: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

SI

.

N

o.

Programme

Level

Name of the Programme/ Course

Duration

Entry

Qualificatio

n

Medium of

instruction

Sanctioned/ approved Student strength

No. of

students

admitted

Under-

Graduate

Post-Graduate

MBA (1st shift)

MBA (2nd

shift)

MCA

2 Years

2 Years

3 years

Bachelors

degree

Bachelors

degree

Bachelors

degree

English

English

English

180

120

60

176

72

7

Integrated

Programm

es PG

MAM 5years

12th

English

60 48

Ph.D.

M.Phil.

Ph.D

Certifica

te

courses

UG Diploma

PG Diploma

Any Other

(specify and

provide

details)

13. Does the college offer self-financed Programmes?

Yes √ No

If yes, how many? 3

14. New programmes introduced in the college during the last five years if any?

Yes √ No Number ONE

(MAM)

Page 25: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

15. List the departments: (respond if applicable only and do not list facilities like Library, Physical

Education as departments, unless they are also offering academic degree awarding

programmes. Similarly, do not list the departments offering common compulsory subjects for

all the programmes

like English, regional languages etc.)

Faculty Departments

(eg. Physics, Botany,

History etc.)

UG PG Researc

h

Science

Arts

Commerce

Any Other

(1. Management

MBA,

MAM (Dual Degree)

BAM

MBA,

MAM

2. Computer

Application

MCA MCA

16. Number of Programmes offered under (Programme means a degree course like BA, BSc,

MA, M.Com…) a. annual system

b. semester system 3

c. trimester system

17. Number of Programmes with

a. Choice Based Credit System

b. Inter/Multidisciplinary Approach

c. Any other (specify and provide details) 3 (MBA, MCA AND MAM)

6. Does the college offer UG and/or PG programmes in Teacher Education?

Yes No √

If yes,

a. Year of Introduction of the programme(s)…… (dd/mm/yyyy)

and number of batches that completed the programme

b. NCTE recognition details (if applicable)

Notification No.: ……………………………………

Page 26: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Date: …………………………… (dd/mm/yyyy)

Validity:………………

Page 27: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

c. Is the institution opting for assessment and accreditation of Teacher Education

Programme separately?

Yes No

19. Does the college offer UG or PG programme in Physical Education?

Yes No √

If yes,

a. Year of Introduction of the programme(s)………………. (dd/mm/yyyy)

and number of batches that completed the programme b.

NCTE recognition details (if applicable)

Notification No.: ……………………………………

Date: …………………………… (dd/mm/yyyy)

Validity:……………………

c. Is the institution opting for assessment and accreditation of Physical Education

Programme separately?

Yes No

20. Number of teaching and non-teaching positions in the Institution

Positions

Teaching faculty

Non-teaching

staff

Technical

staff

Professor Associate

Professor

Assistant

Professor

*M *F *M *

F

*M *F *M *F *M *F

Sanctioned by the

UGC / University /

State Government

Recruited

Yet to recruit

Sanctioned by the

Management/

society or other

authorized bodies

Recruited

3 5 4 7 21 12 2 1

Yet to recruit - - -

-

- 3 - - - - -

*M-Male *F-Female

Page 28: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

21. Qualifications of the teaching staff:

Highest

qualification

Professor Associate Professor

Assistant

Professor

Total

Male Female Male Female Male Female

Permanent teachers

D.Sc./D.Litt. 0 0 0 0 0 0 0

Ph.D. 2 0 5 4 1 3 15

M.Phil. 0 0 0 0 0 0 0

PG 1 0 0 0 4 16 21

Temporary teachers 4 (Appointment yet to be endorsed by the University

selection committee)

Ph.D. 1 1

M.Phil.

PG 1 2 3

Part-time teachers

Ph.D.

M.Phil.

PG

22. Number of Visiting Faculty /Guest Faculty engaged with the College 04

23. Furnish the number of the students admitted to the college during the last four academic

years.

Categories

Year 1

(2015-16)

Year 2

(2014-15)

Year 3

(2013-14)

Year 4

(2012-13)

Male Female Male Female Male Female Male Female

SC 14 6 42 12 23 6 20 10

ST 1 1 3 1 0 0 4 1

OBC 31 15 101 23 65 6 88 16

General 145 90 174 61 144 67 134 75

Others

24. Details on students enrollment in the college during the current academic year:

Type of students UG PG M.

Phil.

Ph.D. Total

Students from the same state where the college is located

MBA:236

MCA: 7

MAM:41

Page 29: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Students from other states of India MBA: 12

MCA:0

MAM: 7

NRI students MBA:0

MCA:0

MAM:0

Foreign students MBA:0

MCA:0

MAM:0

Total

Page 30: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

25. Dropout rate in UG and PG (average of the last two batches)

PG 3%

26. Unit Cost of Education

(Unit cost = total annual recurring expenditure (actual) divided by total number of students

enrolled )

(a) including the salary component Rs. 63137

(b) excluding the salary component Rs. 37009

27. Does the college offer any programme/s in distance education mode (DEP)?

Yes No √

If yes,

a) is it a registered centre for offering distance education programmes of another

Universi

ty

Yes No

b) Name of the University which has granted such registration.

c) Number of programmes offered

d) Programmes carry the recognition of the Distance Education Council.

Yes No

28. Provide Teacher-student ratio for each of the programme/course offered

MBA 1: 15

MCA 1:15

MAM 1:18

29. Is the college applying for

Accreditation : Cycle 1 √ Cycle 2 Cycle 3 Cycle 4

Re-Assessment:

(Cycle 1refers to first accreditation and Cycle 2, Cycle 3 and Cycle 4 refers to re-

accreditation)

Page 31: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

30. Date of accreditation* (applicable for Cycle 2, Cycle 3, Cycle 4 and re-assessment only)

Cycle 1: ……………… (dd/mm/yyyy) Accreditation Outcome/Result….….... Cycle 2:

……………… (dd/mm/yyyy) Accreditation Outcome/Result……..... Cycle 3:

……………… (dd/mm/yyyy) Accreditation Outcome/Result……..... * Kindly enclose copy of accreditation certificate(s) and peer team report(s) as an

annexure.

31. Number of working days during the last academic year.

110 days

32. Number of teaching days during the last academic year

(Teaching days means days on which lectures were engaged excluding the

examination days)

92 days

33. Date of establishment of Internal Quality Assurance Cell (IQAC) IQAC

…………………… (dd/mm/yyyy)

34. Details regarding submission of Annual Quality Assurance Reports (AQAR) to

NA

AC.

AQAR (i) ……………… (dd/mm/yyyy)

AQAR (ii) ……………… (dd/mm/yyyy)

AQAR (iii) ……………… (dd/mm/yyyy)

AQAR (iv) ……………… (dd/mm/yyyy)

35. Any other relevant data (not covered above) the college would like to include. (Do

not include explanatory/descriptive information)

Page 32: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

1. Criteria – Wise

Inputs

Page 33: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

CRITERION - 1: CURRICULAR ASPECTS

1.1 Curriculum Planning and Implementation

1.1.1 State the vision, mission and objectives of the institution, and describe how these are

communicated to the students, teachers, staff and other stakeholders.

Vision: LJIMS will be a key player in management education and corporate development by promoting

creativity, scholarship, innovation and excellence.

Mission: LJIMS will endeavour to create dynamic professionals equipped with conceptual clarity,

practical knowledge, effective soft skills, self confidence, innovativeness and ethical concern.

Objectives:

To exploit new advances in knowledge and technology

To attract and retain the best faculty.

To build links with institutions, both in India and abroad, and industry for enrichment of

academic programmes and for providing learning and employment avenues to students.

To create opportunities and systems for exploitation of talents of students.

To provide access to quality education to talented students of socially, economically and

geographically disadvantaged sections.

To create and support systems for providing exposure, to the students and the faculty, to the latest

developments in the field of management, technology and business.

To encourage and support research among faculty and students.

The Vision, Mission and Objectives are generally discussed in faculty meetings and communicated to

them. They are also prominently displayed at different places like entrance of the institute, conference

room, library and administrative office, and also printed in brochures.

1.1.2 How does the institution develop and deploy action plans for effective implementation of the

curriculum? Give details of the process and substantiate through specific examples(s).

The institute has a mechanism for efficiently implementing the curriculum. The process is as follows:

The faculty members are given choice of indicating their preferences of the subjects as per their

qualifications and expertise, which taken into consideration while making the final allotment.

Faculty will discuss the subjects and syllabus with industry and academic experts to decide the

pedagogy and evaluation pattern.

Once the subjects are allotted to the faculties, they need to prepare an Academic Plan in the

subject file incorporating the following:

- Objectives and Scope of the subject

- Detailed syllabus prescribed by the University

- Number of sessions required to complete the syllabus

- Probable dates/time to finish different units/chapters/topics

- Pedagogy/Delivery mechanism for different units/chapters/topics (for eg. ppt

presentation, case study, role play, project etc.)

- Evaluation components for different units/chapters/topics (class test, quiz,

presentation, assignment, project study, company project, movie screening, student

seminar etc.)

- The list of text books, reference books, journals, magazines, articles to be used.

- Continuous evaluation schedule is also part of the subject file.

Page 34: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

- Supplementary reading material like notes, case studies, research articles are also

included.

The sessions and evaluation are conducted in accordance to the above mentioned plan.

To ensure effective implementation of the curriculum an academic review, in the middle and the

end of semester, is conducted under the mechanism of an Academic Review Process (ARP).

The review process is carried out twice a semester:

i. In the mid semester an Academic Review Committee comprising senior faculty

members and the Dean of the institute, meet each faculty member and audit the

academic progress.

ii. Another audit is conducted at the end of the semester by an expert panel that consists

of the Director, Professor Emeritus and the Dean.

The review which is conducted twice during every semester ensures the adherence to the

session plan, delivery mechanism, completion of evaluation components and use of

innovative pedagogical techniques in delivery and evaluation as suggested in the respective

schemes of the faculty. As a follow up to the ARP, a seminar is also conducted for sharing of

good practices noticed during the review process.

Institute also conducts seminars and workshops for faculties on innovative tools to be used

for subject delivery and evaluation on regular basis.

1.1.3 What type of support (procedural and practical) do the teachers receive from the University

and/or institution for effectively translating the curriculum and improving teaching

practices?

There are different initiatives taken by the University and the Institute for improving teaching practices

and curriculum improvement.

By the University:

The university conducts subject workshops for all the subjects of all the semesters, in

which they invite the faculties teaching the subject in different institutes. The faculties

discuss the syllabus, delivery style, evaluation pattern, doubts if any, practices of

different institutes, question paper format and style, continuous evaluation components

etc.

University also organizes the workshops on effective teaching pedagogies which provide

a platform to all the faculties to contribute in this area.

University also invites faculties to give review on the syllabus which increases the scope

of improvement.

The University also organizes seminars, workshops and Faculty Development

Programmes on regular basis for improving the curriculum.

The University regularly conducts paper setting and evaluation workshops to ensure

better student assessment.

By the Institution:

Institute invites subject and area experts from industry and academics for discussion

on content and delivery for different subjects.

The Institute also organizes Faculty Development Programmes and Corporate

Interaction with Industry experts for the improvement in subject content and delivery.

The Institute organizes brain storming sessions for faculty sessions to devise

innovative teaching techniques for better student understanding.

Page 35: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

1.1.4 Specify the initiatives taken up or contribution made by the institution for effective

curriculum delivery and transaction on the Curriculum provided by the affiliating

University or other Statutory agency.

From 2001 to 2010, the institute was affiliated to Gujarat University. During those times the faculty

members actively participated in the syllabus revision and new syllabus development exercise conducted

at the university level.

Faculties have participated in upgrading the curriculum of different subjects. Dr. Siddarth Singh Bist

designed the syllabus of Consumer Behaviour and Marketing Management. Ms. Manisha Jalla Dhar

developed the syllabus for Compensation Management and International HRM. The university

implemented the syllabus of all the four subjects.

In 2014, the Institute was invited by Gujarat Technological University to participate in developing a new

assessment scheme. Later the institute organised a brain storming session where faculties from different

institutes (affiliated to GTU) suggested a new format of assessment to Gujarat Technological University

which was approved by the Vice Chancellor and implemented. Based on the format all the faculties of the

institute designed sample question papers for their respective subjects which was then uploaded on the

University’s website.

Gujarat Technological University had also requested the Institute for an assessment of the new evaluation

pattern for the academic year 2014-15 and the Institute submitted a report that critically evaluated all the

question papers generated as per the new pattern of assessment.

1.1.5 How does the institution network and interact with the beneficiaries such as industry,

research bodies and the university in effective operationalisation of the curriculum?

The Institute has introduced a new practice in the Summer Internship Programme known

as Summer Internship Project Audit wherein the faculties conduct a personal visit to

those companies where students are undertaking the summer internship project. Apart

from obtaining the feedback pertaining to students’ performance in the project these visits are also aimed at understanding the company requirements and expectations so that the

students can be trained accordingly. This practice of audit ensures that Summer

Internship Projects that is part of the curriculum gets effectively operationalised.

The institute has a unique series called CRADLE where entrepreneurs come and share

their experiences with the students. They also give their suggestions on the current needs

of the market/industry which the institute tries to incorporate in the curriculum delivery.

The institute has started an initiative called PRASHIKSHAN wherein students work on

short term project with different companies and field experience. The students have

worked on different projects for companies like TCS, TATA Motors, LG, Whirlpool,

Havmor, Bajaj finserve, Central Mall to name a few.

The institute conducts skill workshop series in the areas of marketing, finance and HR. In

the area of marketing, the institute conducts MAX (Marketing Excellence Series),

Finance Excellence Series( FINEX) and Human Resource Excellence Series (HRX)

where senior managers are invited to share their corporate experiences. These

programmes have an inbuilt module of skill development wherein the participants spend

time working on different assignments with the corporate and practicing managers in

order to develop real time skills required at the work place.

1.1.6 What are the contributions of the institute and/or its staff members to the development of

the curriculum by the University? (Number of staff members/departments represented on

Page 36: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

the Board of Studies, student feedback, teacher feedback, stakeholder feedback provided,

specific suggestions, etc.

The Institute faculties regularly participate in the University Curriculum Development Meetings and the

institute faculty conducted a brain storming session regarding the same and developed a new paper style

which was adopted by the University subsequently.

The faculties have presented different suggestions to the University to improve the curriculum, delivery

style and evaluation techniques. The suggestions are under consideration right now at University.

1.1.7 Does the institution develop curriculum for any of the courses offered (other than those

under the purview of the affiliating university) by it? If ‘yes’ give details on the process (Needs Assessment, design, development and planning) and the courses for which the

curriculum has been developed.

The Institute is working on certain certificate courses that shall be offered to students

Certificate Course in Behavioural Finance

The course was developed on the following lines

Need Assessment: There is a need of for financial professionals dealing in stock market

to understanding the psychology of investors in the stock market

Curriculum Design and Development: The entire curriculum has been designed after

consulting practicing managers and senior professor and researchers regarding topics to

be included in the syllabus.

Entrepreneurship Development Programme: The Institute has tied up with Entrepreneurship

Development Institute and Centre for Entrepreneurship, Govt. of Gujarat, MSME Department to

offer short term certificate to budding entrepreneurship and students interested in

Entrepreneurship.

Need Assessment: It was observed that there was a dearth of good entrepreneurship

induction and inculcation programmes that imparted real-time skills for practicing

entrepreneurs.

Curriculum Design and Development: The course was designed by consulting

successful entrepreneurs and these experts were roped in to play the pivotal role of

mentor to the students.

Skill Courses: The Institute has developed skill based courses under the names of Marketing

Excellence Series (MAX), Financial Excellence Series (FINEX) and Human Resource

Management Excellence (HRX) in order to inculcate real time working skills among student

participants.

Need Assessment: It was observed that that there was a serious dearth of real time

marketing, finance and HR skills required at the work place by the student.

Curriculum Design and Development: The course was designed by consulting experts

in their respective fields. For example: Mr. Malay Biswas, CFO, Astra Lifecare designed

the skill programme for FINEX where in after a few orientation sessions towards

corporate finance and Forex, the students shall be trained by him at Astra Lifecare and

then at Bank of Baroda. The Institute has tied up with National Stock Exchange to deliver

skill oriented courses.

1.1.8. How does institution analyze/ensure that the stated objectives of curriculum are achieved in

the course of its implementation?

Page 37: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

In order to ensure that the stated objectives are achieved in its course of implementation, all the faculty

members teaching a subject discuss and decide upon three critical parameters regarding the curriculum

implementation.

Subject topics: The faculty identifies the subject topics that need to be covered in order to achieve

the course objective.

Teaching methodology: The faculty decides upon the pedagogy which shall best achieve the

teaching objective. A gamut of pedagogies like lecture, group discussion, presentation, project,

company visit, field visit, expert session, expert interview etc are chosen on the basis of the

teaching objective.

Assessment: The faculty then decides upon the assessment technique to determine the student’s learning. A host of techniques like mid term exam, project submission, presentation, theory and

multiple choice questions etc are included to better assess the student.

To further ensure that the curriculum objectives are met and the academic plan is followed as

planned, the Institute has an Academic Review Process twice in every semester in which the Director

and Dean of the institute review the subject progress and evaluation by individually meeting each

faculty member and checking the progress.

1.2 Academic Flexibility

1.2.1 Specifying the goals and objectives give details of the certificate/diploma/skill development

courses etc., offered by the institution.

The Institute has different certificate/skill development programmes. They are mentioned below.

EPDP: The Executive Personality and Development Programme (EPDP) is a week long

programme.

Objective: To increase student’s employability by enhancing their communication, corporate

knowledge and developing their personality and soft skills.

The programme consists of different activities like communication skill, presentation skill,

interview skill, CV writing, general awareness, corporate etiquettes, group discussions etc. This

week long programme is delivered at the beginning of the third semester, and it is compulsory for

all students seeking placement.

FINEX: It stands for Finance Excellence Series (FINEX) series

Objective: It intends to bridge the gap between students and the corporate world through a

specially designed course curriculum that develops the necessary finance based skills need in the

corporate world.

It is structured series, designed to initially include interactive sessions delivered by industry

experts which is backed by rigorous practical sessions to develop skills among finance students. It

covers areas like corporate finance, banking, insurance and capital market respectively. The goal

of this series is to provide a platform for the holistic development of budding financial managers.

MAX: It stands for Marketing Excellence Series

Objective: The objective of the series was to inculcate marketing skills at work place among

students opting for marketing and sales as a career.

MAX is conceived as a series of interactions with successful marketing professionals from

industry and academia, sharing their experiences of marketing successes and failures. The

speakers share their experiences in the following areas: New launches, product and brand

management, marketing strategies and programmes, IMC strategies, branding strategies, sales and

Page 38: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

distribution management, positioning strategies, CRM strategies, and marketing research. It is

followed by live training in the field under the experts so that the students get a chance to develop

marketing and sales skills to function successfully in the field.

HRX: It stands for Human Resource Management Excellence Series

Objectives: HRX was conceived with the objective of making students aware with the practical

issues pertaining the practices of human resource management.

HRM involves many issues ranging from recruitment and selection to training and development.

In includes labor welfare, labor laws and compensation management, HRX was envisaged with

the objective of getting the best practicing HR professionals to interact with the students and

bring to them the cutting edge HR practices in the leading corporate houses.

1.2.2 Does the institution offer programmes that facilitate twinning/dual degree? If ‘yes’, give details.

No, the Institute does not offer any twinning/dual degree programmes.

1.2.3 Give details on the various institutional provisions with reference to academic flexibility

and how it has been helpful to students in terms of skills development, academic mobility,

progression to higher studies and improved potential for employability. Issues may cover

the following and beyond:

- Range of Core/ Elective options offered by the University and those opted by the college: The institute was among the first to offer Human Resource Management as a third area of

specialization apart from Marketing and Finance in 2001. Looking into the interest levels and

subsequent requests made by seven students (in a batch of 40) to have human resource

management as an area of specialization the institute decided to offer it as an elective and thus

contribute towards offering more academic choice improving the potential for the employability

of these students.

Under the current set up the institute offers three electives each in semesters III and IV. The

choice of electives offered depends upon student interest their preference and current demand

industry demands. These electives help in enabling students develop those skills which may

enhance their potential for better employment.

Choice based Credit System and range of subject options: NA

- Courses offered in modular form: NA

- Credit transfer and accumulation facility: NA

- Lateral and vertical mobility within and across programmes and courses: NA

- Enrichment courses: The institute has different programmes to enrich the courses, the details are

as under:

Considering the finance specialization, every year the institute organizes Finance Excellence

Series (FINEX) for two to three days. In this series of sessions people from industry/corporate

comes and share their experiences with the students who opts finance as their specialization.

For marketing specialization students the institute organizes Marketing Excellence Series (MAX).

In this series of sessions people from industry/corporate comes and share their experiences with

the students who opts marketing as their specialization.

In the same line for HR specialization students the institute organizes the Human Recourses

excellence Series (HIREX). In this series of sessions people from industry/corporate comes and

share their experiences with the students who opts HR as their specialization.

Page 39: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

1.2.4 Does the institution offer self-financed programmes? If ‘yes’, list them and indicate how they differ from other programmes, with reference to admission, curriculum, fee structure,

teacher qualifications, salary, etc. Although L.J Institute of Management Studies, is a self-financed institute offering programmes

launched by the affiliating University, it does not offer any programme developed by itself on the

lines specified in the question.

1.2.5 Does the college provide additional skill oriented progammes, relevant to regional and

global employment markets? If ‘yes’ provide details of such programmes and the beneficiaries.

Yes, the institute offers various programmes to provide its students with the necessary skills

required to work in the corporate world. These are as follows:

1. The Executive Personality and Development Programme (EPDP)

2. Finance Excellence Series (FINEX)

3. Marketing Excellence Series (MAX)

4. Human Resource Excellence Series (HRX)

The details of these programmes have briefly been discussed in section 1.2.1.

EPDP: The Executive Personality and Development Programme (EPDP) is a week long

programme.

Objective: To increase student’s employability by enhancing their communication, corporate knowledge and developing their personality and soft skills.

The programme consists of different activities like communication skill, presentation skill,

interview skill, CV writing, general awareness, corporate etiquettes, group discussions etc. This

week long programme is delivered at the beginning of the third semester, and it is compulsory for

all students seeking placement.

FINEX: It stands for Finance Excellence Series (FINEX) series

Objective: It intends to bridge the gap between students and the corporate world through a

specially designed course curriculum that develops the necessary finance based skills need in the

corporate world.

It is structured series, designed to initially include interactive sessions delivered by industry

experts which is backed by rigorous practical sessions to develop skills among finance students. It

covers areas like corporate finance, banking, insurance and capital market respectively. The goal

of this series is to provide a platform for the holistic development of budding financial managers.

MAX: It stands for Marketing Excellence Series

Objective: The objective of the series was to inculcate marketing skills at work place among

students opting for marketing and sales as a career.

MAX is conceived as a series of interactions with successful marketing professionals from

industry and academia, sharing their experiences of marketing successes and failures. The

speakers shared their experiences in the following areas: New launches, product and brand

management, marketing strategies and programmes, IMC strategies, branding strategies, sales and

distribution management, positioning strategies, CRM strategies, and marketing research. It is

followed by live training in the field under the experts so that the students get a chance to develop

marketing and sales skills to function successfully in the field.

HRX: It stands for Human Resource Management Excellence Series

Objectives: HRX was conceived with the objective of making students aware with the practical

issues pertaining to the practices of human resource management.

Page 40: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

HRM involves many issues ranging from recruitment and selection to training and development.

In includes labor welfare, labor laws and compensation management, HRX was envisaged with

the objective of getting the best practicing HR professionals to interact with the students and

bring to them the cutting edge HR practices in the leading corporate houses.

Prashikshan: It is the name given to the live project immersion conducted at the institute.

Objective: To give students an opportunity to take up live project in companies in order to

generate practical knowledge and networking opportunities.

Under this activity students are going to different firms and take the real life experiences and

work for the companies. This activity helps them to understand the market, skills required, and

give them the exposure to the real life situations as well as it creates the final placement

opportunities.

1.2.6 Does the University provide for the flexibility of combining the conventional face-to-face

and Distance Mode of Education for students to choose the course/combination of their

choice? If ‘yes’, how does the institute take advantage of such provision for the benefit of

students? NO

1.3 Curriculum Enrichment

1.3.1 Describe the efforts made by the institution to supplement the University’s Curriculum to ensure that the academic programmes and Institution’s goals and objectives are integrated?

The institute wants to ensure that student learning has to be rigorous and objective oriented and so the

institute faculties have taken concrete steps to make the university syllabus more rigorous and objective in

nature. The university curriculum consists of objectives, topics and books to be referred. The institute

faculty along with insights from corporate managers have divided the entire curriculum into four parts as

mentioned below.

1. Course objective

2. Topics to be covered

3. Teaching methodology/Pedagogy

4. Assessment

This methodology is adhered to and the institute faculty is doing it in order to make the student learning

process extremely rigorous.

Further, in order to supplement the learning values of the curriculum prescribed the University, the

institute organizes a host of skill oriented courses and workshops like EPDP, FINEX, MAX, HRX,

CRADLE which have been discussed in detail earlier. This is done in order to make the student learning

more practical in nature.

1.3.2 What are the efforts made by the institution to enrich and organize the curriculum to

enhance the experience of the students so as to cope with the needs of the dynamic

employment market?

The institute is taking interest in the employability of the students by taking different actions.

Page 41: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

The institute has a faculty team for Summer Internship Programme in which they arrange sessions

to make the students understand need of the market and they place also all the students in

different firms.

The institute has a dedicated final placement team which runs the immersion programme for the

students. In this week long programme faculties from different specialization participate and

groom the students on subject knowledge, communication, presentation, etiquettes, skills required

from the industry etc.

The Institute conducts a programme called Prashikshan in which students are given an

opportunity for the live projects in the company. Through this activity students get a chance to

interact with industry people and try to understand their skill requirements.

1.3.3 Enumerate the efforts made by the institution to integrate the cross cutting issues such as

Gender, Climate Change, Environment, Education, Human Rights, ICT, etc. into the

curriculum? The curriculum is designed by Gujarat technological University therefore incorporating new

elements and issues lies outside the purview of the institute. But the institute has taken initiative

for incorporating the below mentioned issues in the curriculum to sensitise and educate the

students

Gender sensitivity: As a part of business ethics subject, a leading lawyers/women right

activists are invited to speak to students about gender sensitivity and women rights at the

work place.

Education: As a part of the topic of Corporate Social Responsibility (CSR) in Business Ethics

subject, the students of the institute are encouraged at teach slum kids of nearby areas in order

to sensitize them to social issues.

Human rights: The students are encouraged to work with Blind People’s Association to increase sensitivity towards the physically challenged.

1.3.4 What are the various value-added courses/enrichment programmes offered to ensure holistic

development of students?

Moral and ethical values: A small initiative of LJMBA where the students from the college

impart some knowledge and enhance the skill of the underprivileged kids of slum and perform the

recreational activity to spark their future. Various trips and camps are organized to upgrade their

overall knowledge and ignite their spark in them to know more. Blood donation camps and visits

to deprived sections of the society are regularly organized under the extension activities.

Employability and life skills: The institute has different programmes to improve the

employability and skills of the students by offering different programmes like;

EPDP

FINEX

MAX

HRX

(The details of these programmes have been discussed in section 1.2.1.)

XCEL (The movie club): XCEL is the movie club at LJMBA that brings a new concept of

“EDUTAINMENT”. It means education plus entertainment. Watching movies can also boost the

locus of control of people and helps to stimulate the self motivation power. It also relaxes the

burden of the student.

MIND STEIN (The Quiz Competition): the basic objective of MAN Q is to provide a common

platform to students to explore, hunt, build and cultivate their knowledge bank. The format of

MAN Q will include sections like corporate knowledge, global corporate knowledge, general

awareness and industry specific information.

Page 42: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Archetype (The Management Model Competition): Archetype is a Business Model

competition has been conducted at LJMBA since 2005. It is one of a kind of unique activity

which involves management students, help them generate business ideas and convert them into

feasible business ventures. It is hugely popular and anticipated event wherein the first year

students participate and work for 3 weeks on different business ideas. Every year more than 400

students work on 70 different business ideas.

The Executive Personality and Development Programme (EPDP) is a week long programme

targeted at enhancing student’s employability by enhancing their corporate knowledge and developing their personality and soft skills. The programme consists of different activities like

communication skill, presentation skill, interview skill, CV writing, general awareness, corporate

etiquettes, group discussions etc. This week long programme is delivered at the beginning of the

third semester, and it is compulsory for all students seeking placement.

Better career options: Through different activities like Immersion, Final Placement, EPDP and

Prashikshan the institute tries to give the best career options to the sunders.

Prashikshan (The live project Immersion): Prashikshan is a unique immersion programme where

students undertake live projects in companies on a part time basis. These projects include New

product launch, consumer surveys, distributor survey, auditing, event management, client

acquisition, customer relationship[p management, MIS, training and development, financial

planning, etc. the students have in past undertaken and currently working on part time projects at

Sharp, Central Mall, TCS, Bajaj FinServe, Planet Health, Coke, Tata Motors, Airtel etc.

Industrial Visits: industrial visit for LJMBA students are regularly organized for different SMEs

to provide students an opportunity for experiential learning and research.

Community orientation: The institute runs various extension activities for the upliftment of

society.

Prayas: It is an extension activity where students of the institute under the guidance of a faculty

member teach uneducated students of villages in the vicinity of the institute.

Parivartan: It is an extension activity where students under the guidance of a faculty member

undertake development activities for underprivileged children at and women at destitute home

and old persons at old age homes.

1.3.5 Citing a few examples enumerate on the extent of use of the feedback from stakeholders in

enriching the curriculum?

The institute obtains feedback from stakeholders like parents, employers, alumni and students. Feedback

from employers is very crucial in understanding the current industry requirements. For example, feedback

received from employers highlighted lack of soft skills and lack of domain specific subject knowledge.

Based on it programmes like EDDP, MAX, FINEX and HRX were introduced. Further, since the

curriculum is designed By Gujarat technological University the institute has no control over it. But for the

enrichment the institute has many co-curricular activities like MAX, FINEX, HIREX, Management

Model Competition, CRADLE etc. which helps the students to get a practical aspect of different areas of

management. These activities also enhance the employability of the students by providing them the

industry exposure and knowledge of different areas.

1.3.6 How does the institution monitor and evaluate the quality of its enrichment programmes?

The institute has in place a feedback mechanism where after each activity the feedback is taken for e.g.

EPDP, Teaching, Placement, SIP, feedback from employers, feedback from parents etc. At the end of

every programme feedback is obtained from the learners. For example, based on the feedback obtained

from the learners after completion of EPDP new tracks were added in subsequent years. Further, formats

of MAX, FINEX and HRX were changed. It was linked with Immersion, Field Visits and Industry

training.

Page 43: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

1.4 Feedback System

1.4.1 What are the contributions of the institution in the design and development of the

curriculum prepared by the University?

Curriculum is designed By Gujarat technological University and institute has no control over it. But the

faculties of the institute have a brain storming session on how to use innovative techniques of evaluation

and delivery system to enrich the curriculum. Faculty members have given many suggestions which are

under consideration at University.

Faculty members have attended different seminars and workshop at University on curriculum discussion

and paper drawing style.

1.4.2 Is there a formal mechanism to obtain feedback from students and stakeholders on

Curriculum? If ‘yes’, how is it communicated to the University and made use internally for curriculum enrichment and introducing changes/new programmes?

The institute has a formal feedback mechanism in which feedback is taken from different

stakeholders like students, Employers ( Final placement and Summer placement), Parents and

Alumni.

Student’s feedback on quality of teaching: Student feedback is taken every semester on quality of teaching of all faculties teaching

them. After the analysis of feedback, the Director discusses the feedback with each

faculty member in order to make corrective action in the teaching method if required.

Feedback from Employers (Final Placement): After the final placement the institute collects

feedback to know the performance of the students from employers and corrective action is taken.

Feedback from Employers (Summer Internship): During summer internship, the institute sends

faculty members to the companies to know the performance of the students placed there. The

faculties talk to the project guide and take the feedback of the student performance. The students

are then briefed in order to bring corrective change in their working at the company.

Feedback from Parents: Parent feedback is taken to understand their views on the institutional

functioning and progress of their ward.

Feedback of students on Institute: Student feedback is also taken on overall institute details like

infrastructural facilities and other facilities like library, computer lab, class room facilities,

canteen, playground etc. It helps the institute for improvement in different areas.

Alumni Feedback: The institute also takes feedback from the passed out students to know their

current job details and obtain their inputs on institutional improvement and develop necessary

network.

1.4.3 How many new programmes/courses were introduced by the institution during the last four

years? What was the rationale for introducing new courses/programmes? The institute has started Master in Applied Management (a five years integrated programme in

applied management). The rationale to start this programme is to give exposure of management

education especially applied management right from the undergraduate level.

Page 44: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Criterion - 2: Teaching Learning and Evaluation

2.1 Students Enrolments and Profile

2.1.1 How does the college ensure publicity and transparency in the admission process?

The Government of Gujarat by way of a notification has constituted a committee called “Admission

Committee for Professional Courses(ACPC)” to regulate admissions to the professional degree and

diploma courses .The mission assigned to this committee is to carry out the counsellingprocess in a fair

and transparent manner. The admission process is conducted by the Committee strictly on the basis of merit and preference of the candidate.

The ACPC supervises, monitors and controls the entire admission process. It prepares the merit list and

allocates the open seats and regulates management seats in accordance with the provisions and the rules

made thereunder. It also ensures that admissions are made as per the merit list prepared and that no

candidate is admitted unless his/her name appears in the merit list.

The eligibility criteria for admissions are that a candidate shall have appeared in the Common

Management Admission Test (CMAT), conducted by AICTE, for the corresponding year. The candidates

should have passed the Bachelor’s Degree examination with minimum 50 % marks (45% in case of SC, ST and SEBC candidates).

The institute strictly follows the prescribed reservation norms. The norms of reservation as per the guidelines are as follows:

Reserved Category % Reservation

Scheduled Castes 7%

Scheduled Tribes 15%

Page 45: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Socially and Educationally Backward Classes(SEBC) 27%

Physically Handicapped Candidates 3%

Children of Defense Personnel and Ex-Servicemen 1%

The institute has been sanctioned 180 seats in the first shift and 120 seats in the second shift. For the

purpose of admission to the first year, 75% of the total sanctioned seats are open seats, while the rest 25

% are in the management quota. The admission process for the filling up of the management seats is

carried out by the Institute in accordance with the guidelines and procedure laid down by the ACPC. All

information regarding the admission process is advertised in leading newspapers having circulation of

50000 or more copies as well as displayed on the website of the Institute. A separate register is

maintained for the sale and receipt of admission forms. Time schedule and the place of submission are

clearly mentioned in the advertisement and the website. The institute prepares and displays this Inter-se

Merit list on the Institute’s notice board, as well as on web site. This way Institute ensures that the process of admission is carried out in fair, transparent and non-exploitative manner.

2.1.2 Explain in detail the criteria adopted and the process of admission( Ex. (i) merit (ii) common

admission test conducted by state agencies and national agencies(iii) combination of merit and

entrance test or merit ,entrance test and interview (iv) any other)to various programmes of the

Institution

The qualifying examination for the admission process in MBA programme as per AICTE guidelines is

Common Management Admission Test (CMAT). It is carried out for facilitating institutions to select

suitable students for admission in management programmes. CMAT is a computer based test (CBT)

comprising four equal sections on- quantitative technique, logical reasoning, language comprehension and

general awareness. The other eligibility criterion is obtaining at least 50% (45% in case of candidate belonging to reserved category) in Bachelor’s Degree.

The Admission Committee, through advertisements in the prominent newspapers, publishes the date of

registration, list of help centres, last date for submission of registration form and other necessary

information. A candidate seeking admission is required to apply on-line within the time limit specified by

the Admission Committee. A candidate is required to obtain the print out of the registration form, sign

and submit the same along with the self-attested copies of the requisite certificates and testimonial as

specified in the registration form at the help centre. The merit list of the candidates is prepared on the

basis of marks obtained in Common Management Aptitude Test CMAT) after verification of the

documents. The Admission committee displays the merit list and the schedule of online counselling

programme on its website. The candidate is required to indicate his/her order of preference of the

institutes through the online media. Allotment of seats is made on the basis of merit of the candidate and

availability of seats. The allotment of seats is also published on the website of the committee. The

candidate is required to secure his/her admission by producing information letter, receipt of fee, all original documents and testimonials for verification at the help centre within the specified time limit.

The admission to management quota seats is also done as per the guidelines of the admission committee.

The institute prepares the time schedule of the admission process within the time duration fixed by the

Admission Committee. All the information regarding the admission process is advertised in leading

newspaper having circulation of 50000 or more copies as well as displayed on the website of the Institute.

Minimum seven working days is given for filling up and receiving the admission forms. A Nodal Officer

is appointed to look after the admission process of management seats. The nodal officer attends to the

complaints and queries raised by candidates or the ACPC and resolves the same within the specified time

Page 46: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

limit. A separate register is maintained for the sale and receipt of admission forms. Time schedule and the

place of submission are clearly mentioned in the advertisement and the website. The institute prepares the

Inter-se Merit list of the eligible candidates having merit number of Admission Committee. The institute

displays this Inter-se Merit list on the Institute’s notice board, as well as on website. The Nodal Officer

personally submits the management quota file to the ACPC.

2.1.3 Details of Minimum and Maximum Ranking for admission at entry level and their comparisons with other institutes affiliated with university within city and District.

S.NO Name of institute Comparative

ranking (Gen)

1. Ahmedabad Institute of Technology Gota, Ahmedabad (SFI) 1045-3972

2. B.K.School of Business Management, Gujarat University (GIA) 43- 50

3. B.K.School of Business Management,Gujarat University -MBA (Maritime Mgt.)

(SFI)

22-680

4. GLS Institute of Computer Technology Ahmedabad (SFI) 308- 578

5. L.J.Institute of Computer Applications (SFI)-Ahmedabad 1635- 4326

6. L.J.Institute of Engineering & Technology (SFI)-Ahmedabad 2360- 4170

7. L.J.Institute of Management Studies (SFI)- Ahmedabad 737.-3881

8. L.J.Institute of Management Studies (SFI)-second Shift Ahmedabad 1714- 4274

9. R.B.Institute of Management Studies (SFI),Ahmedabad. 1649- 4171

10. Sal Institute of Management (SFI) ,Opp. Science City, Bhadaj,Ahmedabad 542- 2288

11 Shayona Institute of Business Management, Ahmedabad.(SFI) 3291- 3906

12 ShriChimanbhai Patel Institute of Management and Research (SFI)-Ahmedabad 425- 2449

13 Som-Lalit Institute of Business Management Studies (SFI) Ahmedabad 53- 585

2.1.4 Is there a mechanism in the institution to review the admission process and student’s profile annually? If ‘yes’ what is the outcome of such an effort and how has it contributed to the

improvement of the process?

The institute adheres to the guidelines issued by the Admission Committee for Professional Courses

(ACPC) for the admission process. A student profile is collected as a part of the reporting procedure at the

Institute. An intake analysis is done to study the composition of the students in terms of their basic field

Page 47: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

of graduation, additional qualification, achievements, work experience etc. This helps to identify if there

is any need for Bridge/remedial courses to enable them to cope with the MBA programme.

As a part of the Induction Programme for the fresh entrants to the MBA programme, the first phase of

Executive Personality Development Programme (EPDP) is conducted. This programme facilitates the

Institute to recognize student’s true potential by identifying their strength and weaknesses. The first phase is a three day programme, where students are evaluated on the basis of following criteria- analytical skills,

presentation skills, communication skills (Both verbal and non-verbal), techniques of facing interviews

and group discussions. Various individual and group activities are administered to analyse behavioural

and psychological skills of the first year students.

Once the need is being correctly identified, various programmes are designed to impart knowledge and

improve their presentation and communication skills. For example Placement Assistance Programme –It is a programme specifically aimed at updating students with current trends of industry by providing in-

depth knowledge of conduct and techniques necessary to crack Group Discussions and different types of

Interviews. This programme includes activities like- CV Writing, Techniques for Group Discussion,

Techniques to crack a Personal Interview, Mock GD’s and PI’s and Interaction with Industry Experts. Student Ability Mapping Interviews: As a part of the placement assistance programme, interviews are

conducted for all the students by faculty members and external experts before their summer internship

programme and final placement. The entire interview of each student is captured as a video and is used to

give the student feedback regarding his/her performance. The weak points and improvement areas in

terms of communication, attitude, knowledge, etiquettes and body language are shared with the student in

order to make corrective improvements.

2.1.5. Reflecting on the strategies adopted to increase/improve access for following categories of

students, enumerate on how the admission policy of the institution and its student profiles

demonstrate/reflect the National commitment to diversity and inclusion

SC/ST; OBC; Women ; Differently abled ;Economically weaker sections ;Minority

community ; Any other-

To increase /improve access for the above mentioned category of students for admission in the Institute,

following strategies are adopted:

1. The criteria for reservation in admission is displayed on Institute’s notice board. 2. During the process of admission, aspiring students are provided guidance

3. Students are informed about the scholarships, which are available to them from the

Government, through Notices on the Board and in the classrooms.

Details of category wise details of students admitted is given below:-

Category Students

Admitted

category wise

in 2012

Students

Admitted

category wise

in 2013

Students Admitted

category wise in

2014

Students

Admitted

category wise in

2015

SC 35 37 35 32

ST 0 0 1 1

Page 48: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

SEBC 36 60 52 49

Minority Jain 0 0 5 24

Minority –Muslims 3 16 25 43

Minority –Others -

Total category wise

diversified

communities

74 113 118 149

2.1.6. Provide the following details for various programmes offered by the institution during the

last four years and comment on the trends. i.e. reasons for increase / decrease and actions initiated

for improvement.

The institute’s intake was 40 students in year 2001. The intake is now 180 students in the first shift and 120 in the second shift. This itself shows that there is an increase in the demand for the MBA programme.

The Institute also launched a 5-year integrated AICTE approved Master’s in Applied Management(MAM) programme.

Programme Name 2012 2013 2014 2015

MBA 1st shift 180 180 180 180

MBA 2nd

shift 120 120 120 120

MCA 60 60 60 60

MAM 60 60 60

2.2. Catering to Student Diversity

2.2.1. How does the institution cater to the needs of differently-abled students and ensures

adherence to government policies in this regard?

Admissions to differently-abled students are given as per the norms prescribed by the Government. The

Institute provides necessary facilities/assistance to differently-abled students such as providing separate

seating arrangement at the ground floor.

2.2.2. Does the institution assess the students‟ needs in terms of knowledge and skills before the

commencement of the programme? If „yes‟, give details on the process?

Yes. During the first week of every odd semester, faculties engage in lectures for assessing student ‟

knowledge, needs and skills” as a part of EPDP Programme. Different activities like aptitude test, pros-

writing test, mock interviews, micro presentation, group discussions, and team building exercises are

conducted to assess their aptitude, communications skills, areas of interest and also weak areas. A

Page 49: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Diagnostic Test is conducted to assess the language proficiency of newly admitted students. Accordingly,

the institute takes further necessary steps to work on their weaknesses so as to develop them as efficient

professionals. Further, extra sessions are conducted by the specially engaged full-time Soft Skill Trainer

for developing the communication skills among students, their strengths and weaknesses are identified

appropriate remedial steps are taken.

2.2.3. What are the strategies drawn and deployed by the institution to bridge the knowledge gap of

the enrolled students to enable them to cope with the programme of their choice?

(Bridge/Remedial/Addon/Enrichment Courses, etc.)

At the beginning of the academic session, an intake analysis is done to identify the background of the

student. The students having done their graduation in science stream have no exposure towards subjects

like accounting. Special bridge courses covering the fundamentals of accounting are taught to them in the

beginning of the semester. Similarly, students who have studied in a medium other than English are

exposed to bridge courses on English language.

To further enable the students to cope with the programme and expose them to the corporate world, the

following co-curricular activities are conducted:

1. Vikalp-the case study forum: Students along with faculty members visit the corporate and study

different function areas of the company. The students are then supposed to write a report which is

available on the institute’s website.

2. Vimarsh – a platform of group discussion, where the students are promoted to indulge in group

discussions and present their views on different topics under the guidance of the faculty members.

3. Prashiksan is a short term immersion activity where both first and second year students can

undertake part time projects at top companies from the institute. This gives them a real-time

exposure in the job market and also creates an earning opportunity for them

4. Executive Personality Development Programme week (EPDP) is organized for first and second

year students where different sessions are taken by senior faculty members and external experts

on communication skills, clarity on subject concepts, interview etiquettes and body language,

how to present their views during group discussions and overall general knowledge.

5. A series of sessions are organized under the programmes called FINEX, HRX and MAX where

corporate people are invited from all over the country to share and interact with students their

views on upcoming topics in areas related to finance, human resource and marketing. This

enhances the knowledge of students and prepares them to face the corporate world. In these

programmes there are inbuilt modules of skill development, where the students get to work along

with industry practitioners and develop real time working skills.

6. A series of interactive sessions is organized every semester under the activity called –CRADLE

where successful first generation entrepreneurs are invited from SME’s to share their experiences with students which motivates them and helps develop their entrepreneurial skills so as to enable

them to start up their own business venture. Field visits for students are also conducted at the

entrepreneur’s organization to enhance understanding and learning.

2.2.4. How does the college sensitize its staff and students on issues such as gender, inclusion,

environment etc.?

Page 50: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

The institute organizes seminars on the gender sensitization, inclusion, environment in order to sensitise

its staff and students. The list of activities to achieve the same are mentioned below.

Women Development Cell: The Institute runs a Women Development Cell which works for issues on

women empowerment. Regular seminars are conducted on women rights and empowerment. Field

activities, like development work for destitute women in society, are also undertaken by the Cell for co-

ordination of such seminars and other women right awareness and development activities.

Green Council: The Institute has a Green Council that works to make the campus green. Initiatives like

sapling plantation and greenery mapping is done by students under the guidance of faculty and experts.

At the same time, paperless communication is promoted by actively using social networks and mobile

applications to facilitate communication with students and faculty members.

Prayas: The Institute runs an initiative called Prayas where underprivileged children from the nearby

slums are educated by the students of the institute under the guidance of a senior faculty member. Under

this initiative, during festivals gifts are collected from various places by the students working for Prayas

and are distributed among underprivileged children of the neighbouring areas.

2.2.5. How does the institution identify and respond to special educational/learning needs of

advanced learners?

Advanced learners fall in two categories:

1) Students from science background facing problems in Accounting and related subjects

2) Students who have pursued their education in a medium other than English

For the first type of students, elementary classes on accounting are taken before the commencement of the

semester in order to provide them with conceptual clarity.

For the second type of students, special sessions on English language are taken by a language trainer who

helps them in developing proficiency in reading, writing and speaking English.

2.2.6. How does the institute collect, analyze and use the data and information on the academic

performance (through the programme duration) of the students at risk of drop out (students from

the disadvantaged sections of society, physically challenged, slow learners, economically weaker

sections etc.)?

The institute is having a Student Mentorship Programme in order to enhance student academic

performance. The mechanism comprises of a senior faculty who acts as the Section Head for each class.

The Section Heads meet the students of respective sections twice a week to discuss academic and other

related issues. Every fifteen days individual subject faculty reports the student academic performance and

attendance to the respective Section Heads. Further, the Section Heads discuss each individual case with

the Dean and Director to take appropriate actions. Mentoring of the students is done by the Section Heads

and the Dean. For slow learners, additional sessions are arranged.

Apart from the Student Mentorship Programme following activities are also undertaken:

Institute maintains the data of student performance at the internal exams.

The data of their performance at the external exam is sent by the university to the

institute.

The students are given appropriate opportunities for taking part in various activities other

than teaching/learning i.e co-curricular activities.

The Sc, ST, SEBC and minorities students are informed in time about the financial

help/grant/scholarship available from the Government.

During examinations, physically challenged students, if any, are provided separate

seating arrangement at the ground floor.

Page 51: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Students from the economically weaker sections are helped out by arranging part-time

jobs/projects during the semesters under the activity called Prashiksan.

Slow learners are attached to the specific faculty for the necessary help/guidance.

2.3. Teaching-Learning Process:

2.3.1. How does the college plan and organise the teaching, learning and evaluation schedules?

(Academic calendar, teaching plan, evaluation blue print, etc.)

The academic year is divided into two semesters. The teaching – learning – evaluation schedule is

planned for the entire academic year to ensure that prescribed syllabus is completed and evaluation of the

learning process is done. The process of allocation of teaching work is done before the summer vacation.

Based on the University Calendar an academic schedule is prepared. The Institute designs its own

academic calendar (two-year calendar prepared and given to every student at the time of Induction). The

calendar contains the schedule of all the curricular, co-curricular and extracurricular events to be

organized in an academic year. The planning is done in a way that the syllabus is completed and the

events are organized for the overall development of the students.

At the beginning of each semester, each faculty member makes a subject-wise detailed academic plan

covering the session plan along with the means and methods used for delivery of the session. The session

plan is based upon the University’s syllabus which is followed throughout the semester. A

Comprehensive Evaluation Blue Print is prepared by the institute at the beginning of the academic year

containing various components like- class participation, assignment, project study, case study analysis,

quiz, class test and presentation. Using this evaluation blueprint, faculty members specify the topic

wise/module wise evaluation method in their academic plan. Besides the process of continuous evaluation

of students based upon these criteria, the mid-term examination is conducted every semester. A remedial

examination is scheduled for students failing in the regular exams. Every faculty, throughout the

semester, ensures that students are continuously learning through the chain of continuous evaluation

components and tools of pedagogy.

The Committee for Academic Excellence and Assessment, constituted by the Dean and the Director,

regularly monitors the planning and implementation of the academic plan and execution of evaluation

related activities. An academic review is also conducted at the end of the semester by this expert

committee. In this review, all faculty members are required to submit their subject file comprising of

sessions plan, scheme of evaluation, attendance records, assessment marks and documents showing the

activities given to students. The file is first reviewed by the team of senior faculty members to identify

discrepancies between the academic plan and its execution and then forwarded to the Committee for

futher action.

2.3.2. How does IQAC contribute to improve the teaching –learning process?

Though the institute has not established a formal IQAC but in pursuance of the Quality Policy the

institute has constituted an internal Quality Assurance Cell (QAC) for developing a system for consistent

improvement in overall performance of the institute. The QAC regularly meets for the discussion of

prospective plans for academic development. It makes suggestions to the Director/Management about the

desired development in the teaching–learning process. The Cell motivates the faculty to incorporate

innovative teaching methods and assessment strategies in the academic plan. Facilities like installation of

computers, internet facility, Wi-Fi connections, audio visual aids, sound amplifier system, updating of

library were created on the basis of the suggestions of the QAC.

Page 52: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

The Cell also comes up with innovative suggestions that enhance the teaching- learning process by way of

various co-curricular and extra-curricular activities. Activities like CRADLE (Capability Recognition and

Development Lessons for Entrepreneurship), MAX (Marketing Excellence Series), HRX (Human

Resource Excellence Series), FINEX (Finance Excellence Series) are some of the many activities that

have been implemented by way of suggestion from QAC. The suggestions are reviewed and

implemented, as and when found appropriate. The Cell also introduced a new monitoring mechanism

called Academic Review Process (ARP) from 2011-12. (Refer section 1.1.2)

2.3.3 How is learning made more student-centric? Give details on the support structures and

systems available for teachers to develop skills like interactive learning, collaborative learning and

independent learning among the students? .

With the motive of making learning more student centric, the institute provides various resources like wi-

fi enabled campus, hardware & software resources to cater to various needs of students and faculties as

well as a good infrastructure that acts as a platform for interactive, collaborative and independent

learning.

Besides the basic methods of class room teaching like delivering lectures, power point presentations, case

studies, group discussions and role plays, other interesting methods like live projects for students and

activities that give real time practical exposure to students are being regularly conducted at the institute.

This enables students to develop the interactive and collaborative learning related skills. Students are also

constantly motivated to read current articles from various magazines/journals available in the rich college

library as well as from other sources and then make presentation in the class room. This caters to the

independent learning skills.

The following are the details of some of the activities and support structures and systems to enhance the

entire learning process which serves as a combination of independent learning, collaborative learning as

well as develops independent learning skills in students:-

CRADLE (Capability Recognition and Development Lessons for Entrepreneurship) It is an initiative where the participant learns about entrepreneurship from successful industrialists. Its

broad objectives are to recognize the entrepreneurship capabilities of students and create opportunities for

development of entrepreneurship skills besides building long-term mutually beneficial relationships with

the SMEs and provide opportunities for experiential learning to students. It consists of a host of activities

as mentioned below.

Interactive sessions with the Chief Executive Officers/ Promoters of highly reputed small and medium

enterprises are organized regularly to promote entrepreneurship among students. Such sessions are not

conducted in the form of formal lectures, but more as informal interactions through experience sharing.

This given activity provides a good platform for students to develop the interactive learning skills.

Antrapreneur - The Business Incubator With the vision of promoting the spirit of entrepreneurship, Antrapreneur – The Business Incubator was

established. Its mission is to develop an institutional mechanism to create entrepreneurial culture among

the stakeholders and foster the growth of entrepreneurship in the campus. It is envisaged that students

participating in its activities will have a unique mind set which will make them “intrapreneurial” in the

organizations that they will join, making them a unique asset.

A series of activities were conducted by Antrepreneur – The Business Incubator, amongst which

noteworthy was START UP 24*7 – a start up week where more than 10000 students from Management,

Engineering, Computer Applications, Pharmacy, Commerce and Architecture were sensitized. More than

432 business ideas were generated. The students worked in cross specialization teams for better insights

and creativity. This activity not only develops the collaborative learning skills of students, but also helps

Page 53: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

them develop independent and interactive learning skills as the students are guided by a team of experts

and faculties as and when needed.

EXPLORE – the Industrial visits

Industrial Visit for students are regularly organized to different SMEs to provide students an opportunity

for experiential learning and research. The students then with the help of the faculty members and

industry experts make a report on the industry visited and also write a case study on the same. This

activity develops collaborative and interactive learning skills amongst students.

VIKALPA: It is a process in which a faculty member along with 10-15 students visit a company and then

collaborate to write a case study along with the students. It gives a chance to the student to jointly publish

with the faculty member and enhance learning.

XCEL (Excellent Cinema Enabled Learning) -The Movie Club

Xcel is the movie club at LJMBA that brings a new concept of "EDUTAINMENT". It means education

plus entertainment. Watching movies can also boost the locus of control of people and helps to stimulate

the self motivation power. It also relaxes the burden of the student. LJMBA has an auditorium where in

students gather and watch an educational movie and carry out discussions by establishing a link of the

movie with the management concepts and lessons learnt. As students prepare reports independently on the

movies and derive management lessons from the same, this activity develops the independent learning

skills in students.

Prashikshan - The Live Project Immersion

Prashikshan is a unique immersion programme where students undertake live projects in companies on a

part time basis. These projects include New Product Launch, Consumer Surveys, Distributor Surveys,

Auditing, Event Management, Client Acquisition, Customer Relationship Management, MIS, Training

and Development, financial planning etc. The students have in past undertaken and are currently working

on part time projects at Sharp, Central Mall, TCS, Bajaj Finserve, Planet Health, Coke, Tata Motors,

Airtel etc. Prashikshan offers a unique opportunity to students to augment their theoretical concepts with

real time learning. Students get a chance to hone their managerial skills besides getting opportunities to

successful network with the corporate world. Prashiskshan acts as a great platform to develop the

independent learning skills in students as they get a very good exposure to the functioning of various

industries.

SIP (Summer Internship Programme):

As a part of University’s curriculum, the students undergo a Summer Internship Programme in at the end

of the second semester in which they undergo practical work experience at various companies. The

students undergo the internship based upon their area of interest like finance, marketing or HRM. At the

end of the internship, students prepare a report on the training undergone and appear for a viva conducted

by the University. SIP develops independent learning skills as well as interactive learning skills in

students.

2.3.4. How does the institution nurture critical thinking, creativity and scientific temper among the

students to transform them into lifelong learners and innovators?

Instead of employing didactic method of teaching in the classroom, faculties try to carry out various

innovative methods for teaching. Case studies are presented not only by the faculties but also by the

students. Active analysis is done to reach practical conclusions. Thus, ability to think critically and

logically is developed in the students, which in turn helps them in practical experiences of life. Following

activities are regularly conducted at LJMBA for inculcating such skills among students:

Page 54: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

VIKALP: (The Case Study Forum)

Vikalp is the case study edition of LJMBA. Case studies are the widely used as the method of enhancing

the rational decision making power and practical thinking.

VIMARSH: (The forum for Group Discussion) Vimarsh is a collective amalgamation of Group discussion, Debates and Extempore speeches. Debates,

Group discussions and Extempore speeches have contributed to the development of humans right from

the age of Vedas and Upanishads. We are also continuing this tradition by envisaging Vimarsh at

LJMBA. Vimarsh is both learner-centric and subject-centric based upon three P's-Purpose, Planning and

Participation with two major determinants Leadership and Casualness.

REINCARNATION: (The Role Play) Role play is one of the most effective teaching methods for professional management education. It

sensitizes the upcoming managers with the hypothetical business situations.

MIND STEIN: (The Quiz Competition) The basic objective of MINDSTEIN is to provide a common platform to students to explore, hunt, build,

and cultivate their knowledge bank. The format of MINDSTEIN will include sections like corporate

knowledge, global corporate knowledge, general awareness, and industry specific information.

XCEL: (The Movie Club) XCEL is the movie club at LJMBA that brings a new concept of "EDUTAINMENT". Briefly explained

in section 2.3.3

PARIVARTAN: (The Extension Activity)

An initiative of LJMBA where students from the institute impart knowledge and enhance the skills of the

underprivileged kids of the slum and perform the recreational activity to spark their future. Various trips

and camps are organized to upgrade their overall knowledge and ignite the spark in them to know more.

Blood Donation camps and visits to the deprived sections of the society are regularly organized under this

extension activity.

ENVISAGE: Poster Making Competition The main objective of organizing the event is to provide an outlet to the students for demonstrating their

inherent creativity.

KSHITIJ: (The Wall Magazine) It provides an outlet for the creative talent of all LJ- ITES, besides serving as an instrument of

information sharing. This wall magazine also promotes the creativity along with sensitivity amongst the

students.

ARCHETYPE: The Management Model Competition This unique co-curricular activity of LJMBA is being organized since 2005 for all students of the first

year. It brings out the creativity of students by enabling them to give a physical shape to the management

concepts they learn in classes. The students prepare a business model along with a working prototype and

financial projections. They make a presentation of the entire business model to an expert jury of

entrepreneurs and experts who rate them and give them feedback. The motive of the activity is to promote

entrepreneurship and business sense among students.

Antrapreneur - The Business Incubator

Page 55: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

With the vision of promoting the spirit of entrepreneurship, Antrapreneur – The Business Incubator was

established. Briefly explained in section 2.3.3

Seminars

The institute conducts seminars of local, state and national levels regularly.

Recently, the Institute conducted a National Seminar on Entrepreneurship which was sponsored by All

India Council of Technical Education (AICTE), Gujarat Council for Science and Technology

(GUJCOST) and Department of Science and Technology (DST). The seminar consisted of interesting

themes like New Age Entrepreneurship, Successful Models in Entrepreneurship, Role of Incubators in

promoting Entrepreneurship, Role of Government Institutions in promoting Entrepreneurship, Role of

Academic Institutions in promoting entrepreneurship and Role of Media in promoting Entrepreneurship.

Experts from different institutions and streams had come share their views with the participants.

2.3.5. What are the technologies and facilities available and used by the faculty for effective

teaching? Eg: Virtual laboratories, e-learning -resources from National Programme on Technology

Enhanced Learning (NPTEL) and National Mission on Education through Information and

Communication Technology (NME-ICT), open educational resources, mobile education, etc.

The Institute uses LCD Projectors and other audio visual aids for classroom teaching as and when

required. The institute also has a computer lab enriched with various hardware and software resources for

statistical analysis, dedicated e-resources and e-journals for educational usage. The campus is wi-fi

enabled and also provides facilities like e-learning with the help of a satellite antenna. The institute has

developed videos in which the faculty members deliver lectures for making knowledge easily accessible

to the students. The institute is also enriched with open educational resources in the form of print & video

programmes developed by IGNOU.

The institute is also equipped with a Language Lab that acts as an e-platform to provide students tutorials

on various language learning skills like pronunciations, sentence formations, grammar and other vital

aspects of English language.

2.3.6. How are the students and faculty exposed to advanced level of knowledge and skills (blended

learning, expert lectures, seminars, workshops etc.)?

In order to provide an exposure of practical knowledge to the students, experts in different fields are

invited to the institute to share their experiences and views in respective areas. Faculty members regularly

attend and present research papers on varied subjects in seminars/conferences at state, national and

international level. The details of such activities and programmes conducted at the institute are as

follows:-

Marketing Excellence Series (MAX)

The Institute wanted to promote marketing skills at work place among students, and as a part of that

initiative, the institute created MAX, under which, the institute planned a series of interactions with

successful marketing professionals from the industry and academia, sharing their experiences of

marketing successes and failures. The speakers shared their experiences in the following areas: New

Launches, Product and Brand Management, Marketing strategies and programmes, IMC strategies,

Branding Strategies,Sales and Distribution Management, Positioning Strategies, CRM Strategies and

Marketing Research.

Finance Excellence Series (FINEX) LJMBA conceived the idea of organizing FINEX series in order to bridge the gap between the academic

learning through pre designed course curriculum and corporate expectations which arises due to time and

resources constraints. In order to strengthen the domain knowledge of finance and to expose the students

to practices in the arena of financial markets and services, LJMBA has initiated an innovative programme

Page 56: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

the “Finance Excellence Series” (FINEX). It is a structured lecture series, designed to include interactive

sessions delivered by industry experts, spread over a few days catering to Corporate Finance, Banking,

Insurance and Capital Market respectively. The vital objective of this series is to provide a platform for

the holistic development of budding financial managers.

Human Resource Management Excellence Series (HRX) In order to give an experiential learning to the management students about common HR practices as well

as a proper knowhow on how the corporate world functions, LJMBA came up with the idea of HRX in

which various dignitaries holding a strong position in the HR department from various companies are

invited to share their experiences and knowledge with our students.

Capability Recognition and Development Lessons for Entrepreneurship (CRADLE) It is an initiative where the participant learns about entrepreneurship from successful industrialists. Its

broad objectives are to recognize the entrepreneurship capabilities of students and create opportunities for

development of entrepreneurship skills besides building long-term mutually beneficial relationships with

the SMEs and provide opportunities for experiential learning to students.

Seminars The institute understands the needs for advanced learning not only for students to shape them as better

professionals, but also for faculty members to make them well equipped with the latest developments and

knowledge in the field of management. As a result, the institute focuses on organising such seminars that

not only add value, but also necessary skills among students and faculties for their growth.

The institute regularly conducts faculty seminars in which the faculties actively participate and come up

with various innovative presentations on management related as well as general topics. This given forum

is followed by group discussions and value addition is thus done by all the faculties on the topic taken by

the presenter.

The Institute conducted a National seminar on Entrepreneurship which was sponsored by All India

Council of Technical Education (AICTE), Gujarat Council for Science and Technology (GUJCOST) and

Department of Science and Technology (DST). The seminar consisted of interesting themes like New

Age Entrepreneurship, Successful Models in Entrepreneurship, Role of Incubators in promoting

Entrepreneurship, Role of Government Institutions in promoting Entrepreneurship, Role of Academic

Institutions in promoting entrepreneurship and Role of Media in promoting Entrepreneurship. Experts

from different institutions and streams had come to share their views with the participants.

2.3.7. Detail (process and the number of students \benefitted) on the academic, personal and

psycho-social support and guidance services (professional counseling/mentoring/academic advise)

provided to students?

Academic Advice and Student Mentorship Programme: Student counselling is done at several

levels. In order to provide counselling and mentoring by maintaining one-to-one interaction with

students, the institute has designed a unique Section Head mechanism wherein each senior faculty

member is assigned one class of 60 students. The Section Head is one contact point for students

who regularly interact with the students. They provide personal and academic counselling,

monitor attendance, overall progress, and help them overcome challenges (if any). The entire

class of 60 students benefits from this programme.

Career Counselling: Students are given career counselling in various ways.

It starts with the induction of first year students where diagnostic test and mock interviews

are conducted to determine their IQ, communication skills, group discussion, resume

building, interview skill and other soft skills. Based on the findings of the test and the mock

interviews, students are groomed likewise.

Page 57: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Students are counselled for the Summer Internship Project (SIP) at the end of their first year.

This is their first corporate immersion experience. They are oriented about corporate

professionalism, etiquettes, punctuality and ethics. Their interest and aptitude for the subject

is checked and accordingly they are counselled to opt for a particular specialization.

For the final placement, the Placement Team conducts mock interviews (video recorded) at

the beginning of the third semester and guides students about relevant job profiles and career

options. The alumni also actively participate in counseling students about the market

scenario. Placement Team also trains the students in resume writing, facing interviews,

making presentation, selection of industry and salary negotiation.

2.3.8. Provide details of innovative teaching approaches/methods adopted by the faculty during the

last four years? What are the efforts made by the institution to encourage the faulty to adopt new

and innovative approaches and the impact of such innovative practices on student learning?

Besides the regular class-room teaching methods like delivering lectures, power point presentations, case

studies, group discussions and role plays, the faculties also adopt innovative teaching approaches like peer

learning, live projects and live case studies and take students for educational trips to various industries to

give them a real time exposure to different areas of management. The details are as follows:-

Name of

Innovative

Programme

conducted

Name of faculty

conducting the

programme

Objective of the

programme

Outcome of the

programme on student

learning

Opinionated Case

Study Dr. Siddharth Das

To enhance class

participation and learning

Better understanding of the

concepts

XCEL

Dr. Abhinava S.

Singh, Prof. Kiran

Khatri

Management lessons

(Strategic Management, Sales

& Distribution Management,

etc) from select movies.

Better understanding of the

subject

Envisage

Disha Mehta and

Neha Mehta

To make students learn

managerial aspects and

display their creativity

Brainstorming, out of the

box thinking, skill

development, creativity,

logical thinking, team

work, knowledge

enhancement, awareness

about the topic

Experiential

Exercise on What is

Strategy?

Dr. Abhinava S.

Singh

To encourage the use of

creativity and imagination to

interpret the term strategy

Helps them broaden their

perspective on the concept

of strategy and builds their

diagnostic learning skills

Self Positioning

Statement

Dr. Abhinava S.

Singh

To help them understand the

concept of brand positioning

through their own example

Help them understand,

appreciate, and apply brand

positioning in real-life

situations

Page 58: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Live Research

Projects Mehul Yogi

To impart real-life research

exposure along with

classroom teaching

Understanding on research

technique and data analysis

using latest software

Cue cards

Dr. Sushant

Nagpal

To provide the students a

great study aid to memorize

the concepts using cues and

increase their communication

skills by present on the same

in a simpler words for 1-2

minutes.

Improved presentation

skills and enhanced

understanding of the

technical concepts.

News Room Dr. Neha Shah

Relate theory with practice

and enable to analyse

business environment

Exposure to analysis of

current events

Theater Workshop Dr. Neha Shah Soft skill development

Improved ability to face the

audience among the

participating students

Flash cards

Dr. Sushant

Nagpal

To bring outer world 'into'

the classroom

Provided fastest and easiest

way to learn and remember

new information

Peer Learning Dr. Anitha Sunil

The students were divided in

groups. They were required

to solve the sums in groups

and were required to learn

from each other. This

technique was used in

following subjects:

quantitative analysis in

semester I and operations

research in semester II. The

objective was learner to

learner teaching and better

understanding of the concept

Other than the faculty

teaching in the class,

students learned a lot from

their batch mates

Live stock market

trading Prof. Sweety Shah

To make students aware

about the functionality of

Secondary Capital Market.

Helped students to know

about the real time trading

system of NSE and BSE

exchange.

Film Review Dr. Neha Shah

Making Complex ethical

issues easy to understand

Understanding ethical

issues faced by business

and developed ability of

critical analysis

Designing a training

programme HIMANI SHETH

conceptual clarity on

Training and development (

A textbook topic )

The students got to

understand how the

training programmes are

designed and could analyze

Page 59: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

pros and cons involved in

doing the same

Use of comic book

(Adventures of

Asterix) Dr. Neha Shah

Making complex economic

phenomenon of rise and

collapse of market easy to

understand Concepts were conveyed

Finance Literacy

test

Dr. Priyanka

Pathak, Prof.

Sweety Shah,

Prof. Kiran Khatri,

Prof. Dhara Shah,

Prof. Disha Mehta,

Prof. Reshma

Pilai, Dr. Sushant

Nagpal, Prof.

Rajni Mehta

To check the knowledge of

the students pertaining to

basics of finance and

financial terminology.

To check the knowledge of

the students pertaining to

basics of finance and

financial terminology.

1. Scrap Book on an

International Theme

2. International

weekly news

sharing

3. Movie Analysis, Dr. Manisha Jalla

1. Scrap book programme

was introduced to widen the

horizens of students opting

for International business on

any theme with international

context, related to sports or

political relations, war and

terrorism, business

2. International weekly news

sharing was introduced to

keep students updated on

developments on the

international front.

3. Movie analysis was used

in strategic management to

ensure how concepts

discussed in movie relate to

strategy

All the programmes

ensured that students got

exposed to much wider

knowledge beyond their

books and were updated on

current development in the

world. It was led to

significant improvement in

their analytical skills and

ability to apply the

concepts studied in the

class to the real world of

business.

Scrap book making

in the subject of

Integrated

Marketing

Communication

related to

advertising of

students' chosen

brand Prof. Neha Mehta

Students must learn how

marketing communication

has evolved

subject knowledge,

creativity, brand and

advertising knowledge

Ad Making Prof. Neha Mehta

learning nuances of ad

making

learning entire process of

the subject IMC

Page 60: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

2.3.9. How are library resources used to augment the teaching-learning process?

The institute has a rich library containing over 20000 books, 35 magazines 69 journals and 659 CDs &

DVDs. All these resources are effectively used by the faculties as well as students for the teaching and

learning process. The Library is maintained in a regular and prompt manner. The Librarian guides the

students to the relevant sections where books of different subjects are kept. The College has formed a

Library Development committee comprising faculty members who regularly keep the library updated

with the necessary resources. The Committee actively monitors provision of services at the Library and

enrichment of resources by acquisition of new titles and subscription of required journals. Latest

catalogues of publishers are given to the committee for selection of new titles. The library also has a

section that constitutes of all the comprehensive project reports as well as summer internship project

reports carried out by the past batch students in a classified form. This provides a guideline for all the new

students who are carrying out such projects for the first time on how to conduct a research and write a

report on the same.

The library is accessible to all the students as well as faculties on all the working days. Students and

faculties can procure books and journals for specific time intervals and also get the same renewed as and

when needed. Library is also enabled with multimedia computer systems that make the learning process

easier and effective for all the users. Besides this, a computer is also installed with statistical software for

data analysis (SYSTAT).

2.3.10. Does the institution face any challenges in completing the curriculum within the planned

time frame and calendar? If „yes‟, elaborate on the challenges encountered and the institutional

approaches to overcome these.

As the admissions of students to MBA/MCA programmes are finalized by a centralized body (ACPC),

hence there is a delay in completion of the admission procedure, which results in delayed commencement

of academic activities of the first semester by four to six weeks. As a result the institute faces the

challenge of dealing with the syllabus prescribed by the university in a reduced time period. The institute

arranges for extra sessions for each subject in order to overcome the time constraint and give proper

justice to the curriculum.

The other challenge is the problem encountered by first year students on facing the rigours of post

graduation after having come from under graduation. To acclimatize and assist them, the institute every

year carries out an Induction Programme for the first year students in order to make them feel comfortable

and help them get used to the new challenge concerning their academic career. The Induction programme

talks about the syllabus, co-curricular and extra activities, infrastructure support available and other

facilities the student can avail. The amount of rigour and effort required from the student is also

highlighted along with an insight about student life on the campus. The faculties constantly guide, counsel

and motivate them in order to adapt to the new environment quickly.

In order to make the entire system more effective, the institute has designed a Student Mentorship

Programme. Under this Programme all the students in different sections are allotted mentors (a senior

faculty member) in the form of Section Heads whom students can contact in case of any queries or

problems, and the Section Heads in turn guide and help them resolve their problems.

2.3.11. How does the institute monitor and evaluate the quality of teaching learning?

The institute has put in place a number of systems for constant monitoring and evaluation of teaching-

learning. At the beginning of each semester all faculty members are required to prepare an academic plan,

Page 61: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

comprising of sessions plan, teaching methods and evaluation strategies. In order to make the entire

system more channelized and effective, the institute has formulated a mechanism called Academic

Review Process (ARP). A committee comprising of senior faculty members evaluates the academic plan

and give suggestions wherever required to improve the teaching learning process. During the semester the

committee monitors the status of each and every subject covered by the respective faculty members. It

also gives suggestions for improvising the means and methods adopted to teach the subject. Towards end

of the semester an audit is done by the committee followed by an expert committee. A qualitative analysis

of how the syllabus has been communicated to the students, activities in which students were involved as

per the syllabus requirement and other such related matters are discussed.

There is also a qualitative feedback mechanism where the section heads take feedback of the faculty from

a group of students. They identify what are the strength and the weakness of the faculty member and how

can the teaching learning process be improved. There is also a Student Feedback Mechanism, at the end

of every semester, where all students are required to rate the faculty on various dimensions related to

effective teaching. A feedback is also taken from parents on the quality of teaching, infrastructure of the

institute and the learning processes at the institute. The institute also takes measures in order to improve

the educational processes based upon the student and parent feedback. This mechanism has brought about

remarkable improvement in the quality of teaching learning.

2.4. Teacher Quality:

2.4.1. Provide the following details and elaborate on the strategies adopted by the college in

planning and management (recruitment and retention) of its human resource (qualified and

competent teachers) to meet the changing requirements of the curriculum.

Lok Jagruti Kendra focuses on merit and academic competence as the main criteria for recruitment of

faculty. The detailed process is listed below:

In case of recruitment of any faculty, an advertisement is published in the local

English and Gujarati dailies.

After receiving applications, the institute invites eligible prospective candidates

for delivering demonstration lectures to judge their performance in class and for

an informal evaluation of other abilities. At the same time, the candidates also

interact with the Director and the Managing Trustee. Based on such informal

interactions, candidates are short-listed and appointed on an ad-hoc basis.

Candidates are constantly monitored and reviewed during this provisional tenure.

The formal procedure for recruitment in affiliated colleges is as per the norms

and regulations laid down in the Statutes and Ordinances of the University and

Department of Higher Education, Gujarat State. The candidates face their

interviews in a duly constituted interview committee, and thereby are endorsed

by the University.

Retention of faculties is also given importance and various schemes are developed by the institute to

support the same. Faculty Mentorship Programme is one such scheme under which the newly appointed

faculties are allocated an internal mentor, who constantly guide and support them in carrying out their

duties. Hence, it helps to make the environment conducive for the new faculty and develops his/her skills

for teaching at the PG level.

Highest

Qualification

Professor Associate

Professor

Assistant

Professor

Total

Page 62: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Male Female Male Female Male Female

Permanent teachers

D.Sc. / D. Litt. 0 0 0 0 0 0 0

Ph.D. 2 0 5 4 1 3 15

M.Phil. 0 0 0 0 0 0 0

PG 1 0 0 0 4 16 21

Temporary teachers : 4 (Appointment yet to be endorsed by University)

Part-time teachers : NIL

2.4.2 How does the institution cope with the growing demand/ scarcity of qualified senior faculty to

teach new programmes/ modern areas (emerging areas) of study being introduced (Biotechnology,

IT, Bioinformatics etc.)? Provide details on the efforts made by the institution in this direction and the outcome during the last three years.

The institution believes in developing internal resources and promoting existing faculties. For this

purpose, various initiatives are undertaken. The management promotes research related activities, as a

result of which majority faculties are pursuing their Doctoral studies. Faculties are also encouraged to

update their knowledge by way of attending workshops/ conferences/ seminars at the state, national and

international level. IT & Library resources, as required, are made available. The recruitment process also

takes into account the level to which the candidate has updated his knowledge in his domain. Moreover,

Faculty Mentorship Programme helps the new faculties in adjusting with the ambience and develops their

skills which are required to teach at the Post-graduate level. The newly appointed faculties under this

scheme are assigned a senior faculty in the role of a mentor by the Director for an initial period of two

years. This scheme includes academic guidance, development of materials and delivery strategies,

learning new tools and methods and also gives a scope for collaborative research. At the end of the term,

the mentors are required to submit a report regarding the progress of the mentee to the Director. Similarly,

mentees shall also give a feedback report to the Director.

2.4.3 Providing details on staff development programmes during the last four years elaborate on

the strategies adopted by the institution in enhancing the teacher quality.

a) Nomination to staff development programmes:

Academic Staff Development Programmes Number of faculty

Nominated

Refresher courses 0

HRD programmes 3

Orientation programmes 5

Page 63: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Staff training conducted by the university 5

Staff training conducted by other institutions 1

Summer / winter schools, workshops, etc. 26

b) Faculty Training programmes organized by the institution to empower and enable the use of various

tools and technology for improved teaching-learning

Teaching learning methods/approaches

Handling new curriculum

Content/knowledge management

Selection, development and use of enrichment materials

Assessment

Cross cutting issues

Audio Visual Aids/multimedia

OER’s

Teaching learning material development, selection and use

Regular interactions take place between the Director and faculties, wherein the Director spends

considerable time in mentoring the newly appointed faculties and motivating them to undertake

research and involve in continuous improvement.

A full-fledged Faculty Mentorship Programme is in place, wherein the newly appointed faculties

are allocated domain specific senior professor as Mentors for a minimum period of two years.

The objective is to make the new faculties comfortable in the work set-up and aid them in

delivering lectures in a better manner by suggesting appropriate pedagogical tools and materials.

This scheme includes academic guidance, development of materials and delivery strategies,

learning new tools and methods and also gives a scope for collaborative research. At the end of

the term, the mentors are required to submit a report regarding the progress of the mentee to the

Director. Systemic feedback is obtained from both Mentors and Mentees in prescribed formats.

Faculties are nominated for several Faculty Development Programmes to enhance their

knowledge and skills. Research is actively promoted such that faculties are motivated in writing

research papers and attending conferences on National and International level.

Faculty Seminars are organized on a periodic basis, wherein faculties disseminate information

related to their domain areas and latest updates, research and its nuances and other topics of

academic interest which can enhance teaching skills and widen their perspective.

Salt Workshops are held for informal interaction of faculties, wherein faculties present their

interest areas which become a value addition for the faculties and also help in all-round

development of the students.

Introduced the regular use of LCD projectors to make teaching more effective and focused.

Access of the Internet has been provided to the faculty which enables them to give websites and

connecting links to students, thus encouraging them to gather a storehouse of information and

knowledge, and share the latest information with students.

Library facilities, especially the latest journals and magazines facilitate the faculties in updating

themselves with the latest material pertaining to their areas, which are distributed among the

students.

The institute motivates and provides linkages for visits to industries by faculties and students.

These visits are conducted regularly, allowing students to get firsthand experience of such units.

Page 64: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Faculty interactions with the Director take place on a regular basis, and effective pedagogical

tools are identified for teaching specific topics. Hence, various methods of role-play, group

discussion and case study discussion are used extensively.

The institute has a well equipped Computer Laboratory and it is managed by a full-time technical person.

Though the institute has not devised a formal training programme for its faculty in computer usage, yet

the entire faculty is computer savvy and Internet friendly. For developing listening skills and

conversational skills, the faculty is fully equipped to handle all kinds of multi-media aids like OHP, LCD

projectors, multi-media systems. Faculties are also duly trained to use advanced packages like SPSS for

individual research and also in classes.

c) Percentage of faculty

Invited as resource persons in Workshops / Seminars / Conferences organized by external

professional agencies

40% i.e. 10 out of 39 faculty members have been invited as resource persons in Workshops /

Seminars / Conferences organized by external professional agencies participated in external

Workshops / Seminars / Conferences recognized by national/ international professional

bodies

77% i.e. 30 out of 39 faculty members have participated in external Workshops / Seminars /

Conferences recognized by national/ international professional bodies. presented papers in

Workshops / Seminars / Conferences conducted or recognized by professional agencies

40% i.e. 16 out of 39 faculty members have presented papers in Workshops / Seminars /

Conferences conducted or recognized by professional agencies.

2.4.4 What policies/systems are in place to recharge teachers? (e.g.: providing research grants,

study leave, support for research and academic publications teaching experience in other national

institutions and specialized programmes industrial engagement etc.)

Several positive steps are taken by the institution for recharging teachers. The L.J. Journal of Research

and Studies (LJJRS) is being published as a step to encourage and facilitate research. Faculty members

are sanctioned duty leave to attend seminars, deliver lectures and to represent the institute at other

institutions of national importance. The relevant data of last five years is as follows [2010-11 onwards]:

S.No. Particulars Number*

1 Seminars attended by faculty 86

2 Papers presented by faculty 47

3 Papers published in magazines 95

4 Invited as keynote speaker or chair person / 27

5 Articles/ columns in newspapers 264

6 Position held at academic association/university 13

7 Further academic courses completed/pursuing 34

8 No. of Books authored/co-authored 11

Page 65: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

2.4.5 Give the number of faculty who received awards / recognition at the state, national and

international level for excellence in teaching during the last four years. Enunciate how the

institutional culture and environment contributed to such performance/achievement of the faculty.

The institute motivates and provides support to the faculty for achieving excellence, and many of

our faculty members have been recognized by outside agencies for their contributions in the area

of academics and social activities. For example, many of our teachers have been awarded prizes

for Best Papers at various seminars and conferences as is evident from personal profiles of faculty

members. Similarly, papers/articles contributed to journals have been awarded Best Paper Prizes.

The institute also supports innovations, as a result of which Dr. Siddarth Singh Bist was

felicitated by GTU with the award for Innovation in Pedagogy. This was specifically given for the

activity CRADLE (Capability Recognition and Development Lessons in Entrepreneurship),

wherein first generation entrepreneurs were invited to speak about their journey, share their

experiences and solve queries related to entrepreneurship.

As a matter of fact, there is an in-house body named L.J. Innovation Council, which is entrusted

with the task of undertaking various initiatives. Some of them which are in current practice are

FINEX (Financial Excellence Series), MAX (Marketing Excellence Series), HREX (HR

Excellence Series), EPDP (Executive Personality Development Programme), etc.

From the academic year 2015, the Institute took an initiative of promoting a culture conducive to

learning and introduced Director’s award for Academic Excellence, wherein top six faculty members (who consistently scored high on student feedback) were awarded trophies.

2.4.6 Has the institution introduced evaluation of teachers by the students and external Peers? If

yes, how is the evaluation used for improving the quality of the teaching-learning process?

Faculty Feedback system is in place, wherein at the end of each semester, students are asked to

rate the faculties in the formats specially designed keeping in mind the important factors involved

in the process of teaching and learning. After the calculation of final rating, faculties have a one-

on-one meeting with the Director and they discuss the areas of improvement.

Academic Audit Report is also prepared, wherein at periodic intervals during each semester,

faculties meet the Director and discuss their session plan, coverage of topics, pedagogical tools,

materials used, details of projects/assignments and other components of internal evaluation. It

gives scope to compare the plans of the faculties to what they have actually done in class, and the

faculties can make suggestions for improving the lecture delivery in class.

External experts are also called for evaluation of faculties of MCA programme. For the past 6 years,

LJMCA has relied on an annual “Faculty Appraisal System” – to serve the purpose of not only allowing

the Institute to internally assess faculty performances on an annual basis, but also to identify key

elements that can assist in growth of individual faculty members. The self Appraisal format provides for

recording the data of participation of the faculty in a wide range of activities. The intention, is to indicate

a wide spectrum of activities and functions in which members of the faculty can gainfully involve

themselves, and to elicit information on their participation in them. The Faculty members are required to

provide their achievements and any supporting document with the faculty appraisal form. A panel

consisting of Head of the Institute and experts from renowned organization evaluate the faculty

members on parameters like Teaching Proficiency, Communication skill, Research and

development etc. The Head of the institute holds separate meeting with each faculty member to discuss

the final scores and identify the action plan for further improvement.

2.5. Evaluation Process and Reforms

Page 66: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

2.5.1. How does the institution ensure that the stakeholders of the institution especially students

and faculty are aware of the evaluation process?

As a part of the orientation programme, the first year students are informed about the overall evaluation

pattern that is prescribed by the University. The detailed evaluation scheme is communicated to the

students in the beginning of the semester for each subject. The students are informed about the weightage

of internal and external assessment, probable dates of examination, as well as continuous evaluation

components. All this information is personally communicated to students in respective classes, and also

displayed on the Notice Board. The following scheme of marks and evaluation distribution for each

subject is as per university guidelines:

A. Continuous evaluation component (CEC) (Projects/ Assignments/ Quizzes/ Individual or group

Presentation/ Class participation/ Case studies etc): Weightage 50 Marks (Internal Assessment)

B. Mid-Semester examination: Weightage 30 Marks (Internal Assessment)

C. End –Semester Examination: Weightage 70 Marks (External Assessment)

As the students are already informed about the evaluation process, they need to follow the system

thoroughly. The continuous assessment is carried out by faculty members to find the chronic defaulters.

For such students, the parents are invited to meet the institute head. The whole evaluation process and its

importance are explained to the parents. For more details, the faculty members may interact with parents

to discuss where the student is not following the evaluation process norms which make him / her serious

defaulter. The parents are made aware of the consequences which may be faced by their son/ daughter,

being a serious defaulter.

Faculty meetings are organized in the beginning of every academic year to discuss and finalize the

evaluation plan. So each faculty is aware of evaluation process which needs to be followed by them.

While the institution prepares a comprehensive list of continuous evaluation components, faculty

members have the freedom to choose specific components and also to innovate. [Annexure-1: List of

continuous evaluation components] The faculty also knows that they will be evaluated at the end of the

semester by students whom they have taught.

2.5.2. What are the major evaluation reforms of the university that the institution has adopted

and what are the reforms initiated by institution on its own?

The university has introduced many reforms in the evaluation system.

Summer Internship viva which was earlier conducted at the institute by internal examiners is now

conducted at the University by the external examiners.

Freedom has been given to the institutes in respect of the continuous evaluation component and conduct

of internal examination.

E-assessment has also been introduced where answer sheets are scanned and uploaded on the University

portal. The faculty evaluates them online and submits the result.

In 2014-15, the University has initiated the process of reforms in question paper format.

The University has prescribed installation of CCTV cameras in all rooms of an examination centre.

Examination centres are required to send the CD of CCTV footage to the University along with answer

sheets every day.

Page 67: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

In a major departure from the traditional way of conducting examination, the University has stopped the

practice of sending printed question papers of semester-end examinations to the examination centres. The

University sends encrypted CDs of the question papers to the examination centres in advance. The

examination has to do the decryption with the help of the password received on the registered

institutional mobile number about 40 minutes before the commencement of the examination, and print the

required number of copies in the presence of the University Observer.

The institute has also initiated some reforms in evaluation pattern within limits of university guidelines.

Before the semester begins, the subject faculties of same area or same subject discuss and brainstorm

about the innovative methods of teaching and evaluation. The continuous evaluation components are

designed by each subject faculty and the weightage is also decided by them. The various continuous

evaluation components includes- class test/quiz, Group projects presentation, live project study,

assignment etc. The Institute has also brought changes in the paper style of internal examination by

incorporating multiple choice questions, application-based questions and case studies. The faculty has

devised innovative question paper pattern and submitted the draft to the University for the Examinations

to be conducted by it.

2.5.3. How does the institution ensure effective implementation of the evaluation reforms of the

university and those initiated by the institution on its own?

In order to ensure proper and effective implementation of the University guidelines/

instructions/.reforms, the institute has designated a senior faculty member as GTU Coordinator.

The institute voluntarily accepts the role of examination centre for all semester-end examinations of GTU.

As per the university norms and requirements, the institute has installed CCTV cameras in all the rooms

and corridors of the building.

The faculty is involved in paper setting and evaluation of answer scripts. The institute actively

participates in the workshops conducted by the University for evaluation related matter, especially those

connected with reforms.

In the year 2014 Vice Chancellor of the University introduced a new reform in the examination system by

suggesting introduction of a new question paper format. Various meetings of Directors and Deans were

conducted at the University level regarding the same. The institute actively participated in all the

meetings. After several brainstorming sessions between senior faculty members of some select institutes,

including ours, a new question paper format was introduced. The faculty of the institute played an

instrumental role in this process by not only suggesting and finalising the new pattern of question paper

but also designing sample papers based on the format. The same were uploaded on the university’s website.

All faculty members are required to prepare an academic plan comprising sessions plan, delivery

strategies, and scheme of evaluation and library resources at the start of the semester. The mid-semester

examination and continuous evaluation components are monitored by the institute for effective

implementation. The mechanism of Academic Review Process regularly monitors the planning and

outcome of the evaluation process.

As a part of ARP two reviews, mid-semester and end-semester, are conducted. In the Mid semester Audit

the ARP committee along with the Dean interacts with faculty members to know the progress as per the

academic plan. At the end of semester another review is done. At the time of review all faculty members

are required to produce the status on academic plan, attendance records and appropriate supporting

documents.

Page 68: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

The MCA department has pioneered an On Demand Examination(ODE) to improve quality of continuous

learning and to measure of the student performance. In this students get a chance to select online the

examination they want to take and then can appear in it on a day of their choice.

Three to four ODEs are conducted every semester. Each ODE is conducted for two weeks and a gap

of one week is maintained between two ODEs. A committee comprising faculty members has been

formed in order to coordinate various activities of ODE. Faculty members and student volunteers

have designed and developed a software application for automating various tasks related to it.

Faculty members submit syllabus of their respective subjects a couple of weeks prior to the scheduled

duration of the each examination. Subject faculty members announce the syllabus in the class and the

ODE committee displays the same on the notice board. Students register themselves along with their

preferred dates for appearing in examination of each subject using the software. The faculty members

send six question paper sets to the ODE committee at least one week prior to the scheduled

examination period. Each question paper is of twenty eight marks with time duration of fifty five

minutes.

After the examinations, the ODE committee allocates the answer sheets to faculty members of

respective subjects for evaluation. The faculty members evaluate the answer sheets and return them

along with the mark sheets to administrative office within two working days of allocation.

The marks are entered into the ODE software by the administrative staff and evaluated answer sheets

are returned to the students. In case of any discrepancy in the evaluated answer sheets, the students

contact the ODE committee, and the committee get those answer sheets re evaluated by subject

faculty members.

2.5.4. Provide details on the formative and summative assessment approaches adopted to measure

student achievement. Cite a few examples which have positively impacted the system.

The continuous evaluation components are used as formative assessment approaches and internal mid-

semester exam is considered as summative assessment approach.

As part of formative assessment approach, the continuous evaluation components and their respective

marks are decided prior to commencement of semester. The students are also informed about the same

and the evaluation for each component takes place regularly as decided. The marks achieved by the

students are also communicated to them after the accomplishment of each evaluation component. This has

created the positive impact because the students know in advance about their performance and they get a

time and chance to improve upon it. If any student has not completed work for assigned evaluation

components, the corrective actions are taken for them. This formative assessment approach helps in

ensuring continuous participation of students in each subject during the semester.

The formative assessment approach is also adopted for the Global Country Studies Research (GCSR)

project and comprehensive project (CP). This approach ensures regular research work being carried by

students along with timely submission. This approach helps to maintain and monitor the quality of project

of students.

As part of summative assessment approach, the mid-semester exam is carried out at the institute where

the exam paper focuses more on application-based questions, and its practical implications. The answer

sheets are discussed with students to make them understand their mistakes and the scope of improvement

is also suggested to the students. As the exam is conducted at mid of the semester, students get time to

understand the concepts again where the improvement is suggested.

For the Global Country Studies Research (GCSR) project and Comprehensive Project (CP), the report

submission along with presentation is taken as a part of summative approach. The student presentations

Page 69: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

are conducted by faculty members and suggestions are given to them along with assessment. These

suggestions help them improve their project to be submitted to the University.

2.5.5. Detail on the significant improvements made in ensuring rigor and transparency in the

internal assessment during the last four years and weightages assigned for the overall development

of students (weightage for behavioural aspects, independent learning, communication skills etc)

The internal assessment which happens at the institute is divided in two parts: CEC-continuous evaluation

component (50 Marks) and Mid-semester Exam (30 Marks). The marks distribution and evaluation

pattern for each components of CEC is discussed in advance with the students. The students are also

given probable dates for the accomplishment of respective components of CEC. By providing all the

information about evaluation to students the transparency is maintained. To ensure the rigor of internal

assessment, as the activity takes place, the students are evaluated, their scores are announced and a

feedback is given. The CEC gives weightage to behavioural aspects like attendance, class participation

and discipline, independent/group learning aspects like projects, assignments and viva and

communication skills like presentations, etc. Mid-exam is conducted at the institute by the faculty

members. To ensure transparency in paper setting, there is a common paper for all sections drawn by

faculty members teaching the same subject. The marks are displayed on notice board and the students are

allowed to see their evaluated answer scripts, and also discuss the same with the concerned faculty.

2.5.6. What are the graduate-attributes specified by the college/ affiliating university? How does

the college ensure the attainment of these by the students?

As per the affiliating university guidelines, it is mandatory for the student to maintain 75 % attendance.

The Institute have its own attendance monitoring mechanism were a student is given 12 leaves per year

and that too with prior approval from the section head. In case any student is defaulting on this attendance

criteria, his/her name is displayed on the notice. If the attendance criterion at term end is not met, the

examination forms of the student is withdrawn and not sent to the university.

The assessment pattern for MBA programme comprises a module of a final semester-end examination

carried out by the Gujarat Technological University and internal evaluation by the college as well. All the

subjects have 70 marks of GTU’s final exam(E), 30 marks of mid –semester college exam(M) and 50

marks of internal assessment/Continuous Evaluation Component.(I). Constant analysis of assignment,

seminars, quizzes, attendance, regularity and behaviour takes place by the concerned faculty who decides

the scheme of assessment and announces at the beginning of the term.(semester)

The passing norm is minimum 50 % of marks in each individual head of University exam, mid semester

exam and internal assessment /Continuous Evaluation Component.(I) for all the subjects. In case of the

backlog(less than 50% marks in any component); whenever student clears the component, only

50%marks (max) is considered out of total marks for the subjects /head.

There is one mid-semester examination in a semester for University exam as well as remedial test. In case

of failure to clear the remedial, student has to appear in the regular semester test in the subsequent year.

Student having more than 4 backlogs after declaration of remedial exam result is not allowed for further

studies till he/she clears backlog/s; so as total number of backlogs are not more than 4. The weight age

given in the syllabus is for the guidance only.

After adding the internal marks with the marks secured by the student in the University examination, the

marks will be converted to a letter grade as per the following:

1. 85 -100 marks - AA grade

2. 75 - 84 marks - AB grade

3. 65 - 74 marks - BB grade

Page 70: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

4. 55 - 64 marks - BC grade

5. 50 - 54 marks - CC grade

6. Less than 50 marks is FF grade

2.5.7. What are the mechanisms for redressal of grievances with reference to evaluation both at

the college and university level?

If a student is not satisfied with her/his evaluation at the internal college exam, then she/he can submit an

application to the faculty member who had originally examined the answer-sheets. The concerned faculty

member reviews the answer-sheet carefully again, and looks whether the cause of dissatisfaction is

justified. In case there are changes in the marks given earlier, the faculty member enters the corrected

marks on the answer sheet after necessary approval from examination committee and informs the office

about it. Even if there is no change in the marks, it is reported to the student.

There is a university online portal for entry of internal marks and it is open to students for checking their

marks for a week. The result is also displayed on the notice board of the Institute. In case of any

discrepancy between the two, the student is supposed to bring it to the notice of concerned faculty. The

faculty will look into the matter and inform the GTU coordinator to initiate the process of correction of

marks if required.

Any grievance regarding evaluation at external exam of University has to be addressed by the student to

the GTU coordinator. An application is submitted to the institute and if required representation is made at

the University Level. The GTU coordinator will write a mail to the university with the appropriate details.

An application is also submitted in the university. The GTU coordinator remains in constant touch with

the university to get the problem resolved.

2.6 Student Performance and Learning Outcomes

2.6.1. Does the college have clearly stated learning outcomes? If ‘yes’, give details on how the students and staff are made aware of these?

The institute have clearly stated learning outcomes which are specified in the Mission statement and the

Quality Policy. The Mission statement and the quality Policy emphasizes on continuously striving to

create and maintain quality in all spheres of activities. By focusing on quality of teaching, research,

development of faculty, student activities and library resources, Institute is trying to provide the corporate

world and society in general with:

Dynamic and forward looking managers

Professionals equipped with conceptual clarity and practical knowledge

Well groomed and with effective soft skills

Self confident and innovative individuals

Managers striving for excellence

Managers driven by values like discipline, integrity

The students are made aware of the learning outcomes by mentioning it in their induction programme and

are continuously reminded of the same by the faculties. For the benefit of students and faculties, copies of

Quality Policy have been displayed in the library and in faculty staffrooms. Similarly in the mission

statement these attributes are clearly mentioned.

The academic, co-curricular, extra-curricular activities are designed in a way to explicitly/ implicitly

convey the learning outcomes to the student. For example, to inculcate discipline in students, there are a

Page 71: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

set of rules being framed and students are clearly communicated about it. There is a discipline committee

headed by senior faculty members to make sure that all the rules and religiously followed by the students.

2.6.2. Enumerate on how the institution monitors and communicates the progress and

performance of students through the duration of the course/programme? Provide an analysis of the

students’ results/achievements (programme/course wise for last four years) and explain the differences if any and patterns of achievement across the programmes/courses offered.

As a part of the curriculum the delivery strategies of the faculty is not limited to lectures , but

involve interactive sessions, case study discussion, presentation, role play etc. There are also

other co-curricular activities like Vimarsh, Vilalpa, Man Q, mock interviews etc where the

student is required to participate. Through this process all faculty members monitors the progress

and performance of the students. The student is also given a qualitative feedback on his/her areas

of improvement.

For quantitative feedback, every fifteen days the continuous evaluation components score is

displayed on the notice. The mid semester examination score is also displayed on notice board.

The students who are failing in this examination are required to appear for remedial

examinations. Tutorial classes are also given to students whose performance is not meeting the

set standards. To the weak students additional assignments are given so as to improve their

chances of performance.

The university result analysis of also shows an upward trend barring one or two occasions, where

the total university result was relatively poor that year.

LJIMS- First shift

Sr.no Year Semester No of students

appeared

No of students

passed

No of students

with SPI>=7

1 2011-12 1 177 74 51

2 3 116 59 54

3 2 174 84 46

4 4 117 79 79

5 2012-13 1 177 47 35

6 3 166 95 92

7 2 173 34 29

8 4 166 114 113

9 2013-14 1 179 57 43

10 3 172 86 80

11 2 171 44 28

Page 72: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

12 4 169 106 106

13 2014-15 1 173 34 27

14 3 163 80 72

15 2 172 71 27

16 4 161 99 90

LJIMS- Second Shift

Sr.no Year Semester No of students

appeared

No of students

passed

No of students

with SPI>=7

1 2011-12 1 117 35 22

2 3 114 60 48

3 2 117 43 19

4 4 113 75 69

5 2012-13 1 119 39 27

6 3 115 53 49

7 2 113 25 25

8 4 110 69 63

9 2013-14 1 119 31 20

10 3 111 53 50

11 2 113 44 28

12 4 111 63 57

13 2014-15 1 113 25 7

14 3 107 48 48

15 2 106 30 7

16 4 101 56 46

Page 73: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

MCA RESULTS

Year Semester No of students

appeared

No of students

passed

Pass

Percentage

2011-12 1 58 23 39.66

2 59 23 38.98

3 55 28 50.91

4 47 29 61.70

5 45 24 53.33

6 43 25 58

2012-13 1 59 15 25.42

2 53 19 35.85

3 48 20 41.67

4 51 22 43.14

5 50 27 54.00

6 44 43 97.73

2013-14 1 0 0 NA

2 57 21 36.84

3 65 14 21.54

4 44 26 59.09

5 42 25 59.52

6 48 41 85.42

2014-15 1 0 0 NA

2 0 0 NA

3 60 20 33.33

4 60 12 20.00

5 55 23 41.82

Page 74: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

6 41 37 90.24

2.6.3. How are the teaching, learning and assessment strategies of the institution structured to

facilitate the achievement of the intended learning outcomes?

At the beginning of the semester, every faculty member prepares an academic plan

comprising session plan, teaching-learning strategies and assessment strategy. Each subject

has a course objective. This plan is made keeping in mind the objectives and the learning

outcomes. For example, the teaching-learning strategies are a combination of lecture and case

study discussion so as to achieve practical knowledge with conceptual clarity.

The teaching and the assessment strategies include the following- lectures, interactive

sessions, case studies, role play, live projects, presentation etc. All the delivery strategies are

aimed at imparting knowledge and developing the skills of our students to make them

dynamic and forward looking managers.

Various learning strategies are used to achieve the specified learning outcomes. To promote

understanding and remembering among students pictorial information using power point

slides are used to deliver sessions. Students are also motivated to ask questions which directly

enhance their learning and understanding. Group work is given in the class, exercises given

the class assignments given outside the class also facilitates learning among students.

The institute has also formulated a faculty review mechanism called Academic Review

Process (ARP) to make sure that the faculty is working according to the academic plan and is

facilitating the students for achievement of the intended leaning outcomes.

2.6.4. What are the measures/ initiatives taken up by the institution to enhance the social and

economic relevance (student placements, entrepreneurship, innovation and research aptitude

developed among students etc.) of the courses offered?

The curriculum itself is designed in a way that enhance the social and economic relevance by including

subjects like- New Enterprise & Innovation Management (NEIM), Research Methodology, Managerial

Communication, , Technology & Business, etc

The institute organises faculty visits to the companies where the students are doing their Summer

Internship Programme (SIP). The faculty takes a feedback of the student from the project guide and

utilises their inputs in designing EPDP sessions.

CRADLE is an initiative where the participant learns about entrepreneurship from successful

industrialists. Its broad objectives are to recognize the entrepreneurship capabilities of students and create

opportunities for development of entrepreneurship skills besides building long-term mutually beneficial

relationships with the SMEs and provide opportunities for experiential learning to students.

As a part of Vikalpa the College organizes educational visits to various institutions including industrial

enterprises, manufacturing units, dairies, NGOs, media offices and ports. At the end of each visit, students

submit a report, in the form of a live case study on the visited industry with the help of the respective

faculty members who accompanied them to the given industry.

ARCHETYPE is a unique co-curricular activity of being organized for all students of the first year.

Students are required to develop models based on management lesions they have learned in class. It

brings out the creativity of students by enabling them to give a physical shape to the management

concepts they learn in classes.

Page 75: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Antrapreneur – The Business Incubator is an initiative with a vision of promoting the spirit of

entrepreneurship, among students. Its mission is to develop an institutional mechanism to create

entrepreneurial culture among the stakeholders and foster the growth of entrepreneurship in the campus.

There are project studies like- Summer Internship project, comprehensive project and Global Country

study Report, which inculcate research orientation among students. All these activities make our students

more learned and competent individuals having excellent chances of being absorbed in the corporate

world. That is the reason that 85 % of the needed students were placed and the highest package this year

was Rs six lakhs.

2.6.5. How does the institution collect and analyze data on student performance and learning

outcomes and use it for planning and overcoming barriers of learning?

As already explained above there is a mechanism of the institute to continuously monitor students

performance and learning outcomes. There is also a mechanism of SIP audit where a feedback about the

student is taken from the company guide. The form is designed in a way to identify if the student is

achieving the desired learning outcomes. The areas of improvement are identified for every student on the

basis of all the activities done in the institute. Further improvement and tutorial sessions are conducted as

per the requirement.

As a part of the Induction Programme for the fresh entrants to the MBA programme, the first phase of

Executive Personality Development Programme (EPDP) is conducted. This programme facilitates the

Institute to recognize student’s true potential by identifying their strength and weaknesses. The first phase is a three day programme, where students are evaluated on the basis of following criteria- analytical skills,

presentation skills, communication skills (Both verbal and non-verbal), techniques of facing interviews

and group discussions. Various individual and group activities are administered to analyse behavioural

and psychological skills of the first year students.

For the second year students, interviews are conducted by different panels including faculty member as

expert in their areas. The interviews are recorded in order to analyse the aptitude, strength and weakness

of Students. The Interviewer evaluates knowledge and communication skills of student and if student is

not up to the mark, extra inputs are given to improve their skills. Then specially designed training

programmes are conducted to improve their communication skills. If student is lacking in their content

part, special sessions for different specialization are conducted to develop subject knowledge among

students.

2.6.6. How does the institution monitor and ensure the achievement of learning outcomes?

The students have to undergo Summer Internship Programme (SIP) after completion of first year. The

institution takes feedback from the company guide of the student on basis of parameters such as

discipline, regularity, performance, sincerity, etc. which helps to identify the achievement of learning

outcomes by the students. The procedure is repeated for the final placements as well.

Once the need is being correctly identified, various remedial programmes are designed to impart

knowledge and improve their presentation and communication skills. For example Placement Assistance

Programme –It is a programme specifically aims at updating students with current trends of industry by

providing in depth knowledge of conduct and techniques necessary to crack Group Discussions and

different types of Interviews. This programme includes activities like- CV Writing, Techniques for

Group Discussion, Techniques to crack a Personal Interview, Mock GD’s and PI’s and Interaction with Industry Experts.

Page 76: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

2.6.7. Does the institution and individual teachers use assessment/evaluation outcomes as an

indicator for evaluating student performance, achievement of learning objectives and planning? If

‘yes’, provide details on the process and cite a few examples.

Both the institution and the faculties use different assessment/evaluation tools as mentioned below:

Feedback forms during SIP: The Institute offers summer internship training of 8 weeks to each

and every student who have to compulsorily undertake it from the Institute. A faculty member

visits the company twice during the internship to take a feedback on the student’s performance at the company and make amendments in the student’s work if needed. The rationale is to assess the student’s work in the SIP and evaluating whether the student has developed real time working

skills and understood corporate dynamics.

Final Placements: The Institute offers 100% final placement assistance to its final year students.

All the companies who have recruited from the Institute are send feedback forms to assess the

performance of the graduating students in order to assess the student’s competencies and skills that he/she has learnt from the institute.

Continuous Evaluation Components : The student is also assessed during his academic term in

each subject on a set of evaluation components like attendance, class participation, submission of

individual and group projects, class presentations, viva voce etc. The objective of the entire

process is an overall assessment of the student in order to check his/her academic learning and

overall performance in a subject.

Page 77: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

CRITERION 3: RESEARCH, CONSULTANCY AND EXTENSION

3.1 Promotion of Research:

3.1.1 Does the institution have recognized research centre/s of the affiliating University or any

other agency/organization? LJ Institute of Management Studies (LJIMS) has no recognized research center of the affiliating

University or any other agency/organization

3.1.2 Does the Institution have a research committee to monitor and address the issues of

research? If so, what is its composition? Mention a few recommendations made by the Committee for implementation and their impact.

Yes, the Institute has a research committee to monitor and address the issues of research, and also

to encourage research culture among faculty members and students.

(A) The composition of the Research Committee:

Dr. P. K. Mehta, Director – Chairman (Ex-officio)

Prof. Dhawal Mehta, Professor Emeritus

Prof. D.M.Mithani, Professor Emeritus

Dr. Siddarth Singh Bist, Dean

Dr Sushant Nagpal

Prof. Rinal Shah

Dr. Abhinava Singh, Secretary

The Committee has formed, from among its members, a Research Cell, for operational

convenience, as follows:

Dr. Abhinava Singh, - Coordinator

Page 78: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Dr. Sushant Nagpal

Prof. Rinal Shah

(B) Recommendations made by the Committee for implementation:

All faculty members engaged in research should participate in research workshops and

conferences.

A forum may be created for the faculty to share their ideas, experiences, and knowledge

related to their areas of expertise/ research/ interest.

Special sessions/ workshops may be organized on specific and basic areas pertaining to

research.

Information about research output of the faculty as well as students should be made available

in the library, and also accessible to those who may be interested.

(C) Impact of the recommendations:

Special session on research in management was presented by Dr D.M. Mithani, Professor

Emeritus & former Professor, Universiti Utara Malaysia on 4th September 2010.

A presentation on ‘Research Methodology for the Beginners’ was made by Dr. Siddharth Das on 13

th July 2013.

A workshop for the internal faculty was conducted on ‘Case Writing Techniques by Prof. Dhawal Mehta, Professor Emeritus and Dr. Abhinava Singh on 10

th May 2014.

A presentation on ‘Methodology of Literature Review’ was made by Dr Anita Sunil on 3rd

August 2013.

A two-day workshop on ‘Research Methodology with an Emphasis on Quantitative Analysis’ for the internal researchers was conducted by Dr. Anita Sunil, Prof. Mehul Yogi and Prof. Rinal Shah on 8

th and 9

th August, 2014.

Formation of SALT (Sharing And Learning in Totality) Café, a forum where the LJMBA

faculty share their ideas, research, and knowledge.

Details of SALT Sessions:

Sr No Date Presenter Topic

1 27th March, 2014 Himani Sheth World Travel

2 24th July, 2014 Dr Siddarth G. Das Coin Collection as a Hobby

and Investment

3 20th December,2014 Dr. Abhinava S.

Singh

Insights on Academic

Writing

4 27th December, 2014 Prof. Anita Sunil Experience sharing of PhD

journey

(1) The institute encourages and supports faculty members to pursue Ph.D., and rewards them on

successful completion of the same.

(2) The institute ensures availability of resources to facilitate research culture by continuously

augmenting the library. The details of the library resources are as follows:

Page 79: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Total Volumes 20383

Total Title 15077

Journals 69

Magazine 35

3.1.3 What are the measures taken by the institution to facilitate smooth progress and

implementation of research schemes/projects?

• Autonomy to the principal investigator: • Timely availability or release of resources:

• Adequate infrastructure and human resources: • Time-off, reduced teaching load, special leave etc. to teachers:

• Support in terms of technology and information needs: • Facilitate timely auditing and submission of utilization certificate to the funding

authorities:

• Any other:

(A) Although no major research schemes/projects have been sanctioned to the institute so far, yet

to facilitate smooth progress and implementation of research schemes/projects, the institute

follows the practice as detailed below:

The Coordinator of the project is given full autonomy within the framework of the

norms and guidelines of the given project;

All necessary infrastructure facilities, human resources and funds are made available

in time for smooth implementation of the project;

Necessary flexibility/exemption in terms of duty hours and work load is given to the

faculty involved to enable them to focus on the project;

Provide them all necessary support in terms of technology (e.g. dedicated internet

connection, computer and printer etc);

Give all administrative support and guidance for proper preparation of accounts,

auditing, and timely preparation and submission of utilization certification to the

respective funding authorities.

(B) In addition, the Institute has taken some other initiatives to promote research amongst faculty

members as listed below:

The Institute has started an initiative named VIKALPA wherein faculty members along with

a group of fifteen students are encouraged to visit different companies and write case studies

on the same.

In order to promote case writing skills, special workshops for the faculty members are

conducted and experts are invited to mentor the faculty members in case writing.

The trust has started working on its own annual research journal wherein faculties have been

invited to publish their research papers.

The faculty is encouraged to attend conferences and seminars for paper presentation and duty

leaves are granted to them for the same. The faculty is also paid one side 3 Tier AC fare for

travelling.

The institute has also purchased the licensed version of SYSTAT with life time validity to

facilitate statistical analysis for research.

Page 80: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

3.1.4 What are the efforts made by the institution in developing scientific temper and research

culture and aptitude among students?

The institutional policy to create the ambience and provide encouragement for research is

reflected in the increased numbers of faculty members completing and getting registered

for Ph.D.

The institute encourages faculty members to participate in FDP programmes,

conferences, seminars, workshops conducted by reputed institutes & organizations by

providing duty leave, and one way conveyance to the faculty if their papers are accepted

for presentation at national/international levels.

Faculty members obtaining the degree of Ph. D. are suitably rewarded by the institution.

To foster research culture, the Institute has started industry visit programme in 2009,

whereby faculties and students jointly visit selected company and study various

management concepts like accounting concepts, financial statement analysis, principles

of economics, organizational culture, organizational dynamics of behavior, managements

aspects like planning, organizing, directing and controlling, cost management accounting,

organization and information systems, principles of working capital management, human

resource management, marketing management production and operations management.

The Institution initiated Vikalp, the case study forum in the year 2009. While it’s Phase I activity of ‘identification, analysis and discussion’ of cases in respective classes/subjects has been going on since 2009, its Phase II, involving ‘Research and Case Writing’, was introduced in the year 2013. For this all students of the 1

st year of MBA are divided into

groups of 12 to 15, and each group is assigned a faculty guide. Each group identifies an

industry, visits it to do a comprehensive study of its strategies, products, processes and

functions. Each group collects data of the industry relating to the parameters decided by

the institution. After data analysis and extensive research the faculty guide of each group

does the case writing with active involvement of students. 26 case studies have been

written and submitted in 2013-14.

The Institution inculcates among students critical thinking and research culture through

Vimarsh- the group discussion forum which involves faculty members and students. The

activity involves important discussion which encourages development of thought

processes among the participants. (Annexure)

The Institution utilizes the curricular components of Summer-Internship-Programme

(SIP), Global Country Study Report (GCSR) and Comprehensive Project (CP) for

making the students do considerable research under the guidance of faculty members.

3.1.5 Give details of the faculty involvement in active research (Guiding student research, leading

Research Projects, engaged in individual/collaborative research activity, etc.)

The faculty members are involved in active research, which has resulted in good research works,

projects and collaborative research activity.

(a) Guiding student research – the management programme emphasizes on practical learning by

focusing on research projects at three stages:

1. Summer Internship Programme (SIP) is an integral part of the academic

curriculum of MBA. For the successful completion of the MBA programme, the

students are required to complete the SIP. After completion of the 1st year of the

programme, i.e., after the 2nd semester and before the commencement of the second

year of the programme, the students are required to work with an organization for

Page 81: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

hands on experience. The duration of the SIP is six to eight weeks. During the

internship, the student has the chance to put whatever he/she learned in the 1st year

of MBA into practice while working on a business plan or trying out a new industry,

job function or organization. Students work on projects for in the areas of strategy

formulation, business process reengineering, MIS, ERP implementation,

retail/investment banking, industry analysis, new product launches, sales and

distribution, market research and advertising, etc. The SIP process requires students

to work under the mentorship of an executive of the concerned organization and also

with a faculty member of the institute. Thereafter, the student is required to prepare a

report. Later, the university arranges for evaluation of the SIP reports submitted by

the students.

2. Global Country Study Report (GCSR) is a practical study, whereby the student

carries out study in small Groups of 6 Students each, partly in Semester III and partly

in Semester IV during the 2nd year of MBA programme. The students are required to

study and understand the people, business environment and demographic profile of

the selected country or its Province or State, study the selected sector/industry of

selected country or province, carry out feasibility analysis of the selected

sector/industry of Gujarat or India with the latest data and compare with feasibility

analysis of Selected country to find relative strengths and weakness, as well as

opportunities and threats for selected sector/industry, identify business segments or

products or services in which Gujarat or India has substantial bilateral trade (export –

import) and bilateral investment in each-other countries or Provinces or States by

using SWOT analysis, study the export – import and investment opportunities, based

on published data of last 3 to 5 years, for selected industry or business segment or

products or services between India or Gujarat and the selected country / province /

state of foreign country. One industry / segment/ product-group or services is studied

by a group of 6 students and there are 10 groups in total.

The countries on which the GCSR was studied:

Year Countries

2012-2013 Tanzania, North Korea, Netherlands, Turkey, Ethiopia

2013-2014 Hong Kong, Indonesia, Malaysia, China, Nepal

2014-2015 Hong Kong, Indonesia, Malaysia, Portugal, Nepal

3. Comprehensive Project (CP) in semester II &IV:

Introduction

The Comprehensive Project (CP) report has to be prepared by using appropriate scientific statistical

research tools in consultation with the faculty guide. The work of the CP report is divided in Semester -

III and Semester - IV and students have to undertake the work as per the guidelines of GTU under the

guidance of the internal Guide and submit the progress report in Semester - III for evaluation. The final

report is to be submitted by the students at the end of Semester - IV.

Objective

It is to enable the student to study the practical working and the management issues of an organization /

sector / industry / business / NGO / Government organization and develop an insight into management

Page 82: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

practices in different functions, sectors and regions, as also to exchange ideas to promote innovation and

skills in Industry and Academia for mutual benefits.

Activity

For Semester – III

A student in a group of two has to opt for any one of the recommended sector al areas and select an

Industry Defined Problem (IDP) for commencing their project work in Semester III (1 Credit), and submit

a Research Proposal as per the schedule suggested by the faculty guide. A Performance Evaluation

Committee will review the performance of the work done by the students as per the schedule / date

suggested by the GTU.

For Semester – IV

In continuation with the study from Semester – III through Semester IV (6 credits), the CP has to be

completed and submitted in soft-copy and in a hard-bound copy. In Semester – IV students are expected

to visit / consult / interact with their respective faculty guides and follow the General Model Format for

the CP Project given by GTU. Students have to appear for the Viva with regard to their CP report before

the Panel prepared by the GTU.

Submissions

For Semester – III, Research Proposals are to be submitted before the commencement of Diwali holidays.

The same shall be announced upon the allocation of faculty guides.

For Semester – IV, the final CPs are generally submitted in the month of March.

CP Study Trends

Students of the batch 2011-13 have selected and done their CP study on the following top 5 industries:

Banking

Mutual Fund

Pharmaceutical

Information Technology (e-commerce)

Automobile

Students of the batch 2012-14 have selected and done their CP study on the following top 5 industries:

Banking

Capital Market

Food

Retail

Insurance

Students of the batch 2013-15 have selected and done their CP study on the following top 5 industries:

Banking

Capital Market

Apparel

Insurance

Pharmaceutical

Page 83: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

(b) Under Faculty-Student Research:

1. Vikalp

Under this forum faculties and students gain an exposure to the different industries and

companies and on the basis of the data collected by them during the industrial visit, they

write a case study. The students in the group of 15 are allocated to the faculties. Under

the programme, they visit the company and collect data regarding the business processes

and functions of that industry which enables students to learn concepts related to finance,

marketing, human resource, production and operations, and information technology. The

team also identifies the problems/issues faced by the company. Faculty guides and

students discuss the information and write a case study on the same. Faculties write the

case study based on the extensive research study and comprehensive analysis.

2. Research Paper/s between faculty and student:

Date Presenters Topic Outcome

4th May, 2013 1.Raji Bhavsar,

Faculty, LJMBA

2.Bhavesh Rathi,

Student (2011-

2013 Batch)

A study of

effectiveness of

BRTS as public

transportation system

with special emphasis

on BRTS in

Ahmedabad City

The research work was

presented in the ‘National Conference on Contemporary

Issues in Management and Co-

operation: Prospects and

Challenges’ organized by NICM, Gandhinagar, 4-5 May,

2013.

The research paper was

published in NICM, The

Journal of Management and

Co-operation, Jan-March 2013

Issue. ISSN: 22492275

(c) Individual Research Activity:

The Institute encourages faculty members to conduct research work by providing required

infrastructural support and proper environment for research. The details of faculty research

have been covered in annexure 3.4.3

(d) Collaborative Research Activity:

The faculty members are actively involved in collaborative research, which contributes to

quality research. The activity provides a wider platform to share research experience,

discussion and knowledge sharing.

3.1.6 Give details of workshops/training programmes/sensitization programmes

conducted/organized by the institution with focus on capacity building in terms of research

and imbibing research culture among the staff and students. The details of workshops and sensitization programmes conducted by LJIMS are as follows:

MAX, FINEX and HRX Workshops:

Marketing excellence series (MAX) To promote marketing skills at work place among our students, the workshop called MAX has been

introduced, under which, there are planned series of interactions with successful marketing professionals

from the industry and academia, sharing their experiences of marketing successes and failures. The

speakers shared their experiences related to marketing in the following areas:

Page 84: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

New Launches

Product and Brand Management

Marketing strategies and programmes

IMC strategies

Branding Strategies

Sales and Distribution Management

Positioning Strategies

CRM Strategies

Marketing Research

Some of the prominent guests invited for the series are:

Mr. Achal N. Ranagaswamy, Director, ACT Ltd.

Mr. Sanjay Chakraborty, Vice President, Triton Communications.

Mr. Yogesh Shinde, GM – Marketing, Waghbakri.

Mr. Rahul Sanghvi, CEO-MD, Dexter group of companies.

Ms. Krupa Dave, RJ and Content Head, MYFM.

Mr. Chaitanya Joshi, Group Account Director, DDB Mudra.

Dr. Rajneesh Krishna, Senior Professor, MICA.

Mr. Dilip Pandya, Head – Customer Service, TATA Teleservices.

Mr. Hardik Pota, Marketing Head, Radio Mirchi

Mr. Kamal Jethva, Sales Head, Radio Mirchi

Mr. D.T. Rawal, Zonal Incharge, AMUL.

Mr. Malhar Dave, CEO-MD, Viewfinder

Mr. Vijay Sharma, Coca Cola

Mr. Medhir Pandya, Havmor

Finance excellence series (FINEX)

LJMBA conceived the idea of organizing FINEX series in order to bridge the gap between the academic

learning through pre designed course curriculum and corporate expectations which arises due to time and

resources constraints. In order to strengthen the domain knowledge of finance and to expose the students

to practices in the arena of financial markets and services, LJMBA has initiated an innovative programme

the “Finance Excellence Series” (FINEX). It is a structured lecture series, designed to include interactive

sessions delivered by industry experts, spread over a few days catering to Corporate Finance, Banking,

Insurance and Capital Market respectively. The vital objective of this series is to provide a platform for

the holistic development of budding financial managers.

Some of the eminent guests invited for the series were:

Mr. M.G. Diwan, Ex-chairman, LIC

Mr. Vijay Chaturvedi, Unit Manager, Religare Securities.

Mr. Hemal Parikh, Director, Interface Capital.

Mr. Prakash Nayak, Senior Vice President, Kotak Bank.

Mr. Neeraj Kalawatia, V.P. and Zonal Head, Religare Finvest

Mr. A. Khandual, General Manager, IDBI Bank.

Mr. Nishant Mehta, Zonal head, Metlife.

Mr. Nilam Patel, Associate Director, SNL Financial.

Mr. A. V. Nair, Income Tax Department.

Mr. Malay Biswas, CFO, Astra Lifecare.

Mr. Jesal Mehta, General Manager – India Operations, APTTUS

HR excellence series (HRX)

Page 85: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

HREX (the HR Excellence Series) which is in its 2nd

year and exposes the LJIMS students to the

dynamics of the HR field and helps them understand various concepts of HR better through direct

interaction with the HR professionals. Some of the prominent speakers invited are as follows:

Mr. Aditya Jain, MD & CEO, Addrec Solutions Ltd.

Mr. Raghuraman R, Manager HR, Arvind Retail

Mr. Haresh Chaturvedi, Zonal Head HR, Coca Cola

The Institution has initiated sensitization programme through Business Incubation initiative under

Antrapreneur which imbibes research culture among the staff and the students.

The Institution organizes regular research workshops (as mentioned in 3.1.2).

3.1.7 Provide details of prioritized research areas and the expertise available with the institution.

The Institution has rich source of faculty which holds specialization in prioritized areas like

Marketing, Finance, and HR. Many of the faculty members also specialize in Economics,

Entrepreneurship, IT, Business Communication, Strategic Management, and other research areas

of Management.

S.No. Research Area Faculty Member (Expertise Available)

1. Entrepreneurship and Innovation Dr Abhijeet Singh, Dr Siddarth Singh Bist, Prof

Meetali Saxena

2. Microfinance Dr Neha Shah, Dr Siddarth Singh Bist, Prof Rajni

Mehta

3. Strategic Management Prof Dhaval Mehta, Dr Abhinava Singh, Dr

Manisha Jalla

4. Skill Development Dr P.K Mehta, Dr Siddarth Singh Bist, Prof

Sushma Jacob

5. Consumer Behaviour Prof Neha Mehta, Prof Raji Bhavsar, Dr Anitha

Sunil, Prof Indra Meghrajani

6. Banking and Finance Dr Priyanka Pathak, Prof Sweety Shah, Prof

Kiran Khatri,

LJMB A Faculty Specialization and Research areas

Sr No Faculty Name Area of Specialization Area of Interest and Research

1 Dr Siddarth Singh Bist Marketing

Strategic Management,

Entreprenurship, Microfinance,

Research, Consumer Behaviour

Page 86: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

2 Dr. Abhinava S. Singh

Strategic Management

and Marketing

Strategic Leadership, Business Model

Innovation

3 Rinal Shah Marketing, IT, QA

Branding, Telecom services,

Technology

4 Sweta Patel

Human Resources

Management,Indian

system of Medicines

Industrial Relations(IR) & Labor

Laws,Ethics & Corporate

Governance,Cooperative

movements,Health

5 Dr. Sushant Nagpal Finance

Behavioral finance, Financial

planning, Wealth Management,

Financial education

6 Amola Bhatt Finance Corporate Finance, Microfinance

7 Rajani Shah Finance, IT, QA, OR

Information Technology, Banking,

Investments

8 Rutuja Brahmbhatt Marketing Advertisements

9 Raji Bhavsar

Consumer behavior &

Marketing Consumer behavior, IMC

10 Ranjana Dureja HR OD, HR and action research

11 Preeti Pillai Marketing Green marketing, retailing, branding

12 Dr. Manisha Jalla

Strategic management,

Information system, HR

resource based view, knowledge

management, strategic HR,

international strategies, cross-cultural

difference

13 Dr. Priyanka Pathak Finance valuations M&A, corporate finance

14 Meetali Saxena

Information system,

Strategic IT management

ICT adoption, Strategic IT

management, Entrepreneurship, SME's

15 Dr. Archan Mehta HR, Communication, GM Nothing in particular

16 Indra Meghrajani Marketing

Rural marketing, Retailing,

Advertisement & Promotion

17 Nidhi Srivastava HR HR management,

18 Shini Unni

Managerial (Business)

Communication Business communication, english

19 Disha Mehta Finance Banking, Portfolio Management

20 Sweety Shah Finance Personal finance, security markets

21 Dr. Bilva Desai Singh Marketing Service quality

22 Kiran Khatri Finance

Reading (Fiction), Music & Travel,

Accounting, Governance, Taxes,

SME's, Corporate finance

23 Neha Mehta Marketing

Reading, visual merchandising,

Consumer Behavior, Retail,

Advertising, Travelling, Music

24 Dr. Neha Shah

Economics,

Microfinance, Social

securities, employment

Development issues, women issues,

Society & Politics

25 Himani Sheth HR

Compensation Practices, Change

Management

26 Dr Anita Sunil Marketing, QA, OR Services marketing, Statistics

Page 87: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

27 Dr. Siddharth G. Das

Business Law, FA, FM,

Banking

Business Ethics, Corporate

Governance, Behavioral Sciences,

Science Fiction, Temporal Sciences

28 Garima Sharda Marketing

Information system, Consumer

behavior, Strategic management

29

30 Mehul Yogi Marketing

Statistics, Randomness, Marketing

Communications

31 Dr. Abhijit Singh

General Management and

IT

Entrepreneurship, Sports, Music,

Innovation

32 Dhara Shah Finance

Dhrupa Trivedi HR, Marketing

Change Management, Emotional

Intelligence

3.1.8 Enumerate the efforts of the institution in attracting researchers of eminence to visit the

campus and interact with teachers and students.

The Institution has successfully attracted researchers of eminence to visit, address and interact

with the teachers and students

Under the Expert Lecture Series, eminent Professors from reputed institutes in the world have

visited the institute in the last four years. A Detailed list is as follows:

Sr No Speakers

1 Lord Meghnad Desai, Professor Emeritus,

London School of Economics

2 Dr Gautam Appa, Professor Emeritus,

London School of Economics

3 Dr G S Gupta, Ex IIMA Professor

4 Dr Abraham Koshy, Professor, IIMA

5 Mr Arvind Patwari, Director, MSME-DI,

Ahmedabad

6 Dr Chandan Chatterjee, Director, Centre

for Entrepreneurship DIC, Govt. of

Gujarat

7 Dr Arbind Sinha, Director General, Shanti

Business School, Ex- Professor and HOD

MICA

8 Mr Ajay Umat, Bennett, Coleman and Co.

Ltd.

Page 88: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

9 Mr H D Shrimali, Additonal Industries

Commissioner, Govt. of Gujarat

10 Dr Hemant Trivedi, Director-Institute of

Petroleum Management, PDPU

11 Dr Rakesh Basant, Professor, IIMA

12 Prof S B Sareen, Professor, EDI

13 Prof Pradyumna Vyas, Director, NID

14 Mr Rajen Jaswa, CEO, Dyyno Selectica,

USA

15 Dr V G Patel, Chairman CERC, Founder

Director of EDI

16 Dr. Nagesh Rao, President & Director,

MICA

17 Dr Sunil Shukla, Director EDI

3.1.9 What percentage of the faculty has utilized Sabbatical Leave for research activities? How

has the provision contributed to improve the quality of research and imbibe research

culture on the campus? The Institution has facilitated the following faculty members to involve in research by providing

sabbatical leaves:

1. Ms Monica Kapoor

2. Dr. Shubhra Anand

3. Ms Garima Sharda

4. Ms Rinal Shah

Although a very small percentage of the faculty has utilized ‘Sabbatical Leave’ for research activities, the remaining faculty members are actively engaged in research while working in the

institution.

3.1.10 Provide details of the initiatives taken up by the institution in creating

awareness/advocating/transfer of relative findings of research of the institution and

elsewhere to students and community (lab to land)

The Institution has taken initiatives in creating awareness and advocating research through

various programmes. The details are as follows:

ANTRAPRENEUR – The Business Incubator

Antrapreneur by means of incubation, investment and training provides the necessary resources to

the ones are passionate enough to follow their dreams and carve a niche of their own in a world

Page 89: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

full of people who are willing to mingle with the crowd because of their inability to take risks.

Antrapreneur brings together students, faculty of Lok Jagruti Kendra and also consists of alumni,

budding entrepreneurs, industrialists and mentors from across sectors, who are dedicated to the

cause of endorsing the zest of entrepreneurship amongst individuals. The initiative provides early

stage and seed funding to gain better valuation for the start-ups before a venture capitalist enters.

Vikalp- Case Writing

Vikalp – the case study forum was formed in the year 2009. While it’s Phase I activity of ‘identification, analysis and discussion’ of cases in respective classes/subjects has been going on since 2009, its Phase II, involving ‘Research and Case Writing’, was introduced in the year 2013.

For this all students of the 1st year of MBA are divided into groups of 12 to 15, and each group is

assigned a faculty guide. Each group identifies an industry, visits it to do a comprehensive study

of its strategies, products, processes and functions. Each group collects data of the industry

relating to the parameters decided by the institution. After data analysis and extensive research

the faculty guide of each group does the case writing with active involvement of students.

Resource Mobilization for Research

3.2.1 What percentage of the total budget is earmarked for research? Give details of major heads

of expenditure, financial allocation and actual utilization.

Adequate and necessary funds are made available by the institute as and when the requirement

arises for the conduct of research activities including FDP, workshops, and industry visits

irrespective of any budgetary allocation.

3.2.2 Is there a provision in the institution to provide seed money to the faculty for research? If

so, specify the amount disbursed and the percentage of the faculty that has availed the facility in last four years.

Yes, there is a provision in the institution to provide seed money to the faculty for research. The

institute’s trust Lok Jagruti Kendra (LJK), created a special unit under the banner of LJ

Knowledge Foundation recently (May, 2014) in order to systematically provide support to the

faculty members of the institute as and when required.

3.2.3 What are the financial provisions made available to support student research projects by

students?

Financial Provisions are made available to support student research project under Antrapreneur -

The Business Incubator and allied activities like the startup village undertaken in the campus.

Green Campus project started by the students has also been funded by the Institution.

The students’ talent has been encouraged by the trust by giving them opportunities to design the Institute’s website and social media pages.

The solar projects undertaken by students have been supported by the institution through the LJ

Knowledge Foundation.

3.2.4 How does the various departments/units/staff of the institute interact in undertaking inter-

disciplinary research? Cite examples of successful endeavours and challenges faced in

organizing interdisciplinary research. 1. Faculty members from different areas of research are encouraged to come together to

undertake research and publish research papers in interdisciplinary journals.

2. Internal faculty seminars are undertaken with lead discussant and presenter from inter-

disciplinary areas leading to myriad interaction.

Page 90: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

3.2.5 How does the institution ensure optimal use of various equipment and research facilities of

the institution by its staff and students?

The institution facilitates its staff and students by providing richly sourced library, computer lab

with internet connection, and 2 auditoriums (one within the institute building and other in the

campus) with 200 and 300+ seating capacity for guest sessions and discussions, and business

incubator cell with all the required facilities.

All faculty members are provided dedicated internet connection in their cubicles to assist

in their research work.

The library has installed SYSTAT software application for the faculty members and

students to undertake statistical analysis.

The library has computers with internet connection for use by faculty members and

students for searching information and research.

A dedicated internet enabled computer lab for students to help in their assignments and

project work.

The library has black bound volumes of journals with number available for research by

faculty members and students.

All classrooms have computers with internet connection and projectors for use by faculty

members and students helping in better student faculty interaction and knowledge

exchange.

3.2.6 Has the institution received any special grants or finances from the industry or other

beneficiary agency for developing research facility? If yes, give details.

No, the institution has not received any special grants or finances from the industry or other

beneficiary agency. However, the Institution in keen for applying for such grants in the near

future.

3.2.7 Enumerate the support provided to the faculty in securing research funds from various

funding agencies, industry and other organizations. Provide details of ongoing and

completed projects and grants received during the last four years.

Sr.No. EVENT/PROJECT FUNDING AGENCY GRANTS

RECEIVED

STATUS

1 National Seminar on

Entrepreneurship

AICTE 1,00,000 Completed

2 National Seminar on

Entrepreneurship

GUJARAT COUNCIL OF

SCIENCE AND

TECHNOLOGY

40,000 Completed

3 ENTREPRENEURSHIP

DEVELOPMENT

ENTREPRENEURSHIP

DEVELOPMENT

INSTITUTE (EDI)

75,000 Completed

4 ENTREPRENEURSHIP

DEVELOPMENT

CENTRE FOR

ENTREPRENEURSHIP

DEVELOPMENT (CED),

INDUSTRIES

COMMISSIONERATE,

15,00,000 Ongoing

Page 91: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

GOVT OF GUJARAT

3.3 Research Facilities

3.3.1 What are the research facilities available to the students and research scholars within the

campus? The research facilities available to the students and researchers include:

Fully resourced library with spacious seating arrangement

Past issues of bound volume journals in library

SYSTAT software installed for research in the library

Rich libraries of other institutes/ colleges in the campus

Internet enabled computer lab for students

Incubator Cell with all the facilities

Personal computers with internet connections for all faculty members

3.3.2 What are the institutional strategies for planning, upgrading and creating infrastructural

facilities to meet the needs of researchers especially in the new and emerging areas of

research?

The Institution has upgraded and created infrastructural facilities by facilitating research

work for budding entrepreneurs by creating Antrapreneur - Business Incubator cell.

The Institution has air-conditioned 300+ seating capacitor auditorium to conduct

seminars and workshops

The institute has acquired the dedicated lease line optical fiber network which gives

uninterrupted internet connection to the researchers and students for the quick research.

The ‘Industry Interaction and Placement Cell’ (IIPC) has been set up, with dedicated

infrastructure facilities and personnel, in the building of LJIMS for establishing and

maintaining institute-industry interface, for conducting MDPs, centralized pre-

placement training and placement process across the L.J. Group of Institutes. The

objective of the IIPC is to reduce the gap between industry expectations (practice) and

academic offerings (theory) by direct involvement of industry to attain a symbiosis.

3.3.3 Has the institution received any special grants or finances from the industry or other

beneficiary agency for developing research facilities? If, yes, what are the

instruments/facilities created during the last four years?

No special grants of finances have been received by the institution from the industry or other

beneficiary agency for developing research facilities.

However, a two-day National Seminar on “Entrepreneurship The New Age Tune: Developing an

Entrepreneurial Ecosystem in Academic Institutions”, sponsored by the All India Council for

Technical (AICTE) and the Gujarat Council of Science and Technology (GUJCOST), was

organized by the LJ Institute of Management Studies in the LJ Auditorium, LJ Campus, S. G.

Road on 29th and 30th January 2014.Very eminent persons, both academic and professional,

from the area of entrepreneurship participated as Resource Persons.

3.3.4 What are the research facilities made available to the students and research scholars outside

the campus/other research laboratories?

Page 92: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Besides a rich library, free and uninterrupted internet access, Wi-Fi enabled campus; the research

facilities of all institutes of the LJ Group of Institutes are available to the students and faculties of the

institute, whenever required for research work. A letter is provided by the institute to facilitate such

requests when the need arises.

Owing to efforts being made by the institute, the faculty members and students of the institute are allowed

access to the libraries of some institutes of national repute namely, Indian Institute of Management

Ahmedabad(IIM), Entrepreneurship Development Institute (EDI), Techpedia, Mudra Institute of

Management, Ahmedabad (MICA), Ahmedabad Management Association.

3.3.5 Provide details on the library/information resource centre or any other facilities available

specifically for the researchers?

The Institute has a rich library containing over 20000 books, 35 magazines 69 journals and 659

CDs & DVDs. In totality the library offers rich paper back and digital resources to facilitate research

work.

The institution provides dedicated computer systems with latest configuration and un-interrupted internet

access. One computer lab out of the five labs is dedicated to internet access by students to enumerate

research activities involving computer systems. In order to make the environment more conducive, Wi-Fi

connectivity is provided. The students get access to computing and internet facility through a computer

lab which houses many computers.

The institution has a rich collection of the student reports with over 1000 Comprehensive Project reports

and over 1500 Summer Internship Programme reports on different areas of Finance, Marketing, Human

Resource and Information Technology. Over 170 Global Country Study reports on different sectors are

also available in the library.

3.3.6 What are the collaborative research facilities developed/created by the research institutes in

the college. For ex. Laboratories, library, instruments, computers, new technology etc.

LJ Institute of Management Studies runs an activity called – ‘Antrapreneur – the Business Incubator’. The forum conducts several activities to promote entrepreneurship. The institute has developed a business

incubation cell for collaborative working. The students from different areas and streams come with their

business ideas to the forum where they are evaluated and analyzed and their feasibility is tested. Feasible

projects are then selected and students are guided and provided support to convert them into viable

businesses. Experts and faculty members of different institutions work together in this venture and use the

facility developed for the same.

3.4 Research Publications and Awards

3.4.1 Highlight the major research achievements of the staff and students in terms of

Patents obtained and filed (process and product)

Original research contributing to product development

Research studies or surveys benefiting the community or improving the services

Research inputs contributing to new initiatives and social development

As of now, number of patents have been filed and/or obtained by LJIMS but the

ANTRAPRENEUR – The Business Incubator of LJK has short-listed 12 business ideas for

Page 93: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

incubation, many of which have been sent for patent filing process. Prof. Abhijeet Singh, LJIMS

faculty is the COO of ANTRAPRENEUR –The Business Incubator.

The following projects have applied for patents and out of the 6 projects 4 of them have got

provisional approval for the same.

A CAPSULE CLEANING AND POLISHING MACHINE"(LJ-03-2013)

A PORTABLE TABLET COATING MACHINE

AN APPARATUS FOR MEASURING THE ANGLE OF REPOSE

A COMPACT SIZE REDUCTION, SEPARATION AND MIXING MACHINE (Our

Ref. No.LJ-05-2013)

AN AUTOMATIC SECTION CUTTER (Our Ref No.LJ-02-2013)

Auto HPTLC

At the moment, LJIMS has not contributed to product development through original research but

the incubation process of 12 business ideas through LJK’s ANTRAPRENEUR – The Business

Incubator will lead to original research contributing to product development in the near future.

Several initiatives by the institution like PARIVARTAN, VIKALP, CRADLE and LJK’s ANTRAPRENEUR – The Business incubator which are coordinated by LJMBA faculty are

poised to make significant contributions (in the form of research) to the community, new

initiatives and social development in due course of time.

At institution faculty level, research studies/ inputs/ surveys benefiting the community and

contributing to social development are listed as follows:

1. Dr. Neha Shah has worked as a consultant for SEWA-Union for their projects on Beedi (thin

Indian cigarette) workers of Ajmer (2011-12) and Bhagalpur (2012-13). The Objective of

both the projects was to identify socio-economic issues faced by the Beedi workers. The

study was used to identify the issues that SEWA as a trade union will use to mobilize the

workers. The data was used for advocacy purpose in negotiating for wage rate,

implementation of social security provision available for the beedi workers and implementing

welfare programmes.

2. Dr. Neha Shah has worked as consultant for SEWA for mapping social security for

unorganized workers in Gujarat 2011. This mapping was used by NASS (National Alliance

for Social Security) in advocacy programmes to get the social security act for unorganized

workers (2008) implemented.

3. Dr. Neha Shah has worked on a project on Human Development for Tribal Population in

Gujarat in 2008. The project was carried out at CFDA (center For Development Alternatives,

Ahmedabad) and was supported by The Tribal Development Department, Government of

Gujarat). She contributed in the chapters on education and Health indices.

4. Dr. Neha Shah has contributed to Human development report for the Sabarkantha District,

that as prepared at Sardar Patel Institute of Economic and Social Research (SPISER). This

project was assigned to SPISER by the government of Gujarat. The project was carried out

during 2010-12.

Page 94: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

3.4.2 Does the Institute publish or partner in publication of research journal (s)? If ‘Yes’, indicate the composition of the editorial board, publication policies and whether such publication is listed in

any international database?

Yes, the L.J. Journal of Research and Studies (LJJRS), a peer-reviewed bi-annual inter-disciplinary

journal with a ‘double blind’ review process is being published.

The Aim(s) and Scope of the journal is as follows:

The main objective of the L.J. Journal of Research and Studies (LJJRS) is to promote and enhance the

research abilities of the faculties and students of the LJ Group of Institutes (LJK) and make notable

contributions in the fields of management, commerce, engineering, technology, humanities, and social

sciences.

It aims at engaging rigorously with ideas, concepts, and practices in the fields of management, commerce,

engineering, technology, humanities, and social sciences with an emphasis on providing meaningful

insights to individuals and groups from the industry and the society.

Its mission is to create research communities who share would objectives related to management,

commerce, engineering, technology, humanities, and social sciences and in the process contribute to a

better understanding of management and social issues pertaining to organizations, industries, and to the

society as a whole.

The Editorial Team for the journal is drawn from the different institutes of the LJ Group with Dr.

Abhinava Singh, Associate Professor at LJIMS handling the responsibility of the Coordinator who has

successfully coordinated the collection, review and proof-reading process of research papers/ articles/

cases.

3.4.3 Give details of publications by the faculty and students:

LJIMS believes that the research output of the institute is a major criterion for growth and sustainability

in the future. The institute faculty collectively has published over 90 papers in national and international

peer reviewed journals, presented over 80 papers in national and international conferences, participated in

30 FDPs, workshops and seminars, and authored/ co-authored 7 national/ international books.

Number of papers published by the faculty and students in peer reviewed journals

(national/ international)

Total number of papers published by the faculty is 90+ and out of that more than 20 papers are

published in international journals. 1 paper has been contributed by a student in collaboration

with a faculty member in a national journal.

Number of publications listed in the International Database (for Eg: Web of Science,

Scopus, Humanities International Complete, Dare Database – International Social Sciences

Directory, EBSCO host, etc.)

LJMBA faculties have published over 90 research papers out of which more than 10 papers are

listed in Ulrich’s Periodicals Directory, 5 papers are listed in International ISSN directory, 3 papers are listed in EBSCO host Database and 2 Papers are listed in Pro Quest Database.

Monographs

As of now, no monographs have been published by LJIMS faculties.

Page 95: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Chapter in Books

Books Edited

None

Books with ISBN/ ISSN numbers with details of publishers

Books Authored and Published by LJMBA Faculty

Sr.

No.

Name of

faculty Book Published Total

`

Name of Book Publication

1 Dr.

Abhinava

S. Singh

A Study of the Indian Pharmaceutical

Industry in the New Patent Regime:

Untangling Sources of Competitive

Advantage in Unpredictable

Environments

LAP Lambert Academic

Publishing, Germany,

ISBN: 978-3-8494-9693-8 2

A Study of Modern Blood Banking in

India: Creating a Cause for Donating

Blood

LAP Lambert Academic

Publishing, Germany,

ISBN: 978-3-659-20029-8

2 Dr.

Siddharth

G. Das

A Study of Modern Blood Banking in

India: Creating a Cause for Donating

Blood (Co-authored)

LAP Lambert Academic

Publishing, Germany,

ISBN: 978-3-659-20029-8

2

Chapter in Books Authored and Published by LJMBA Faculty

Sr.

No.

Name of

faculty Book Published Total

Name of Book Chapter Name in Book

1 Dr. Neha

Shah

An Edited Book - "Tribal

Development in Western India" by

Amita Shah and Jharna Pathak,

Routledge, New Delhi, ISBN - 978-0-

415-71006-0

Health Status of the Tribal

Population

2

An Edited Book - "Growth or

development - which way is Gujarat

going", Oxford university Press,

India, ISBN 13: 978-0-19-945118-0)

Political Economy of

Subsidies and Incentives to

Industries in Gujarat-Sun

Issues

Page 96: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Elements of Banking & Insurance Sri Gajanan Publications,

Surat 1997

3 Dr.

Priyanka

Pathak

Global India and World Trade

Organization; Effects and Issues on

Indian Agribusiness Industry

Everest Publication House,

Pune, April 2007. 1

4 Dr.

Sushant

Nagpal

Psychology of Investments and

Investor’s Preferences

Regal Publications, New

Delhi; 2007 edition, ISBN:

81-89915-63-0

1

5 Ms.

Meetali

Saxena

ICT in Rural India: e-Governance IUP, ISBN - 978-81-314-

20782 1

Citation Index

Over 30 citations have been observed through google scholar for research papers by the institute

faculty members.

SNIP

None

SJR

None

Impact factor

The impact factor of journals in which the institute faculty members have published research

papers is mentioned (as applicable) in annexure 3.4.3

h-index

Over 2 h –index have been observed through google scholar for research papers by the institute

faculty members.

3.4.4 Provide details (if any) of

research awards received by the faculty

recognition received by the faculty from reputed professional bodies and agencies,

nationally and internationally

incentives given to faculty for receiving state, national and international recognitions for

research contributions.

Prof. Sweety Shah and Prof. Amola Bhatt contributed a research paper titled, “Factors Affecting

risk tolerance capacity of Investors: An Empirical study in Ahmedabad” at National Conference-

National Institute of Co-operative Management (NICM), Gandhinagar in May 2013. Their paper

won the 2nd

prize in the area of finance in the conference.

Prof. Sweety Shah contributed a research paper titled, “Financial Literacy: An Outcome of Global

Economic Crisis” at the International Conference by GTU and Parul group of Institutes in

January, 2013. Her paper won the 3rd

prize in the finance category at the conference.

Prof. Rajani Shah won the 1st prize in general category in paper presentation on “ Challenges and

Opportunities faced by Higher Education System with Special reference to management

Institutions” (2nd

International conference on Global markets by GTU & Parul Group of

Institutes, Jan 2013, ISBN- 978-93-82062-90-5).

Page 97: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Prof. Amola Bhatt was awarded best paper in the category of Ethics at the 3rd

International

Conference on Business Ethics and Corporate Governance organized by GTU in collaboration

with CKSVIM, Baroda in February 2013 for the research paper “Factors influencing Budding

Managers’ Perceptions on Ethics: An Empirical Study in Ahmedabad and Gandhinagar”.

Dr. Siddarth Bist, Dean – LJIMS was conferred the Innovation-best pedagogy award in

recognition for the CRADLE initiative by GTU in 2013.

Prof. Amola Bhatt was awarded best paper in the category - 2nd National Conference on Business

Ethics and Corporate Governance organized by GTU, FGI, CKSVIM, Baroda for the research

paper “Advertising – The Ethical Way” in September, 2011.

3.5 Consultancy

3.5.1 Give details of the systems and strategies for establishing institute-industry Interface.

The institute has created a number of systems for establishing and maintaining institute-industry interface

for students pursuing professional programmes. The details are as follows:

(A) The ‘Industry Interaction and Placement Cell’ (IIPC) has been set up, with dedicated

infrastructure facilities and personnel, in the building of LJIMS for establishing and maintaining

institute-industry interface, for conducting MDPs, centralized pre-placement training and

placement process across the L.J. Group of Institutes. The objective of the IIPC is to reduce the

gap between industry expectations (practice) and academic offerings (theory) by direct

involvement of industry to attain a symbiosis. All the stakeholders namely: Institutions, Industry,

Students and Society stand to gain as it can be a win-win partnership.

(B) As a part of the strategy, the institute has taken several other initiatives of co-curricular nature

which ensure a constant institute-industry interface and further strengthen it.

Vikalp – The Case Study Forum: This involves industrial visits through a group of students

headed by a faculty, data collection, research, analysis and writing a case.

CRADLE (Capability Recognition And Development Lessons for Entrepreneurship) which

includes interactive sessions with first generation entrepreneurs, workshops, research projects and

MDPs with a focus on the SME sector. The activity has completed 3 years and Gujarat

Technological University (GTU) in 2013 conferred the best pedagogy award to LJIMS for

CRADLE.

ANTRAPRENEUR – The Business Incubator for entrepreneurship development and support by

means of start-ups, incubation, investment and training by bringing together students, faculty,

alumni, budding entrepreneurs, industrialists and mentors from across sectors.

XPLORE (Excellence in Practical Learning Over Real Encounter) exposes the LJIMS students

towards the dynamics of corporate world through industrial visits.

MAX (the Marketing Excellence Series) which is in its 3rd

year and promotes marketing skills

among LJIMS students through a series of interactions with leading marketing professionals from

the industry and academia.

FINEX ( the Finance Excellence Series) which is in its 3rd

year and exposes the LJIMS students

to practices in the arena of financial markets and services through a structured lecture series

designed to include interactive sessions delivered by industry experts.

HREX (the HR Excellence Series) exposes the LJIMS students to the dynamics of the HR field

and helps them understand various concepts of HR better through direct interaction with the HR

professionals.

3.5.2 What is the stated policy of the institution to promote consultancy? How is the available

expertise advocated and publicized?

Introduction:

Page 98: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

LJIMS believes that as a management institute, it is very important to bridge the gap between research

and practice and contribute significantly to the cause of business enterprises and the society. Consulting at

LJIMS is viewed as a dynamic process of learning for the faculty and extends it to the industry and the

social community.

The main objective/s of consultancy at LJMBA is:

To provide an opportunity for the faculty to share insights with industry and contribute to

experimentation and new learning by the industry.

To bring the faculty in contact with real-life managerial problems, and thus greatly enriches

teaching and research.

To promote small and medium sized enterprises to help them realize their potential and contribute

to the society as a whole.

Consultancy Process at LJIMS:

LJMBA faculty comprise of groups based on area of specialization and interest (competency mapping).

Consultancy and training needs are identified from the industry (through leads, network, and personal

visits) through a faculty team and are matched with faculty expert areas and specialization. Depending on

the match, consulting and training is proposed and offered to the respective client/s (enterprise and/or

organization).

The faculty expert areas and specialization are promoted through placement brochure, industrial visits,

MDP brochure and institute website.

3.5.3 How does the institution encourage the staff to utilize their expertise and available facilities

for consultancy services?

LJIMS faculty comprise of groups based on area of specialization and interest (competency mapping).

Consultancy and training needs are identified from the industry (through leads, network, and personal

visits) through a faculty team and are matched with faculty expert areas and specialization. Depending on

the match, consulting and training is proposed and offered to the respective client/s (enterprise and/or

organization).

Besides this, faculty members are also deputed on exploratory visit to industries for identifying industry

needs. LJIMS management keenly promotes the activity of consultancy and training as it enriches the

teaching and research abilities of its faculty members and contributes to the cause of good management

practices especially at SME level. Moreover, it may also generate additional income for the institute and

its faculty. Dedicated infrastructure facilities on the campus through IIPC and auditoria.

3.5.4 List the broad areas and major consultancy services provided by the institution and the

revenue generated during the last four years.

The broad areas identified by LJMBA for consultancy and training are based on the area of specialization/

interest of the faculty. They include Marketing, Finance, HR, General Management & IT, Managerial

Communication, Business Law & Ethics, Strategic Management and Economics. The institute is involved

in consultancy and training for a number of companies since 2014. The details of the consultancy and

training are as follows:

Sr. No. Event Time Duration Resource Person name

Page 99: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

M

a

k

s

t

e

e

l

Wire Healds Pvt. Ltd, Baroda (August 2014 – Present): We are working on an

assignment to help Maksteel expand/ improve in terms of market, production capacity,

R&D and design. The management wishes to become a leading player in Jacquard

harness parts in the world (from current position of No. 2 in the world). The institute

conducted a 1 day staff training programme for the managers and supervisors of

Maksteel in Baroda on the 19th September, 2015. The trainer team included the Director,

Dean, Professor Emeritus and Associate Professor from LJIMS. The details of the

programme are mentioned below:

Mighty Group of Companies, Mumbai (October 2014 – Present): The task was to help

Mighty group in framing their vision, mission, values, strategic positioning and strategic

intent. Mighty group wanted to move from current 1-2 projects to 5-50 projects in 1-3 years

timeline.

Shubham Buildmart Pvt. Ltd (November 2015 to present):

1 Welcome speech by Shri

Ramesh Siddhpura

11.15 am

(10 minutes)

Shri Ramesh Siddhpura,

CMD, MakSteel

2 Self Introduction of

participants

11.25 am

(10 minutes)

3 Introduction to the Training

programme & the Trainers

11.35 am

(10 minutes)

Dr. Abhinava Singh

4 Session 1 – The Importance of

Vision, Mission, & Values for

an Organization

11.45 am – 12.30

pm

(45 minutes)

Dr. P.K. Mehta

5 Session 2 – Vision, Mission

and Values of Mak Steel

12.30 pm –

1.15pm)

(45 minutes)

Prof. Dhawal Mehta

Break for lunch 1.15 pm-2.15 pm

(1 hour)

6 Session 3 Team building

exercise- I

2.15pm – 3.15pm

(1 hour)

Dr. Abhinava Singh and Dr.

Siddarth Singh Bist

7 Session 4 Team building

exercise-II

3.15 pm – 4.00pm

(45 minutes)

Dr. Abhinava Singh and Dr.

Siddarth Singh Bist

8 Closing remarks 4.00 pm Shri Arpit Siddhpura

Page 100: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

A leading distributor and retailer of steel, cement, paint, and other building materials has

engaged us to create system & structure for their HO and retail outlets so as to help them

achieve their 2020 target/ objective.

CareTree Wellness (December 2014 to present):

We are consulting them for marketing of ayurvedic/ herbal brands in the online arena.

The brands have been exclusively launched and are available at Amazon, India and one

of the brands became the no.1 best seller in its category.

Ofzone Digital Marketing, Ahmedabad (December 2014 – April 2015): We provided

marketing and strategy related advise to Ofzone, a digital marketing company planning

to launch a mobile application which would provide businesses with an alternative

medium for marketing (targeted advertising)

The institute is also keen to take up more such assignments and it is in advanced stages of negotiations

with some of the well known industrial organizations in the state and country. No significant revenue has

been generated from the above assignments as in most cases; it has been undertaken as a gesture of

goodwill.

3.5.5 What is the policy of the institution in sharing the income generated through consultancy

(staff involved: Institution) and its use for institutional development ?

The institute’s policy for sharing of income generated through consultancy is based on mutual understanding between the concerned faculty and the institute. In case of consultancy visits by faculty, the

sharing for the faculty ranges between 60 to 90% and for the institute, 10 to 40%. In case of institutional

resources being used extensively, the sharing for the faculty ranges from 10-40% and for the institute, 60

to 90%.

3.6 Extension Activities and Institutional Social Responsibility (ISR)

3.6.1 How does the institution promote institution-neighbourhood community network and student

engagement, contributing to good citizenship, service orientation and holistic development of

students?

The institution understands its responsibility towards the society and in order to fulfill that it has designed

several extension activities with an objective to reach out to the community or creates a platform through

which it can inculcate a citizenship role in its students and also enable their overall development. For the

holistic development of students, the institute encourages students and teachers to participate in

community welfare activities. Students are guided to contribute to exhibit good citizenship behaviour,

develop service orientation and thereby enable overall development .The institute runs a programme,

‘Parivartan’ in which students under the guidance of a faculty member, teach the kids of the nearby locality and the slum dwellings. In addition they also make visits to the Orphanage, Old Age home,

Remand Home Blind People’s Association, contributing to their welfare through services and sometimes financially also. They also participate in Blood Donation Camps organized every year. The details of

these activities are as under.

Parivartan

LJ Institute of Management Studies have started an initiative, ‘Parivartan’, for bringing about change in the lives of people of the disadvantaged sections living in its neighbouring areas. Parivartan’s focus is to

provide literacy and also generate awareness about various social, environmental, health and hygiene as

well as political issues faced by them. Such project of extending education to people living outside the

campus serves the dual purpose:

Page 101: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

i. Equip the students of LJ to understand the reality of other half of the population of the

country so as to make them more sensitive and responsible citizens.

ii. Provide literacy to the children living in the surrounding area.

Under this initiative, 25 children have been imparted basic education. The students of the institute even

volunteer to collect donation of stationary items, books, toys and clothes and distribute them among these

children.

Blood Donation Camp– As a mark of celebrating humanity, LJ Institute of Management Studies,

frequently organizes Blood Donation Camp with hand in hand with Prathama Blood Centre& Red cross

society ;Ahmedabad . Seven such camps have been organized in which a total 502 units of blood was

donated. Both faculty and students have participated in large numbers in these camps and supported the

event.

The details of the camps organised are as under:

Sr.

No

Date of Blood

Donation

Camps

No. of students

donatedblood in blood

donation camp

(Total=Boys+Girls)

1 20-03-2015 58

2 22-02-2014 49

3 27-01-2012 93

4 02-03-2012 26

5 01-10-2010 117

6 01-10-2009 117

7 17-02 2009 38

8 11-08-2008 70

Training Programmes –The institute collaborated with the Gujarat Chamber of Commerce and

Industries and the Ahmedabad Traffic Police for conducting a 10-day management training programme

for over 1500 personnel of the Ahmedabad Traffic Police in 2013 providing its infrastructure facilities

and expertise free of cost.

Plantation Drive –The students of the institute have conducted a plantation drive on 11-02-2010, which

was celebrated as ‘Go Green Day’ to increase the green cover in and around the campus and make it more eco –friendly.

3.6.2 What is the institutional mechanism to track students’ involvement in various social movements/activities, which promote citizenship roles?

Page 102: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

The institute has organized many activities with involvement of students to promote citizenship roles e.g.

theme based functions co-curricular and extracurricular activities with social themes etc. The details of

such events are as under:

‘Walk For a Cause’- (1-3-2011) To create awareness about ‘save the girl child’, ‘corruption’, ‘aids awareness’, ‘save environment’, the institute organized ‘Walk for a cause’ in which students walked with placards & slogans from the campus to the city & back creating awareness about

such socially important issues .

‘Traffic Awareness Programme’ – Keeping in mind the increasing number of vehicles on road

and the arising chaos owing to people not following traffic rules. On 01/03/2012 the students of

LJMBA tried to streamline the unmanaged traffic by manning major traffic junctions of the city

and distributing chocolates and flowers to the violators. With this gesture they humbly requested

the violators to follow traffic rules and effectively played their role as good citizens.

Archetype 2010 – Reinventing Rural India – LJMBA organized a business model contest for

students on 13-12-2010, with the theme of ‘Reinventing Rural India’. The theme was aimed at helping our students identify the real challenges faced by rural people, create awareness about

social responsibility, identify opportunities and simultaneously develop viable business projects.

3.6.3 How does the institution solicit stakeholder perception on the overall performance and quality

of the institution?

The stakeholders of the institute comprise of the students, their parents, faculty members, industry,

various employers who employ our students and our alumni who are huge in numbers. The institute has a

mechanism for taking regular feedback from all these stakeholders, which covers in detail the perception

on overall performance and quality of the institute.

3.6.4 How does the institution plan and organize its extension and outreach programmes?

Providing the budgetary details for last four years, list the major extension, outreach programmes,

and their impact on the overall development of students.

As a part of the extension and outreach programmes, the institution has taken up several initiatives and

under these initiatives regular activities are conducted every year in an organized manner.

Every year with the new batch of students joining the institute, new student volunteers join the Parivartan

programme and the institute continues to work towards the betterment of people of the weaker and the

underprivileged section residing in the nearby areas.

Recently, about 70 Kashmiri flood affected families have taken shelter in Ahmedabad city for some time.

They migrated to the city in the month of November 2015 and are expected to be here till April 2016. As

these families do not have any source of livelihood, they are in dire state of poverty. Though the state

government had provided them support, but it too got exhausted and these families needed support till

their shelters are ready in their native places.

Students and faculty members of LJIMS came to know about these migrants. A team of faculty and

students personally visited them to identify their requirements. It was realized that food is their main

concern. The team appealed the students and faculty to donate food items like grains and spices for them.

With a collective effort, items like food grains, spices, oil, vegetables etc were collected. The material

was collected at the campus, which was supplied to them by student volunteers. These migrant families

were extremely appreciative of the care and concern shown by the LJ fraternity.

Page 103: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

As a result of these regular extension and outreach programme being conducted in the institute, the

institute has observed and increase participation of students in such activities which make them socially

responsible citizens in addition, few of our students have also joined NGO’s as full time employees.

3.6.5 How does the institution promote the participation of students and faculty in extension

activities including participation in NSS, NCC,YEC and other National/International agencies?

Although the institute does not independently run NSS/NCC, however in keeping with its mission of

education and social development it conducts extension activities and encourages faculty and student

participation in it. The trust (LJK) has been sanctioned the unit of NSS by the University where students

from all the institutes of the trust including LJIMS participate enthusiastically in all related activities.

3.6.6 Give details on social surveys, research or extension work (if any) undertaken by the college

to ensure social justice and empower students from under-privileged and vulnerable sections of

society.

In order to focus on the issues of social justice and empower female students of the LJ Campus, a

survey was conducted by the Collegiate Women’s Development Cell Team of the institution to

identify the issues and concerns of safety of girls coming to the LJ campus. The study focused on

understanding perception of girl students about their safety, and find out the types and magnitude

of the problem of sexual harassment on the campus.

The results and findings of the survey led to policy decisions been taken regarding making the

campus more safe for the female students.

A talk was organised on ‘Perspectives on Violence Against Women’ on 4th February 2014

where Ms. Manjula Pradeep, Executive Director, Navasarjan and Dr. Kalpana Shah, A women’s Study Scholar addressed the students on the issue.

A gender sensitization workshop was conducted by the CWDC on 21st February 2014 and Ms.

Sophia Khan, a lawyer and the director of an NGO-named SAFAR sensitized the students and

faculty members on how gender discrimination starts in society and what measures need to be

taken to abate that.

3.6.7 Reflecting on objectives and expected outcomes of the extension activities organized by the

institution, comment on how they complement students‟ academic learning experiences and specify the values and skills inculcated

To fulfill the institution’s social responsibility, LJMBA has designed several extension activities through which it reaches out to the community or creates a platform through which it can inculcate a citizenship

role in its students and also enable their overall development.

The various activities like Parivartan, Blood Donation Camps, Visits to the Orphanage, Old Age home,

Remand Home and Blind People’s Association, Plantation Drive, Theme based curricular and extra-

curricular activities serve dual purpose. The benfits observed are as under:

25 children of the nearby areas have been imparted basic education and now the Parivartan team

is working on designing curriculum based teaching for these children. The parents and family

members of these children are very happy with the work and dedication of students enrolled in

the activity.

502 units of blood has been voluntarily donated to Prathama and the Red Cross Society,

Ahmedabad, in different camps organized by LJMBA and the same has been appreciated by

them.

Page 104: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Theme based activities has seen an upsurge in student participation and there is a visible change

in students awareness and attitude towards the weaker section of the society and for their

upliftment.

As a result of the different extension and outreach programme conducted by the institute, it has helped in

making the students more aware about the society at large. They have become socially more responsible

which is exhibited in their increased response in the different activities conducted by the institute.

3.6.8 How does the institution ensure the involvement of the community in its reach out activities

and contribute to the community development? Details on the initiatives of the institution that

encourage community participation in its activities

As a part of Parivartan, the faculty member co-coordinating the activity has started involving the parents

of the children whom they are teaching. There are regular discussions that are being held regarding

nutritional requirements of the children, creating awareness about health and hygiene, and parenting

styles.

3.6.9 Give details on the constructive relationships forged (if any) with other institutions of the

locality for working on various outreach and extension activities.

The institute aims at developing a constructive relationship with other institutions of the locality for

various outreach and extension activities; however, as of now no such relationship exists.

3.6.10 Give details of awards received by the institution for extension activities and/contributions to

the social/community development during the last four years.

The institute has received certificates of recognition/ award by different agencies like Prathama Blood

Centre and Red Cross Society with whom the institute has collaborated for the extension and outreach

activities.

3.7 Collaboration

3.7.1 How does the institution collaborate and interact with research laboratories, institutes and

industry for research activities. Cite examples and benefits accrued of the initiatives – collaborative

research, staff exchange, sharing facilities and equipment, research scholarship etc.

Institute collaborates and interacts with industries with initiatives like:

Vikalp: The Case Study Forum which involves

1. Identification, analysis and discussion of case studies in every class

2. Data collection through visits to identifies industries, data analysis and case writing which

resulted into collaborative research, sharing facilities, and providing solutions to industries.

CRADLE (Capability Recognition And Development Lessons for Entrepreneurship) which

provides

1. Interactive sessions and inviting first generation entrepreneurs

2. Workshops for development of entrepreneurship, bridge workshops, MDPs

3. Research projects with SMEs and corporate

Page 105: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Antrapreneur: The Business Incubator: Antrapreneur by means of incubation, investment and

training provides the necessary resources to the ones are passionate enough to follow their dreams

and carve a niche of their own in a world full of people who are willing to mingle with the crowd

because of their inability to take risks. Antrapreneur brings together students, faculty of Lok

Jagruti Kendra and also consists of alumni, budding entrepreneurs, industrialists and mentors

from across sectors, who are dedicated to the cause of endorsing the zest of entrepreneurship

amongst individuals.

Startup Week 24x7: LJK Antrapreneur Startup 24x7 was a week-long hands-on experience

training programme in September 2013 where student entrepreneurs as well as aspiring student

entrepreneurs put their entrepreneurial skills to test and launch their startups.

EXPLORE (Excellence in Practical Learning Over Real Encounter) to expose students

towards the dynamics of corporate world and make them understand the business processes

through direct interaction.

Prashikshan- the Managerial Skills Development Programme. The programme aims at providing

the student with the opportunity of consolidating and applying theory through field experience. A

part time role for a short duration of one to two weeks will help the students to build confidence,

make useful employer contacts and could even lead to a permanent job placement.

LJCIA (LJ Centre for International Affairs) provides international exposure to its students and

the faculty on regular basis. With rapid globalization in every sphere of activities, especially in

education, business and industry, it has become necessary for a good educational organization to

put in place systems and processes for providing international exposure to its students and the

faculty on a regular basis.

IIPC (Institute Industry Interaction and Placement Cell): LJ-INDUSTRY INTERACTION

AND PLACEMENT CELL (LJIIPC) is a centralized training and placement cell across the L.J.

Group of Institutes.

The objective of the IIPC is to reduce the gap between industry expectations (practice) and

academic offerings (theory) by direct involvement of industry to attain a symbiosis. All the

Stakeholders, namely: Institutions, Industry, Students and Society stand to gain as it can be a win-

win partnership.

3.7.2 Provide details on the MOUs/collaborative arrangements (if any) with institutions of national

importance/other universities/industries/ Corporate (Corporate entities) etc. and how they have

contributed to the development of the institution. LJK has signed MOUs with:

University of Bielefeld, Germany

Universiti Utara Malaysia

Herzing University, USA

The process for tie up with other universities abroad is on. (HELP University, University Kuala Lumpur,

University of Malaya, Asia Pacific University, Malaysia)

3.7.3 Give details (if any) on the industry-institution-community interactions that have contributed

to the establishment/creation/up gradation of academic facilities, student and staff support,

infrastructure facilities of the institution viz. laboratories/library/new technology/placement

services etc.

Page 106: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Institute has tied up with many corporate to provide placement assistance and valuable job opportunities

for management students. For e.g. XL Dynamics, TCS, etc.

3.7.4 Highlight the names of eminent scientists/participants who contributed to the events, provide

details of national and international conferences organized by the college during the last four years. 1. Name of the event: NATIONAL CONFERENCE ON Business in Emerging Markets: Management

Practices & Research

Dates: 23/04/2011

Topics/Areas Covered: Primarily topics were under the theme of Business in Emerging Markets:

Management Practices & Research

Eminent Names:

Prof. Dhaval Mehta, Professor Emeritus, and former Director- B K School of Business

Management, Gujarat University

Prof. B S Dave, MD & CEO, Interlink Marketing (Europe) Ltd., London

Mr. Ajay Shaad, Director - NIS Academy (ADAG)

Total No. of participants: 150.

Total No. of papers presented: 15.

2. Name of the event: “Entrepreneurship The New Age Tune: Developing an Entrepreneurial

Ecosystem in Academic Institutions”

Dates: 29/01/2014 to 30/01/2014

Total No. of participants: 450

Grants Fetched: AICTE gave grant of Rs. 1, 30,000 and GUJCOST gave grant of Rs. 40,000 for the

event.

3. Startup Week 24x7:

The dates of the events were from 23rd to 29th September 2013 at LJK Campus Ahmedabad.

LJK Antrapreneur Startup 24x7 was a week-long hands-on experience training programme where student

entrepreneurs as well as aspiring student entrepreneurs put their entrepreneurial skills to test and launch

their startups.

This programme helped students to set up their company just within a week.

The programme began with idea pitches on Monday morning; student attendees vote for the best 20 ideas

every day and based on that, teams are formed on that idea.

Over Friday, Saturday and Sunday, teams focused on idea improvisation, product development, and

customer validation, practicing LEAN Startup Methodologies and building a minimal viable product with

help from mentors belonging to diverse background.

On Sunday evening, teams pitch their demo prototypes and receive valuable feedback from a panel of

experts and emerge as winners.

Page 107: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

The event programme had more than 10,000 student participants filtered to final 90 and every form

application was scrutinized for the programme and later the selected ones were notified through a mail or

telephonic confirmation.

4. MAX (Marketing Excellence Series)

As a part of our strategy to promote marketing skills at work place among our students, we have created

MAX, under which, we have planned a series of interactions with successful marketing professionals

from the industry and academia, sharing their experiences of marketing successes and failures. The

speakers are sharing their experiences related to marketing in the following areas:

New Launches

Product and Brand Management

Marketing strategies and programmes

IMC strategies

Branding Strategies

Sales and Distribution Management

Positioning Strategies

CRM Strategies

Marketing Research

5. FINEX (Finance Excellence Series)

LJMBA conceived the idea of organizing FINEX series in order to bridge the gap between the academic

learning through pre designed course curriculum and corporate expectations which arises due to time and

resources constraints. In order to strengthen the domain knowledge of finance and to expose the students

to practices in the arena of financial markets and services, LJMBA has initiated an innovative programme

the “Finance Excellence Series” (FINEX). It is a structured lecture series, designed to include interactive

sessions delivered by industry experts, spread over a few days catering to Corporate Finance, Banking,

Insurance and Capital Market respectively. The vital objective of this series is to provide a platform for

the holistic development of budding financial managers.

6. HRX (HR Excellence Series)

HRX (the HR Excellence Series) exposes the LJIMS students to the dynamics of the HR field and helps

them understand various concepts of HR better through direct interaction with the HR professionals.

Expert Professor Series

In expert professor series we invite eminent faculty members from institutes of National Importance.

Expert Professor Lectures are generally held twice in a year and represent the Institute's ongoing

commitment to furthering translational of management studies by creating opportunities for the most

talented management students, faculty members to exchange knowledge and ideas. Dr. Nagesh Rao,

President and Director, MICA was invited in 2015 as part of the series.

Page 108: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

3.7.5 How many of the linkages/collaborations have actually resulted in formal MoUs and

agreements? List out the activities and beneficiaries and cite examples (if any) of the established

linkages that enhanced and/or facilitated –

(a) Curriculum development/enrichment

(b) Internship/On-the-job training

(c) Summer placement

(d) Faculty exchange and professional development

(e) Research

(f) Consultancy

(g) Extension

(h) Publication

(i) Student Placement

(j) Twinning programmes

(k) Introduction of new courses

(l) Student exchange

(m) Any other

Institute has established several linkages/collaborations by exchanging MoUs and agreements with 3

Cultural Forums, 7 Foreign Universities, 9 Industrial bodies, 13 academic institutions, 4 National

Universities, 5 NGOs, 2 Open Universities, 12 State/International Organizations, 9 Private Universities, 6

Research institutes, 22 State universities, which has resulted into development of many activities and

benefits like Joint Curriculum development, Internship/On the job training, Summer Placement, Student

exchange, faculty exchange and professional development, Research, Consultancy, Extension activities

with SRISTI, research publications, student final placement, working towards development and

introduction of new courses.

3.7.6 Details on the systematic efforts of the institution in planning, establishing and implementing

the initiatives of the linkages/collaborations.

Systematic efforts have been planned, established and implemented with several initiatives like Vikalp,

CRADLE, Antrapreneur - The Business Incubator, Startup Week 24x7, EXPLORE, Prashikshan,

Parivartan, LJ Centre for International Affairs, Industry Interaction and Placement Cell (IIPC). The details

have been stated earlier.

Page 109: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

CRITERION 4: Infrastructure & Learning Resources

4.1 Physical facilities

4.1.1

What is the policy of the institution for creation and enhancement of infrastructure that facilitate

effective teaching and learning?

The policy of the institute for creation and enhancement of infrastructure is as follows:

To follow the norms and guidelines of the AICTE and the affiliating university

To ensure that the infrastructure created is adequate, comfortable, spacious, ventilated, has

functional utility and is equipped with modern technological gadgets

To make value additions for creating an academic ambience and a smooth user-friendly working

environment for both teachers and students.

4.1.2

Details of the facilities available for

A) Curricular and co curricular activities

The institute has properly ventilated and spacious classrooms with comfortable seating

arrangements, black boards and soft boards.

Technology enabled learning spaces have been created by providing dedicated computer

systems, permanently installed LCD projectors & screens and CCTV cameras in all

classrooms.

There are tutorial rooms for conducting and small group interactions.

The institute has a well equipped and fully air conditioned auditorium with a capacity of 450

people and a seminar hall with capacity of 250 people.

Specialized facilities and equipments like collar microphones, Language Laboratory, IIPC,

Business Incubator, SYSTAT Station have been made available for teaching, learning,

research and industry interaction.

B) Extra curricular activities

The institute has playground and facilities on the campus for outdoor and indoor games such as

cricket, foot ball, basket ball, volley ball, tennis, table tennis, carrom, chess etc.

Flood lights have been installed in the playground to facilitate day night games.

There is an Open Air Theatre on the campus with provision of green rooms. This facility is being

used for organizing cultural activities like ‘Adventure’ – the Annual cultural festival, Inter B-

School competition and Garba Festival.

The institute has set up a Health Centre with dedicated infrastructure equipped with facilities for

providing basic health services to students and staff. The Health Centre also helps in creating

awareness about health and hygiene.

4.1.3

Page 110: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

How does the institution plan and ensure that the available infrastructure is in line with its

academic growth and is optimum utilized? Give specific examples of the facilities developed /

augmented and the amount spent during the last four years (Enclose the master plan of the

institution / campus and indicate the existing physical infrastructure and the future planned

expansions, if any )

L. J. Institute of Management Studies was the first among the L. J. Group of Institutes to start functioning

(2001) on the present campus. It was later joined by the L. J. Institute of Computer Applications (2004),

L. J. Institute of Pharmacy (2004), L. J. Institute of Engineering & Technology (2007), L. J. Polytechnic

(2008), New L. J. Commerce College (2011), L. J. School of Architecture (2013) and L. J. Institute of

Radio Programmeming (2014), L. J School of Law (2015), L.J Institute of Applied Sciences (2015), L.J.

Institute of Media and Communication (2015)

The institute plans its infrastructure on the basis of

a) Norms of AICTE/University

b) Requirements of the programme

c) Requirements of various co-curricular/extra-curricular activities conducted by the institute

d) Requirements of the faculty & students

e) Classrooms, Computer Labs and Library are planned as per the number of students

f) The institute prepares an academic calendar that lists out all the institutional activities planned for

the coming year. This ensures that the infrastructure facilities are optimally utilized.

The institute started in 2001 with an intake of 40 students for MBA, and has grown to an intake of

300 in MBA and 60 in the MCA programme. There has been a constant increase in the number of

student, faculty and a range of activities necessitating further development and augmentation of

infrastructure including the IT infrastructure and the library.

The following specific infrastructure facilities that have been developed/ augmented

2001 – Only ground floor

2004 – Half of the first floor was constructed

2007 – other half of the first floor constructed; provision of separate library for MCA; the

Governing Body decided to provide LCD projectors in all classrooms of all institutes on the

campus; second faculty room made functional

2008 – 2nd

floor constructed with 7 classrooms; one 250 seater auditorium; dedicated

infrastructure for the proposed Industry Interaction and Placement Cell(IIPC); Health Centre

started on the 2nd

floor; third faculty room made functional

2010 - Construction the basket ball court and augmenting the playground facilities by installing

flood lights

2010- Dedicated state-of-the-art infrastructure facilities created for IIPC

2011 – IT infrastructure further augmented and networked with optical fibre network; separate

office for the Dean created on the ground floor; a well equipped and fully air-conditioned 450

seater auditorium constructed and made functional; IIPC made functional on the 2nd

floor of the

building

2013 – Library floor area expanded by covering the adjoining passage, and book storage

arrangements were expanded by fully utilizing the wall spaces up to ceiling

2013- Third floor of the building was constructed and seven additional rooms were allotted to the

Institute.

Page 111: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

2014 – The institute installed CCTV cameras in all the classrooms as per the university

requirement.

2014 – The Business Incubator was constructed on the second floor of the institute to incubate

and promote different business ideas of the students on the campus.

2015 – Provision of Air Conditioning of the 250 seater auditorium

4.1.4

How does the institution ensure that the infrastructure facilities meet the requirements of students

with physical disabilities?

The institute has taken following steps in meeting the requirements of differently- abled students:

Providing necessary infrastructure support for meeting the requirements of these students.

Making administrative arrangements for ensuring that the facilities are maintained properly and

are in ready-to-use condition.

Making human assistance available in cases of severe disabilities.

Arranging the classes and examinations of these students on the ground floor.

4.1.5 Give details on the residential facility and various provisions available within them

There is no residential facility on the campus.

4.1.6 What are the provisions made available to students and staff in terms of health care on

the campus and off the campus?

There is a Health Centre on the campus with all minimum necessary equipments, medicines, and

a qualified doctor.

“L.J. Arogya Kendra”, a mobile van of LJK Trust, for providing all medical services and

medicines to the slum dwellers of Vadaj locality of Ahmedabad. It is also available for students

and staff. The timings of the van are from 8 am to 12 noon and the medicines are distributed at a

subsidized rate. Health awareness camps are also conducted for the slum dwellers.

LJK Trust has a tie up with a pathological laboratory for conducting health check-ups and tests at

subsidized rates.

4.1.7 Give details of the common facilities available on the campus

Separate dedicated space has been provided for LJCIA (L. J. Centre for International Affairs) on

the third floor of the building.

Women’s Cell: There is a Collegiate Women Development Cell (CWDC) for creating awareness in women on issues related to gender equality, women empowerment, discrimination etc.

Counselling and Career Guidance: Counselling is provided through a mechanism of mentorship

programme in which a senior faculty is made the Section Head of group of 60 students. Section

Heads also ensure career guidance by involving faculty members of specific specializations.

Placement Unit: There is a full-fledged Placement Committee comprising faculty and student

coordinators. The committee coordinates pre-placement talks, conducts company and profile

specific training and skills development. The Placement Committee also provides post-placement

Page 112: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

assistance on regular basis. Dedicated and well-equipped infrastructure facilities have been

created for the placement unit on the 2nd

floor of the building.

Health centre: A Health Centre with a qualified doctor has been provided on the 2nd

floor of the

building.

Canteen: A Canteen with adequate space and dining facilities functions in the basement of the

institute building.

Recreational spaces for staff and students – Sports facilities for Cricket, Basket ball field, volley

ball, table tennis, carrom board and chess are available.

Safe drinking water facility: RO drinking water facility is available on all floors in the building.

Auditorium: There is one auditorium in the institute building with a seating capacity of 250, and

another bigger, fully equipped and air-conditioned auditorium on the campus with a seating

capacity of 450 on the campus.

4.2 Library as a learning resource

4.2.1 Does the library have an advisory committee? Specify the composition of such a committee.

What significant initiatives have been implemented by the committee to render the library student /

user friendly?

Yes, the institute has a Library Advisory Committee. Its composition is as follows:

Prof. B. M. Peerzada, President, LJK - Chairman

Prof. Dhawal Mehta, Professor Emeritus - Expert (Academic)

Prof. Bela Shah, Librarian, RJTC - Expert (Technical)

Dr. Siddarth Singh Bist, Dean, LJIMS

Dr. Siddharth Das, Coordinator, Library Development Committee

Ms. Kashmira Barot, Librarian, LJIMS Secretary

Significant initiatives undertaken by the Committee are as follows:

Expansion of the library by including a passage area within the library.

Optimal utilization of wall space for storage purpose creating shelves with glass doors

from floor-to-ceiling.

Removal of steel cupboards for increasing the floor space of the reading room.

Re-organization of the seating arrangements so as to provide separate seating for students

and the faculty.

Installation of CCTV in library and at the entrance.

More computers with internet access have been added to the library.

4.2.2 Provide details of the following:

Total area of library ( in Sq. Mts. ) : 200 sq meters

Total seating capacity: 100

Working hours:

On working days: 8 AM to 9 PM

Before Examination days: 8 AM to 9 PM

During examination days: 9 AM to 8.30 PM

During vacation: 9 AM to 2 PM

On holidays: Generally remains closed

Layout: The library has comfortable seating arrangements for students and faculty with separate

space being provided for internet browsing, accessing e-resources and catalogue search.

Page 113: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

4.2.3 How does the library ensure purchase and use of current titles, print and e journals and other

reading materials? Specify the amount spent on procuring new books, journals and e – resources

during the last four years

A) Purchase of current titles, print and e journals and other reading materials

L J has a tie up with “Unique Book Agency”. All the textbooks and reference books are

purchased from the above mentioned Agency.

The books other than textbooks & reference books are purchased from Delhi Book fair.

In case any faculty requires textbook which may not be mentioned in the syllabus, they have

to fill up a requisition form.

The same is signed by the Director & sent to the Trust Office.

The trust office then purchases the required books and sends them to the library.

In case of journals and magazines, publisher sends a reminder to the librarian for the renewal

of the same.

The librarian consults the faculties and decides whether the subscription of the respective

magazines/ journals should be renewed or not

Once it is decided to renew the subscription, the renewal forms are sent to the trust office.

The trust office sends a cheque to the librarian which is then sent to the publisher.

In case of newspapers, the vendor comes directly to the MBA office and presents the bill. The

Administration department checks the bill and makes the payment to the vendor directly

B ) The amount spent on procuring new books, journals and e – resources during the last four

years

2011 2012 2013 2014 2015

Library

holdings

Total

Cost (Rs)

Total

Cost (Rs)

Total

Cost (Rs)

Total

Cost (Rs)

Total

Cost

(Rs)

Text Books 1304644 155640 48424 18123 122187

Reference

Books 319719 980838

461170

479777 1484186

Journals /

Periodicals 111533 86163 57602 44297 35042

News Papers 7541 7622 9204 7754 17644

Page 114: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

C) Use of books and other Reading Material

The institute reviews the usage of books, prints and other reading material bi-monthly. A report is made

in the following format:

Library Review for the Months of September & October 2015

1. Student Library Visit Register

SEPTEMBER OCTOBER

Average Visit: 77 78

Highest Visit: 200 (28/9/2015) 136 (29/10/2015)

Lowest Visit: 22 (04/9/2015) 34 (12/10/2015)

2. Photocopy Register

No photocopy

3. Inter-Library Register

New LJ College – issued and returned on the same day

4. Subscription Received Register (September & October)

SEPTEMBER

Journals: Indian Management, Pajnan, The Economist, Business India, Business World, Yojana,

HBR

Magazines: Capital Market, Down to Earth, Femina (H & E), HPH News, Human Capital, India

Today, Productivity News, The Teenager, Knowledge, Pratiyogita, Men’s Health, Filmfare, Lonely

Planet, Good Homes, Outlook, Frontline, Mainstream, Men’s Health, The Week, Time.

OCTOBER

Journals: Anvesha, Indian Journal of Human Development, Indian Journal of Industrial Relations,

Organizational Management, HBR

Magazines: Femina (H & E), Filmfare, Lonely Planet, Frontline, Mainstream, The Week, Time,

Capital Market, Down to Earth, HPH News, Human Capital, India Today, Lonely Planet.

5. Faculty Books Issue Register (September – October)

Page 115: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Faculty No. of Books issued

(September)

No. of Books issued

(October)

Dr. Neha Shah 3 -

Dr. Siddharth Das - 1

Dr. Sushant Nagpal 1 -

Prof. Mehul Yogi - 1

Prof. Kiran Khatri 2 -

Prof. Himani Sheth - 3

Dr. Anitha Sunil 1 -

Prof. Dhaval Mehta - 1

Dr. Bilva Desai 3 -

Prof. Neha Mehta 4 -

Prof. Sushma Jacob - 1

Prof. Indra Meghrajani 1 -

Prof. Raji Bhavsar 6 -

Prof. Nidhi Srivastava 1 -

Prof. Meetali Saxena 4 3

6. Faculty Subscription Issue Register

Prof. Rajani Shah – 4 (September)

Prof. Sushma Jacob - 4 (October)

Prof. Meetali Saxena - 2 (October)

Dr. Siddharth Das - 1 (October)

Dr. Sushant Naggpal - 1 (October)

4.2.4 Provide details on the ICT and other tools deployed to provide maximum access to the library

collection?

Electronic resource management package for e journals

The institute has subscribed to following journals:

Page 116: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

American Marketing Association & American Accounting Association Online

American Economic Association

However, the current renewal of these journals is pending due to technical difficulties.

Federated searching tools to search articles in multiple data bases

There are no on-line databases subscribed at present

Library website

No separate website for the library. Library information is available on the institute’s website

In – house / remote access to e – publications

All 8 PCs have internet connection. Faculties and students can download the relevant

information as and when required.

List of recent e – publications

Business-Fundamentals - Global Text Project - http://cnx.org/content/col11227/1.4/

20 Ways to Improve Your Story - http://www.writefine.com

Accounting Principles –Team FME – management-ebooks.com, (free management e books)

Effective Communication - Team FME –management-ebooks.com, (free management e books)

Leadership theories - Team FME –management-ebooks.com, (free management e books)

Team building - Team FME –management-ebooks.com, (free management e books)

Understanding Emotional-Intelligence..- Team FME –management-ebooks.com,

(free management e books)

Mutual Funds-A-Guide-For- Investors.. U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission -Website:

www.investor.gov

Savings-Fitness-A-Guide-To Your financial future - http://www.free-ebooks.net/tos.html

Theory- of Business-Enterprise - http://www.Free-eBooks.net

Working-Capital- Management – Robert Alan Hill –e books at bookboon.com

How-to-write-an- Essay. – Alan Barker - e books at bookboon.com

I –Still-cant- Speak-English.- Jason West - e books at bookboon.com

English- out-there –ss1-beginner-level-1- e books at bookboon.com

English-Grammar- for Economics - Ellman Patricia - - e books at bookboon.com

Library automation

o Computers are used to automate the typical procedures of cataloguing and circulation, . The

institute’s library has a dedicated ERP system. Total number of computers for public access

Page 117: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

o Total 10 computers are available out of which 8 are for public access and 2 for the library

management

Total number of printers for public access

o One printer and One scanner

Internet band width / speed - 2 mbps , 10 mbps, 1 gb ( GB )

o Yes, 2 Mbps

Institutional Repository

o Text books, reference books, Journals & Periodicals, Comprehensive Projects, Grand projects,

Global Country reports, Research papers, Research Articles

Content management system for e – learning

o There is a dedicated drive for e- resources. The same helps the students to upgrade and work

on their projects and assignments.

Participation in resource sharing networks / consortia ( Like Inflibnet )

o The institute uses INFLIBNET software for searching classification number of books

4.2.5 Provide details on the following items

Average number of walk – ins – 250 - 300

Average number of books issued / returned – 300

Ratio of library books to students enrolled : – 26:1

Average number of books added during last 3 years –6000

Average number of login to OPAC - 35

Average number of log in to e resources –52

Average number of e –resources downloaded / printed – 65

Number of information literacy trainings organized – LJ trust organizes a training programme

for all the librarians. Training is provided on library software upgradation, computer literacy,

journals to be purchased and other related information. ERP software training was organized

through SKYPE

Details of weeding out of books and other materials – Every year 5 % of books and other

materials in total are removed from the library due to damage.

4.2.6 Give details of the specialized services provided by the library

Manuscripts – Not Applicable in a professional course like MBA

Reference – Specialized dictionaries, Dictionaries focusing on particular subjects like Business,

Computers, Ecology, Law , Marketing, Psychology , Finance & Banking. Cambridge, Grammar,

French dictionaries. Encyclopedias, Atlases, Faculty research papers, Journal Bound volumes,

Periodicals and magazines, Year Books, Grand projects , Summer Internship projects, Global

country reports are available

Reprography – The library provides printing, photocopy & scanning facilities in its premises.

Cost per page for photocopy – 0.50 paise, printing cost per page – Rs 2, and scanning facility is

provided for free to the students

Download – All 8 PCs have internet connection. Faculties and students can download the relevant

information as and when required.

Printing – Printing facilities are provided to students on a chargeable basis

Page 118: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Reading list / Bibliography compilation – Library prepares a quarterly reading list where all new

arrivals or important books, important articles of certain magazines are mentioned. The same is

displayed every quarter

In house / remote access to e – resources –

o All 8 PCs have internet connection. Faculties and students can download the relevant

information as and when required.

User orientation and awareness – Proper assistance is provided to students for searching

books and other related data base. The ways to search the books are explained. Related

cupboards and shelves are shown. The procedure for issue and returns of books is explained

in detail. Rules and regulations regarding library discipline are displayed and the same is

explained personally as and when required

Assistance in searching data bases – Institute has not subscribed to any database.

INFLIBNET / IUC facilities – INFLIBNET is used for searching classification number of

books

4.2.7 Enumerate on the support provided by the library staff to the students and teachers of the

college

Proper assistance is provided for searching books and other related data

The ways to search the books are explained.

Related cupboards and shelves are shown.

The procedure for issue and returns of books is explained in detail.

Rules and regulations regarding library discipline are displayed to the students and the same

is explained personally as and when required

In case, a faculty wants a book which is not available at the library, he/she is provided a

requisition form to order that particular book and the same is ordered for the concerned

faculty after approval from the Director.

4.2.8 What are the special facilities offered by the library to the visually / physically challenged

persons? Give details. –

There has been no visually challenged student in the institute since its inception.

However, the physically challenged students are provided special seating arrangements, and

personalized assistance by the library staff in respect of all library services like book

issue/return, catalogue searching etc.

4.2.9 Does the library get the feedback from its users? If yes , how is it analyzed and used for

improving the library services. (What strategies are deployed by the library to collect feedback

from users? How is the feedback analyzed and used for further improvement of the library

services? )

The institute has a formal feedback system designed for its students. Feedback is taken from the students

in the classrooms at the end of each semester through feedback forms. The grey areas or inadequacies are

studied and improvements on the same are made after a thorough check is made in terms of a timeline for

the changes or improvement.

4.3 IT Infrastructure

4.3.1 Give details on the computing facility available (hardware and software) at the Institution:

Page 119: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Number of computers: 293

Configuration: Pentium 4, Core to Dual processors, upto 3 GB RAM and upto 500 GB hard disk.

Computer student ratio: 1:2

Standalone facility: YES

LAN facility: YES

Wifi facility: YES

Licensed software: YES

Number of nodes/ computers with Internet facility: All computers have Internet facility

4.3.2 Details of the computer and the internet facility made available to the faculty and students on

the campus and off-campus?

Dedicated computers are made available to every faculty with internet connection on the campus.

For students there are six computer labs with internet facility.

- No internet facility is available off campus.

4.3.3 What are the institutional plans and strategies for deploying and upgrading the IT

Infrastructure and associated facilities?

Since the Institute has the Intake of 360 students / year, keeping in view the requirement of IT skills for

prospective graduates, state of art computer labs are designed with latest configuration, the systems are

constantly upgraded in terms of hardware and software in order to be in tune with the changing times.

High end LCD projectors are installed with the computer systems in the classes to give enhanced learning

experience to the students.

The institute intends to increase the internet speed to facilitate better functioning for the students and the

faculty members.

4.3.4 Provide details on the provision made in the annual budget for procurement, upgradation,

deployment and maintenance of the computers and their accessories in the institution ( year wise

for last four years)

YEAR PROVISION IN BUDGET (Rupees)

2014-15 70,000

2013-14 8,00,000

2012-13

2011-12

40,00,000

Page 120: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

4.3.5 How does the institute facilitate extensive use of ICT resources including development and use

of computer-aided teaching / learning material by its staff and students?

The institute procures the computer systems through the central purchase system by LJ Trust.

The institute identifies the requirement of the software based on the subjects, projects and

research work undertaken at the institute.

Students use e-resources for doing their assignments and projects.

Faculties also use these resources for their research work.

4.3.6 Elaborate giving suitable examples on how the learning activities and technologies deployed

(access to on-line teaching –resources, independent learning, ICT enabled classrooms/learning

spaces, etc.) by the institution place the student at the center of teaching – learning process and

render the role of facilitator for the teacher.

The list of software used:

M S Office 2007

Tally

SPSS

AMOS

SYSTAT

Java

Notepad ++

MS Visual studio 2010

Oracle 9 i

Tom Cat Apache

Deep Freeze

Symantec A/V

These software are used by the students in research projects during their two year MBA programme.

For e.g. the students have Comprehensive Projects, Summer Internship Project, Global Country

Report and subject project reports. Students are given assignments which require the software and

system use. Faculties are also using these facilities for their research work.

4.3.7 Does the Institution avail of the National Knowledge Network connectivity directly or through

the affiliating university? If so what are the services availed of?

No

4.4 Maintenance and Campus facilities

4.4.1 How does the Institution ensure optimal allocation and utilization of the available financial

resources for maintenance and upkeep for the following facilities (substantiate your statements by

providing details of budget allocated during last four years?)

a. Building

b. Furniture

c. Equipment

Page 121: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

d. Computers

e. Vehicles

f. Any other

The Institution ensures that there is an optimal utilization of the available financial resources for

maintenance and upkeep of facilities like Building, Furniture and equipment etc. The provisions made in

the budget for the maintenance of different facilities are as follows:

Particulars 2014-15 (Amount

in Rs)

2013-14 (Amount

in Rs)

2012-13 (Amount

in Rs)

2011-12 (Amount

in Rs)

a. Building

b. Furniture

c. Equipment

d. Computers

e. Vehicles

f. Any other

70,00,000

55,00,000

70,00,000

30,00,000

4.4.2 What are the institutional mechanisms for maintenance and upkeep of the infrastructure,

facilities and equipment of the college?

For maintenance and upkeep of the infrastructure the Institute has appointed some personnel as

Maintenance officers.

The maintenance and upkeep of building is a centralized process through the Trust office. The

Administrative office of the Institute receives all queries regarding the maintenance and upkeep of the

equipment; the queries are instantly passed on to the central maintenance office. These queries are

recorded in a Query Register and respective personnel are notified. There are separate personnel

appointed for Infrastructure, Facilities and Equipment.

The personnel are required to respond to queries within 24 hours and prepare a report on the type of query

received and the response made.

4.4.3 How and with what frequency does the institute take up calibration and other precision

measures for the equipment/ instruments?

Not applicable

4.4.4 What are the major steps taken for location, upkeep and maintenance of sensitive equipment

(voltage fluctuations, constant supply of water etc.)?

Page 122: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Though the Institute is located well within the municipal limits, it is not covered by the local power

supplier that provides uninterrupted power in the city. Therefore to ensure uninterrupted supply of Power;

the Institute has installed two generators, 62 KVA and130 KVA. To solve the problem of voltage

fluctuation which affects the sensitive equipment’s like LCD projectors UPS has been installed in the computer labs.

Water supply: To ensure continuous supply of water the Institute has its own underground bore well, for

drinking water the Institute has water filters in its premises.

Page 123: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

CRITERION - 5: STUDENT SUPPORT AND PROGRESSION

5.1 Student Mentoring and Support

5.1.1 Does institution publish its updated prospectus/handbook annually? If ‘yes’, what is the information provided to students through these documents and how does the institute ensure its

commitment and accountability?

Yes, the institution prepares its updated prospectus before the commencement of every academic year

providing information to students about location, contact details, courses, intake, timings, vision, mission,

Quality Policy, approval status, academic systems and processes, co-curricular and extra-curricular

activities, student welfare measures, placement activity, alumni, faculty details, faculty development

programme, research and extension activities, innovations and initiatives, fee structure, infrastructure

facilities, computer laboratories, library resources, sports facilities, medical and healthcare facilities,

conferencing facilities, canteen, Women Development Cell, Grievance Redressal mechanism, Feedback

Mechanism, institutional achievements etc. However, since admissions to all institutions offering

professional programmes in Gujarat state are finalized centrally, and online, by the Admission Committee

for Professional Courses (ACPC), the institutional information is published on the website of the ACPC

for benefit of prospective students. The information is also published on the website of the Directorate of

Technical Education, Govt. of Gujarat, on their website under the KYC (Know Your College) scheme.

The information is also published on the website of the institute.

The institution ensures its commitment and accountability to the information provided by seeing to it that

all infrastructure facilities are in place, that the allocation of responsibilities for academic, co-curricular

and extra-curricular activities is completed well in advance, that library and laboratory resources are duly

augmented, that the plans of all activities are reflected in the academic calendar prepared for distribution

to the new batch.

5.1.2 Specify the type, number and amount of institutional scholarships/freeships given to the

students during the last four years and whether the financial aid was available and disbursed on

time?

The institute is instrumental in supporting students for financial assistance in three ways:

One, the institute is an intermediary for the state government scholarships provided to students from SC,

ST, OBC and minority communities. These scholarships are channelized through the institution. The

institution creates awareness among students, facilitates and provides all administrative assistance to the

eligible students.

Two, many students take an education loan to finance the cost of education. The institute provides all

administrative support required by the banks to process the loans.

Three, LJ Kendra has supported needy but deserving students by providing fee concessions and/or by

giving an option of paying fees in easy installments and/or by providing infrastructural facility at

concession rate. Such students are identified from personal interactions with the Director/Dean or faculty

members. The case is then recommended to the trust. For example, Ankit Narsinghani (2011-13 Batch)

contacted the director to discuss his inability to pay fees due to untimely demise of his father, the case

was forwarded to the trust immediately. The trust facilitated him to pay fees in easy instalments and

waived his hostel accommodation fees.

Page 124: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

The Lok Jagruti Kendra has mooted a scheme to provide full freeships to meritorious students from

economically weaker background with bright academic records - ‘Alp Sadhan Tejasvi Vidyarthi maate Protsahan Yojana’ by LJK is in the pipeline.

5.1.3 What percentage of students receive financial assistance from state government, central

government and other national agencies?

The following table provides details of the number students enrolled in different categories that receive

scholarship either from State government, Central government or other national agencies. Eligibility of

students for scholarship is evaluated after the application. Only the deserving students from economically

weaker backgrounds are awarded scholarship. The administrative assistance required to complete the

procedure is provided by the institute.

YEAR CATEGORY % OF STUDENTS

RECEIVING

SCHOLARSHIP

2012-13 SC

ST

SEBC

MINORITY (JAIN AND

MUSLIM)

11

NIL

12

1

2013-14 SC

ST

SEBC

MINORITY (JAIN AND

MUSLIM)

12

NIL

20

5

2014-15 SC

ST

SEBC

MINORITY (JAIN AND

MUSLIM)

12

1

17

10

MCA

YEAR

CATEGORY

% OF STUDENTS RECEIVING

SCHOLARSHIP

Page 125: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

2012-

13

SC

ST

SEBC

MINORITY (JAIN AND MUSLIM

12

NIL

NIL

2013-

14

SC

ST

SEBC

MINORITY (JAIN AND MUSLIM

5

NIL

1

1

2014-

15

SC

ST

SEBC

MINORITY (JAIN AND MUSLIM

10

NIL

5

1

5.1.4 What are the specific support services/ facilities available for-

(a) Students from SC/ST, OBC and economically weaker sections?

A Special SC-ST Cell has been set up with students’ representative from the respective category along with members from the faculty, administrative staff and

civil society to address their special needs and grievances, if any.

Students are provided necessary counsellingsupport for obtaining financial assistance

from the State Government under the scholarship schemes for SC /ST/ OBC and

economically backward students.

Special bridge courses are offered to such students to bring them at par with other

students.

A provision has been made for issuing one extra book from the library to the students

belonging to SC/ST, OBC and economically weaker sections of the society.

(b) Students with physical disability?

Since its inception in 2001, the institute had only two students with physical disabilities so far.

Varun Desai (2008-10) - running his own flourishing business in Kheralu

town of North Gujarat.

Uday Kachhadia (2011-13) – gainfully employed in an organization at

Ankleshwar in South Gujarat

Creating awareness among the faculty about disability related issues and sensitizing them about

special needs of the disabled persons.

Providing barrier free environment.

Providing health and academic counseling.

Giving concessions in leave rules on health grounds.

Page 126: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

(c) Overseas students

No overseas students have enrolled with the institute so far. Nevertheless the institute has a facilitating

mechanism in place in the form of the L. J. Centre of International Affairs which has been created with a

futuristic vision of creating an international presence.

(d) Students to participate in various competitions/ National and International?

The institute always motivates, promotes and supports students to participate in various academic/non-

academic competitions at national and international levels such as case study competitions, SIP report

presentations, co-curricular and extra-curricular activities at university level, inter college level and state

level.

The institute supports students participating in various competitions in the following ways:

Provides transportation facility

Hires experts to provide mentorship and training to prepare students for competitions e.g.

engaging choreographers for various forms of dancing.

Pays rent for costumes required for drama, dances or mime.

Makes necessary equipments, instruments and properties available for cultural activities, art

activities as well as sports.

Provides adequate academic and administrative compensation to students participating in various

events/competitions, e.g. submission deadlines are extended where necessary.

(e) Medical assistance to students: health center, health insurance etc.

There is a Health Centre in the institute for providing medical and health care services to

students, faculty and other staff. There is a qualified doctor to take care of the Health Centre. It

has all basic equipments and important medicines for providing first aid services. Services of the

Health Centre are available to students, faculties and the entire staff of other institutes on the

campus.

For diagnostic purposes the institute has a tie-up with a pathological laboratory at subsidized

rates.

Emergency cases are referred to hospitals with the help of the 108 services, with a staff member

who waits there till parents/relatives of the patient take charge of their ward.

(f) Organizing coaching classes for competitive exams

Generally the students pursuing MBA do not target competitive examinations. However, the institution

equips students for placement by training them for various companies as well as public sector banks for

their recruitment. The institution provides them training towards enhancing computing skills, quantitative

skills, English proficiency and General Knowledge which are useful in competitive examinations.

(g) Skill Development (spoken English, Computer literacy, etc.)

Diagnostic tests are conducted for the students to identify their proficiency level in the English

language. This test is conducted within a month of their joining the institute so as to identify areas

where the students would need extra inputs to improve their skills. Then specially designed

training programmes are conducted to improve their communication skills.

Page 127: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Classes are conducted to impart basic computer knowledge to students. The exercise is

conducted under a well designed programme called ‘Executive Personality Development Programme’ (EPDP) which covers communication skill, interview skill, resume writing,

grooming, mock interviews, and group discussions. The programme is useful in developing the

overall personality of students and enhancing their soft skills.

(h) Support for ‘slow learners’

Continuous student monitoring, counsellingwith the mentor and conducting diagnostics tests play a very

crucial part in identifying the slow learners. Besides EPDP and ‘English Language Learning’ programmes, remedial classes and extra tutorials are conducted for slow learners to enable them to

overcome their limitations. The focus is on improving the respective subject knowledge, personality

development, personal grooming, communication skills etc.

(i) Exposures of students to other institutions of higher learning/corporate/business house etc.

The institute has put in place the following systems/channels to provide the students exposure to

industries/corporate houses/institutions of higher learning:

EXPLORE (Excellence in Practical Learning Over Real Encounter): Under this industrial visits

are conducted to expose students to the dynamics of the corporate world, making them

understand various business processes through direct interaction with personnel in the Industry.

Students visit various manufacturing firms in groups of fifteen along with a faculty. Visits at

different industries ranging from small industrial units at GIDC to large corporate houses like

Adani port, Coca Cola, Mother Dairy etc. have been arranged during the last few years. Now, the

institute is focusing on Small and Medium Scale industries, where students are able to interact

directly with the owner. They learn production process, quality control, time management, supply

chain and distribution etc.

Summer Internship Programme (SIP): Summer Internship is a part of university curriculum. It

is mandatory for each student to undergo an internship of 6 to 8 weeks at the end of the first year.

Placement for the internship is done through the campus. This activity provides students an

opportunity to work directly with the corporate and gives them an exposure to real time corporate

world. They also get an idea of their own strengths and weaknesses to work with corporate and

can focus on developing their personal capabilities.

Prashikshan – the Managerial Skills Development Programme: The best way to gain good

quality learning is to align with the corporate world through a job-training programme. This

programme aims at providing the students with the opportunity of consolidating and applying

theory through field experience. A part time role for a short duration of one to two weeks helps

them to build confidence and make useful employer contacts which may even lead to a permanent

job placement.

Vikalp - The Case Study Forum: This involves visits to identified industries, data collection,

data analysis and case writing by students of the first year divided in groups of 12 to 15 each

under the guidance of a faculty member. This activity develops students’ insight and understanding of the functioning in the corporate world.

Students are exposed to various institutions of higher learning mainly through participation in

various academic, co-curricular and extra-curricular programmes and competitions. They become

familiar with different institutional cultures and also get an opportunity to mingle with their peers

from other institutions.

The students get a firsthand exposure to the expertise available in other institutions of higher

learning as well industries in various programmes organized by the institute where eminent

Page 128: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

experts are invited. Programmes such as MAX, FINEX, HRX, CRADLE, and Expert Lecture

Series are conducted where faculties from institutions such as IIM-A, EDI and MICA are invited.

(j) Publication of student magazine

‘KSHITIJ’ is the wall magazine of students of LJMBA. A notice board is allotted for the magazine. A

committee of students under the guidance of faculty work towards publishing an issue monthly. In a year

about 6-7 issues are displayed. Contributions are invited from students. Students come up with a variety

of contributions in the form of an essay, assembly of news, poems, paintings, photographs, cartoons,

sketches etc. The team of faculty and students filter the best and the relevant contributions for the display.

Each issue can display about 10 to 15 contributions in the allotted space.

5.1.5 Describe the efforts made by the institution to facilitate entrepreneurial skills, among the

students and the impact of the efforts

Teaching a Course of Entrepreneurship

The institute offers an elective course in Entrepreneurial Development, designed by the University. The

course is a blend of theoretical and practical aspects. The institute has designed its own delivery strategy

under which students are asked to identify a prospective area to carry out business and they are guided to

prepare a business plan for the same. Students have to undertake a market survey as well as prepare

financial projections. More than 500 students have opted for this course in last three years

Students are also encouraged to take up preparing a business plan for their Comprehensive Project.

Promoting Entrepreneurship among Students

Every year the institute organizes Archetype, the Management Model Competition which is compulsory

for all students of the first year. In this competition, students in a group of 6 to 7 are guided by the faculty

and supported by the institution to prepare a business plan and a prototype. They are required to present

their business plan before all students and the faculty. Evaluation is done by experts from industries.

Guest Lectures

The institute has initiated a guest lecture series under a programme named CRADLE (Capacity

Recognition And Development Lessons in Entrepreneurship) with the primary objective of inculcating

entrepreneurial spirit among students. Under this series, successful first generation entrepreneurs are

invited to share their experiences with students. This unique initiative of the institute has achieved

“Pedagogical Innovation Award 2013” by the Gujarat Technological University.

The Business Incubator

In order to boost the entrepreneurial spirit among the students, Lok Jagruti Kendra (LJK) has set up

“ANTRAPRENEUR - the Business Incubator” for translating entrepreneurial ideas into reality. Its Chief

Operating Officer ( COO) is Dr. Abhijeet Singh- a faculty of LJIMS. The setting up of the business

incubator is a part of LJK’s vision to attain excellence in imparting quality education. The mission of

ANTRAPRENEUR is to develop institutional support mechanism for prospective entrepreneurs so as to

foster the growth of entrepreneurship amongst the students, faculty and the society at large as well as to

promote entrepreneurship and self-employment amongst students as an attractive and viable career

option. ANTRAPRENEUR began with a start-up week from 23rd

to 29th September 2013 with the aim to

help students to set up their business venture. The event witnessed more than 10,000 students from across

LJ campus being sensitized, 463 business ideas generated, 20 best ideas filtered by the judges that were

sent to Antrapreneur for incubation. At present there are 9 projects under incubation.

Page 129: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Impact of the efforts:

Due to constant exposure to activities mentioned above and the overall environment conducive to growth

of entrepreneurship, many students of MBA have chosen to start their business venture.

5.1.6 Enumerate the policies and strategies of the institution which promote participation of

students in extracurricular and co-curricular activities such as sports, games, quiz competitions,

debate and discussions, cultural activities etc.

(a) Policies:

To organize co-curricular and extra-curricular activities for ensuring the overall development of

students during an academic year.

To involve all faculty members and students, in a systematic way, in planning and organization of

all activities.

To encourage students to participate in youth festival and sports meet organized by the university

as well as cultural festivals/technical events and other academic programmes organized by other

B Schools of the country.

To provide incentives, relaxations and support to students for participation as well to give special

awards to those who excel at the University/inter-university/national level.

To provide academic support by organizing special sessions for students who may have missed

their studies due to participation in activities at the university/inter-university level.

(b) Strategies:

All activities, as planned by the institution in its academic calendar, are organized and

coordinated by faculty members with active involvement of students.

In the beginning of the year various activities are allocated to different faculty coordinators (and

the team) and they are required to prepare and submit respective activity plans along with the

probable dates to the Director.

The plans are further coordinated by a senior faculty who later prepares the institutional calendar.

Faculty coordinators of activities make different committees of students. Students are encouraged

to plan and organize activities.

After the completion of each activity/event, the faculty coordinators have to submit a report

which is uploaded on the institute website.

Some activities are class-specific, others are specialization-specific and still others are general. So

they are conducted accordingly, and with active involvement of student coordinators which

ensures wider participation.

5.1.7 Enumerate on the support and guidance provided to the students in preparing for the

competitive exams, give details on the number of students appeared and qualified in various

competitive exams such as UGC-CSIR-NET, UGC-NET, SLET,

ATE/CAT/GRE/TOFFEL/GMAT/Central/ State services, Defense, Civil Services, etc.

L. J. Institute of Management Studies offers a PG programme in management. It is a professional course.

Students opting for this course are enrolled with the aim of having a career in the corporate world, so they

do not target other competitive examinations.

5.1.8 What type of counselling services are made available to the students (academic, personal,

career, psycho-social etc.)

Page 130: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Section Head Mechanism and Counselling: Student counselling is done at several levels. In

order to provide counselling and mentoring by maintaining one-to-one interaction with students,

the institute has designed a unique Section Head mechanism wherein each senior faculty member

is assigned one class of 60 students. The Section Head is a contact point for students who

regularly interacts with the students. They provide personal and academic counselling, monitor

attendance, overall progress, and help them overcome challenges (if any).

Career Counselling: Students are given career counselling in various ways.

It starts with the induction of first year students where diagnostic test and mock interviews

are conducted to determine their IQ, communication skills, group discussion, resume

building, interview skill and other soft skills. Based on the findings of the test and the mock

interviews, students are groomed likewise.

Students are counselled for the Summer Internship Project (SIP) at the end of their first year.

This is their first corporate immersion experience. They are oriented about corporate

professionalism, etiquettes, punctuality and ethics. Their interest and aptitude for the subject

is checked and accordingly they are counselled to opt for a particular specialization.

For the final placement, the Placement Team conducts mock interviews (video recorded) at

the beginning of the third semester and guides students about relevant job profiles and career

options. The alumni also actively participate in counseling students about the market

scenario. Placement Team also trains the students in resume writing, facing interviews,

making presentation, selection of industry and salary negotiation.

5.1.9 Does the institution have a structured mechanism for career guidance and placement of its

students? If ‘yes’, detail on the services provided to help students identify job opportunities and

prepare themselves for interview and the percentage of students selected during campus interviews

by different employers (list the employers and the programmes)

Yes, the career guidance and placement service to the students are provided by the placement team in two

stages, one during Summer Internship Programme and second during Final Placement.

Summer Internship

Student counselling focuses on two aspects first, training students for soft skills and second, guiding them

for undergoing internship. For the first, various diagnostic exercises are conducted during the first

semester such as aptitude test, pros test, group discussion, micro presentations and mock interviews in

order to identify areas of weakness. Students are given training for communication skills, GDs and

interview skills during 2nd

semester.

Student orientation sessions for summer internship begin during the 2nd

semester. Students are introduced

to various possible specializations in the initial sessions. The subject faculty gives them an outline of the

subject. These orientation sessions focus on skills required and possible job profiles. In addition,

experienced professionals from corporate are also invited to interact with students.

There is a summer internship placement team comprising of faculty and students who coordinate with

companies for placement and also finds summer placement opportunities for students.

The institute has a structured mechanism for auditing performance of students during their summer

internship. Faculties are allocated different companies for visit. During the visit, faculty interacts with the

company guide for student’s performance.

Final Placement

Page 131: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

The institute has a well-established placement cell working to provide services to help students identify

job opportunities. The cell works at two fronts- first, strengthening performance of candidates and second,

as platform for promoting corporate and student interaction. Following are major services provided by the

cell

a) Mock interviews: A mock interview is conducted for all the students where they are assessed on

various parameters like dressing, etiquette, presentation, confidence level and assertiveness.

b) Resume building exercises: Special workshops are conducted with the students to teach them

effective resume writing. They are taught to design their resume as per the job description of the

company and how to highlight their positive points in order to create a positive impression

through the resume.

c) Executive Personality Development Programme: It is a semester long programme where students

are prepared in the following areas:

a. Personality Analysis: As a part of the EPDP, all students are subjected to personality

questionnaires to understand their personality traits and their mindset for the career

they aspire to make. The personality questionnaires used are:

a. Left Brain and Right Brain type.

b. MBTI – Myer Briggs type personality indicators.

c. Type of ego states – Transactional analysis.

d. Locus of control.

Once the student undertakes the questionnaire, he/she is oriented on choosing a career that suits

his/her personality.

d) Immersion: Based on the current scenario and industry trends, the institute decided to focus on

the training and development of its students. The programme was initiated in 2013-14 with an

objective to train students in communication skills, facing interviews, confidence building,

subject content, etc. The programme was scheduled for 7 days, each day focusing on

development of various skills. Approximately 230 students participated and benefited from the

immersion programme. Faculty shared their expertise in this programme through various practical

exercises.

These activities were conducted on individual and basis. The students are rated by expert faculties on

scale of 1 to 10 on the basis of their performance wherein 1-3 = Excellent Performance, 4-6 = Average

Performance / Needs Improvement and 7-10 = Poor Performance / Full Intervention. This activity was

conducted with the help of Professors listed below.

Date Programme / Activity

26/2/2014 Presentation on random topics

28/2/2014 Presentation on self with Question & Answer.

1/3/2014 Speech on “Turning point of my life”

3/3/2014 Role Play

4/3/2014 Comprehension writing

5/3/2014 Group Discussion

6/3/2014 Mock Interview

Sr. no. Name of the Professor

Page 132: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

e) P

r

e

p

a

r

i

ng

SStudents are also given specific specialized training as per the requirement of company. For

example following training programmes were organized to suit specific requirements of the

company:

TCS – Aptitude, Soft skills, General Awareness

XL Dynamics- Aptitude, Soft skills, General Awareness

SNL Financial – Basic Computer, Soft skills

Vodafone – Students had to visit store to experience live work environment, and also they had to

give presentation on the same.

Woodland - Students had to visit store to experience live work environment, and also they had to

give presentation on the same.

VIP – General Awareness and Accounting.

Following table provides statistical analysis of placement achievement of last four years.

Year No. Of students

needing

placement

No. of students

opted for self

placement

No of

students

placed in

private

sector

No. Of students

placed in Govt.

Sector

% of

placement

achieved

2014-2015 281 19 229 10 85

2013-2014 264 36 219 5 85

2012-2013 262 38 202 8 80

2011-2012 260 40 202 3 79

5.1.10 Does the institution have a student grievance redressal cell? If ‘yes’, list (if any) the grievances reported and redressed during the last four years.

Yes, the institution has a properly constituted Grievance Redressal Cell (GRC) addressing the grievances

of both students as well as staff. The institute conducts the process of handling the grievances in a fair

1 Dr. Siddarth Singh Bist

2 Dr. Abhinava Singh

3 Dr. Anitha Sunil

4 Dr. Manisha Jalla Dhar

5 Prof. Sushma Jacob

6 Prof. Raji Bhavsar

7 Prof. Kiran Khatri

8 Prof. Himani Sheth

9 Prof. Nidhi Srivastava

10 Prof. Dhrupa Trivedi

11 Prof. Ramzan Sama

Page 133: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

manner by ensuring that the grievances are handled with transparency and consistency. However,

grievances redressal mechanism for students operates at two levels: (a) at the level of Section Head, and

(b), through the Grievance Redressal Cell. The institute proactively takes care to see that students face no

problems. So students have very few grievances to report to the GRC. Few grievances got reported during

the last four years, and they were resolved promptly. An indicative list of grievances reported and

redressed during the last four years is as follows:

Sr.

No

Grievance Date and Time of

Reporting

Date on which Issue

was resolved

1 The LCD in room no 302, Section-A Sem-1

is not functioning

15th September 2013

2.00pm

17th September 2013

2 Complaints were received about cases of

theft in the class room

CCTV camera are installed in all class

rooms

September 2013 November 2013

3 Students complained about unavailability of

textbooks during exam time.

More Text books were made available in

the library. Each student is issued two

textbooks at the beginning of the semester,

which he/she can keep for the entire

semester.

April 2013 August 2013

4 Theft of Laptop from rack placed outside

the library

3rd

Sept 2014 10th Sept

5 Poor cleanliness in wash rooms

Immediately contractor was summoned and

more frequent rounds of cleaning wash

rooms was ensured

December 2014 December 2014

5.1.11 What are the institutional provisions for resolving issues pertaining to sexual harassment?

The Institute established a Collegiate Women’s Development Cell (CWDC) in 2008 for (i) creating awareness and (ii) for resolving problems of women. The members of CWDC go to each

class to explain the objectives, activities and names of representatives of CWDC. Names and

contact details of the faculty-in-charge are displayed on the notice boards. The CWDC conducts

various activities every year in the direction of awareness creation that includes guest lectures and

workshops.

Due to the overall environment on the campus and the proactive approach of the management no

incident of sexual harassment has occurred in the institute so far. However, the institute has put in

place a strategy to deal with incidents of sexual harassment as and when reported: the CWDC

team would investigate the case, verify the facts and take necessary actions against the culprit

depending on the magnitude of the problem. The institute has installed CCTV cameras at various

places in the campus and activities on the campus are constantly monitored that helps to avoid

any untoward incident.

LJ has nurtured the rich tradition of ensuring discipline on the campus right from the date of

commencement of the institute. There is policy of zero tolerance to indiscipline and this tradition

has helped making the LJ campus a ‘Safe Campus’.

Page 134: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

5.1.12 Is there an anti-ragging committee? How many instances (if any) have been reported

during the last four years and what actions have been taken on these?

Yes, there is an Anti-ragging Committee, centrally operated for the campus, with representatives drawn

from all institutes. However, not a single case of ragging of any type has taken place since the inception

of any of the institutes.

5.1.13 Enumerate the welfare schemes made available to students by the institution.

The institute undertakes various welfare programmes for students:

Students are issued text books of two subjects from the library for the entire semester. This is

over and above the books that students can borrow from the library.

The institute has a health center attended by a qualified doctor. It provides all first-aids and basic

medicines to students.

The institute supports the students participating and winning in state/national level sports events.

5.1.14 Does the institution have a registered Alumni Association? If ‘yes’, what are its activities and major contribution for institutional, academic and infrastructure development?

Yes, the institute has an Alumni Association, “Antarang”, which was established in 2008. Its registration

is under process.

The notable activities/contribution of the Alumni is as follows:

Getting approvals for industrial visits to;

Generating effective leads for Summer as well as Final Placements;

Interacting with students for career guidance and sharing corporate experiences

Giving services as mentors or judges in various students’ projects like the management model competition etc;

Participating as resource persons in various pre-placements training programmes including mock

interviews and Executive Personality Development Programme;

Helping the institute conduct internal viva for the Comprehensive Project and the Global Country

Study Report project;

Organizing an alumni meet every year as a part of the annual event of the institution

Publishing ‘Antarang’ and circulating it to all alumni.

The matter of contribution to the infrastructure development of the institute is under active

consideration of the alumni.

5.2 Student Progression

5.2.1 Provide the percentage of students progressing to higher education or employment (for the

last four batches) highlight the trends observed

As the institute is conducting professional higher education programme of postgraduate level, the students

pursuing MBA/MCA generally target employment or self-employment rather than further higher

education.

Page 135: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

MBA

Year No. Of students

need placement

No. of students

opted for self

placement

No of

students

placed in

private

sector

No. Of students

placed in Govt.

Sector

% of

placement

achieved

2014-2015 281 19 229 10 85

2013-2014 264 36 219 5 85

2012-2013 262 38 202 8 80

2011-2012 260 40 202 3 79

MCA

Year No. of students

needing

placement

No. of students

opted for self

placement

No of

students

placed in

private

sector

No. Of students

placed in Govt.

Sector

% of

placement

achieved

2014-2015 32 5 13 Nil 40

2013-2014 31 10 13 Nil 43

2012-2013 32 11 14 Nil 41

2011-2012 20 5 7 Nil 32

5.2.2 Provide details of the programme wise pass percentage and completion rate for the last four

years (cohort wise/batch wise as stipulated by the university)? Furnish programme-wise details on

comparison with that of the previous performance of the same institution and that of the colleges of

the affiliating university within the city / district.

Following table provides batch wise results of students for each semester and a comparison with

university results.

Batch 2010-12

Semester Name of Institute Total Students

Appeared Pass Fail Percentage

Passing %

of Uni.

I

LJIMS 120 64 56 53.33

LJIMS Second

Shift 117 42 75 35.90

II

LJIMS 117 82 35 70.09

60.97 LJIMS Second

Shift 115 56 59 48.70

III LJIMS 116 59 57 50.86

57.30

LJIMS Second

Shift 114 60 54 52.63

Page 136: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

IV LJIMS 117 79 38 67.52

65.22

LJIMS Second

Shift 113 75 38 66.37

Batch 2011-13

Semester Name of Institute Total Students

Appeared Pass Fail Percentage

Passing %

of Uni.

I

LJIMS 177 74 103 41.80

39.79 LJIMS Second

Shift 111 63 48 56.68

II

LJIMS 177 44 133 24.86

32.87 LJIMS Second

Shift 113 33 80 29.2

III

LJIMS 166 95 71 57.23

54.47 LJIMS Second

Shift 115 53 62 46.09

IV

LJIMS 166 114 52 68.67

58.64 LJIMS Second

Shift 110 69 41 62.73

Batch 2012-14

Semester Name of Institute Total Students

Appeared Pass Fail Percentage

Passing %

of Uni.

I

LJIMS 177 47 130 26.55

27.21 LJIMS Second

Shift 119 39 80 32.77

II

LJIMS 173 34 139 19.65

24.01 LJIMS Second

Shift 113 25 88 22.12

III

LJIMS 172 86 86 50 49.53

LJIMS Second

Shift 111 53 58 47.75

IV

LJIMS 169 106 63 62.72

62.17 LJIMS Second

Shift 111 63 48 56.76

Batch 2013-15

Page 137: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Semester Name of Institute Total Students

Appeared Pass Fail Percentage

Passing %

of Uni.

I LJIMS 179 57 122 31.84 26.57

LJIMS Second

Shift 119 31 88 26.05

II LJIMS 171 44 127 25.73 34.72

LJIMS Second

Shift 113 44 69 38.93

III LJIMS 163 80 83 49.08 61.46

LJIMS Second

Shift 107 48 59 44.86

IV LJIMS 161 99 62 61.49 72.69

LJIMS Second

Shift 101 56 45 55.45

5.2.3 How does the institution facilitate student progression to higher level of education and/ or

towards employment?

The institution has taken various initiatives and created mechanisms to facilitate student progression

towards employment or self-employment. There is an Industry Interaction and Placement Cell (IIPC),

and a separate dedicated Placement Cell for LJMBA to plan and execute pre-placement and placement

services and provide all necessary support to students. Various programmes are conducted in a planned

way to ensure students’ effective progression to their desired goal. Mock Interviews are conducted at the beginning of semester -1 to identify strengths, weaknesses

and the skills of students,. This one-to- one interaction helps the institute understand students’ aptitude and suitability for specific profiles. Then training programmes in respective areas are

designed and conducted for students.

Executive Personality Development Programme (EPDP): It is a semester long programme

focused at personality development of students. It begins with personality analysis to understand

their personality traits as explained in 5.1.9.

On the basis of the analysis of the test, students are oriented regarding their personality and

guided towards choosing the possible career option.

Resume preparation: Special workshops are conducted with the students to teach them effective

resume writing. They were taught how to design their resume as per the job description of the

company and how to highlight their positive points.

Students are provided exposure to professionals, invited under MAX, FINEX and HRX, from

the corporate world who share their experience with students. This motivates and helps them in

improving their performance.

The institute organizes Industrial Visits to give students practical exposure of corporate work

culture that helps to motivate and help students shape their future goals.

VIKALP – The case study forum: This involves visits to identified industries, data collection,

data analysis and case writing by students of the first year divided in groups of 12 to 15 each

under the guidance of a faculty member. This activity develops students’ insight into and understanding of the functioning of the corporate world.

Page 138: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Archetype: Every year the institute organizes, Archetype, the Management Model Competition

which is compulsory for all students of the first year. In this competition, students are

encouraged, guided and supported by the institution to prepare a business plan.

Prashikshan: Prashikshan-The Managerial Skills Development Programme is envisaged to

impart both theoretical and practical knowledge to the students to make them confident and

effective managers in the future. This is a job-training programme, which provides a platform to

students taking up a short time assignment.

CRADLE: (Capacity Recognition And Development Lessons in Entrepreneurship) As a part of

our strategy to promote Entrepreneurship skills amongst students, LJMBA has created CRADLE,

under which successful entrepreneurs are invited to share their experiences and interact with

students and faculty members.

Antrapreneur: The Business Incubator : The mission of ANTRAPRENEUR is to develop

institutional support mechanism for prospective entrepreneurs so as to foster the growth of

entrepreneurship amongst the students, faculty and the society at large as well as to promote

entrepreneurship and self-employment amongst students as an attractive and viable career option.

5.2.4 Enumerate the special support provided to students who are at risk of failure and

drop out?

Academically weak students are identified in the process of continuous evaluation.

Faculty members conduct remedial classes for their respective subjects as and when required.

These classes are additional inputs including subject revision for the academically weak students.

Faculty members and/or the dean boost morale of weak students by giving counselling with the

main objective to help them cope up with their studies. On several occasions the parents are also

called in to understand various aspects that affect students’ performance in order to boost improvement.

Students failing in internal evaluation are offered remedial exams so as to help them to improve

their score as required by the university.

A special study material is created for students who are weak and need academic support.

5.3 Student Participation and Activities

5.3.1 List the range of sports, games, cultural and other extracurricular activities available to

students. Provide details of participation and programme calendar.

Students are offered a wide range of co-curricular and extra-curricular activities to participate. They get

opportunities to participate in various events at university/inter-institute events as well as internal events.

Following is the list of sports, cultural, extra-curricular and co-curricular activities available to students:

Sports Cultural Co-Curricular/Extra-

Curricular

Cricket Drama Quiz

Volley ball Dance Ad making

Basket Ball Garba Night Poster making

Table Tennis Music Elocution

Page 139: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Chess Mimicry Debate (VIMARSH)

Mime Film viewing and reviewing

(XCEL)

Rangoli Seminars (including MAX,

FINEX, HRX, CRADLE)

Poster Making Case Study discussion

(VIKALP)

Collage Workshops

Cartooning Industrial visits

Fashion Show Theme based celebration of

days

Wall paper magazine

Social work

National Seminar on

Entrepreneurship

National Day Celebration at

GTU

For sports and cultural activities, the institute organizes two annual festivals- Khel Sangram for sports and

Adventure for cultural activities. The co-curricular and extra-curricular activities are carried out

throughout the year. There is a separate time slot allotted for these activities thrice a week.

Following table provides details Of Student Participation during last four years in various activities:

Cultural Activities:

External Activity Internal activity No of students

participated

Year

Teachers day

celebration

All students Sept. 2011

Fresher’s party All Students Sept. 2011

GTU Youth Festival 52 LJIMS Students in

competition ,50

Students in

Organisaiton

Oct. 2011

LJ no Sanedo Garba

Night

More than 100 students

have participated

Oct. 2011

Kite flying

competition

More than 50 students

have participated

Jan. 2012

Days celebration All students have

participated

Feb. 2012

Adventure Singing 13 students March 2012

Adventure solo dance 12 Students March 2012

Adventure Group

dance

80 Students March 2012

Management games 60 students March 2012

Rock concert 15 students March 2012

Alumni meet 35 students in

organisation

March 2012

Farewell Party All students March 2012

Page 140: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Cultural Festival at

B.K

10 students Feb 2012

Cultural festival at

SLIMS

8 students Feb 2012

Aagman All students Aug 2012

Teachers day All students Sept ,2012

Freshers Party All students Sept ,2012

GTU Youth Festival 49 Students from

LJIMS, 30 students in

Organization

Oct,2012

LJ No Sanedo Garba

Night

More than 200 students Oct 2012

Days celebration All students Jan,2013

Adventure Dancing 85 Students march,2013

Adventure Fashion

show &Management

Games

100 students March 2013

International Visit To

Malaysia

34 Students March 2013

Farewell Party All students March,2013

Aagman All students 11 Aug,2014

Independence Day All Students 15 Aug,2014

Teachers Day All Students 5 Sept,2014

GTU Youth Festival 45 Students 18 Sept to 20

Sept,2014

LJ no Sanedo- Garba

Night

More than 150 Students 26,27 Sept 2014

Fresher’s Party All Students 23 Sept,2014

Sports Activity

External Internal Participation of

students

Month and Year

Khel Sangram Sports

week

208 Jan,2011

GTU Cricket

Tournament

15 Jan ,2011

GTU valley ball

Tournament

15 Jan,2011

Khel Sangram Sports

week

260 Feb,2012

GTU Cricket

Tournament

15 Jan ,2012

GTU valley ball

Tournament

15 Jan,2012

Gujarat Cricket 15 FEB ,2012

Page 141: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Championship By

PDPU

Khel Sangram 280 Jan,2013

LJ Cup 50 Feb,2013

GTU Cricket

Tournament

15 Jan ,2013

GTU valley ball

Tournament

15 Jan,2013

Gujarat Cricket

Championship By

PDPU

15 FEB ,2013

Khel Sangram 280 Jan,2014

LJ Cup 50 Feb,2014

GTU Cricket

Tournament

15 Jan ,2014

GTU valley ball

Tournament

15 Jan,2014

Management Activities

External Internal Participation Of

students

Month, Year

Seminar 100 March,2011

Archetype All First year Students Feb,2011

Envisage All First year students Feb,2011

Participated at

Ganapat University in

business Plan

8

March 2011

Participated at Changa

Institute For

Management activities

10 March,2011

MAX 107 Sept,2012

FINEX 200 Sept,2012

VIKALP All Students Throughout the year

VIMARSH All Students Throughout the year

XCEL All Students Throughout the year

Mindstein All Students Throughout the year

CRADLE –Interactive

sessions

All Students Throughout the year

Start up week All Final year Students Sept,2012

Participated at

Ganapat Unversity

For Summer project

presentation

10 Oct,2012

Archetype All First year Students Feb,2012

Envisage All First year students Feb,2012

Participated at

Ganapat University in

business Plan

8

March 2012

Participated at Changa 10 March,2012

Page 142: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Institute For

Management activities

MAX 107 Sept,2013

FINEX 200 Sept,2013

VIKALP All Students Throughout the year

VIMARSH All Students Throughout the year

XCEL All Students Throughout the year

Mindstein All Students Throughout the year

CRADLE –Interactive

sessions

All Students Throughout the year

LJK Start up week All Final year Students Sept,2013

Participated at

Ganapat Unversity

For Summer project

presentation

10 Oct,2013

Archetype All First year Students Feb,2013

Envisage All First year students Feb,2013

Participated at

Ganapat University in

business Plan

8

March 2013

Participated at Changa

Institute For

Management activities

10 March,2013

MAX 107 Sept,2013

FINEX 200 Sept,2013

VIKALP All Students Throughout the year

VIMARSH All Students Throughout the year

XCEL All Students Throughout the year

Mindstein All Students Throughout the year

CRADLE –Interactive

sessions

All Students Throughout the year

Participated at

Ganapat Unversity

For Summer project

presentation

8 Oct,2014

Archetype-Business

Model Development

All First Year Students Sept,2014

Following is the calendar for Adventure 2014, showing details of activities that were organized in this

programme.

Samarth a Cause 1st Mar 2014 9:00 Onwards

Box Cricket 1st Mar 12:00 Onwards

Cultural Festival 1st Mar 5:30 Onwards

Ahmedabad Hunt 2nd Mar 9:30 Onwards

Box Cricket 2nd Mar 12:00 Onwards

Page 143: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Mindstein 2nd Mar 1:00 Onwards

Ad Mania 2nd Mar 3:30 Onwards

One minute Game 2nd Mar 1:00 Onwards

LAN Games 2nd Mar 9:30 Onwards

Cultural Festival 2nd Mar 5:30 Onwards

Business Baazigar 3rd Mar 9:30 Onwards

Fun Mania 3rd Mar 10:30 Onwards

LAN Games 3rd Mar 9:30 Onwards

Box Cricket 3rd Mar 12:00 Onwards

Prize Distribution 3rd Mar 4:30 Onwards

Alumni Meet 3rd Mar 6:30 onwards

Students Activity Calendar for the Year 2014-15:

Co curricular Activity Extra Curricular Activity Dates

Aagman 2014,Induction

Programme

11/08/14

Independence day celebration 15/08/14

Teachers Day Celebration 5/09/14

CRADLE Session 11/09/14

GTU Youth Festival 18/09/14 to 20/09/14

Archetype –Business model

Presentation

22/09/14 and 23/09/14

Fresher’s Party 23/09/14

‘LJ no Sanedo’ Navaratri celebration

26/09/14 and 27/09/14

VIKALP –case study

Discussion

29/09/14 and 30/09/14

VIMARSH 8/10/14 and 9/10/14

Xcel -1 10/10/14

Mind stein 13/10/14 and 14/10/14

KSHITIJ -Inauguration of

wall magazine

16/10/14

Expert Lecture 20/10/14

Inauguration of Pardesh

gallery

21/10/14

Reincarnation 22/10/14

Alumni meeting 13/01/15

VIKALP Visits 10/01/15 to 24/01/15

Khel Sangram 19/01/15 to 24/01/15

Theatre Work Shop 27/01/15 to 31/01/15

FINEX/MAX/HRX 1/02/15 to 7/02/15

VIMARSH 9/02/15

Page 144: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Mindstein 10/02/15

VIKALP Case writing

workshops

18/02/15 and 19/02/15

Days celebration 18/02/15 and 19/02/15

Envisage 18/02/15

Adventure day 1 and day 2 20/02/15 and 21/02/15

CEO Series 1st week of March

Guest lecture on women

empowerment

5/03/15

Campus walk –CWDC

Activity

7/03/15

Cultural Activities (MCA)

External

Activity Internal activity No of students participated Year

Blood Donation 7 2015

Enthusia -2015- Dance 2 2015

Enthusia-2015- Fashion

Show 3 2015

Dayspring 2015 15 2015

Dayspring 2014 10 2014

Picnic 20 2013

Enthusia-2012 18 2012

CHESS 5 2015

100 METER RUNNING 11 2015

XITIJ- 2015-

CRICKET 16 2015

XITIJ- 2015-

BOXING 1 2015

XITIJ- 2015-

SWIMMING 1 2015

XITIJ- 2014-

CRICKET 16 2014

XITIJ- 2014-

CHESS 2 2014

XITIJ- 2014-

FOOTBALL 16 2014

SPIRIT-2013-

ATHLETICS 1 2013

SPIRIT-2013-

CRICKET 16 2013

SPIRIT-2012-

BADMINTON 5 2012

Page 145: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

5.3.2 Furnish the details of major student achievements in co-curricular, extracurricular and

cultural activities at different levels: University/ State/ Zonal/ National/ International etc. for the

previous four years.

Students participate in various events taking place across the university and have won many prizes also.

Following is the list of Winners of Youth festivals in different categories zonal and Inter zonal:

Name of Student Activity Year

Ishan Surani and Group Second Prize in Mime at GTU

Youth Festival

2011

Rutvik Karnik Second Prize Solo singing

western song at GTU Youth

Festival

2011

Rutvik and group First prize for Group singing

at GTU Youth Festival

2012

Ishan Surani and Group First Prize in Mime At GTU

Youth festival

2012

Karishma Gavai Clay modeling at GTU Youth

Festival

2012

Karishma Gavai Poster making at GTU Youth

Festival

2012

Maaz Saiyed And Tirth Patel First Prize at

Summer Project Presentation

called ‘PRATIBHA’ at Ganapat university

2014

Dilip Pandey Second Prize in Cross country

marathon, at state level, Surat

First Prize in Cross country

marathon at Cochin,

Organised by AIU

2014

Arohi Second runner up at fresh face

2013 at state level Organized

by Clean and Clear Face wash

2013

Dhruvee Bhatta First Prize at

Summer Project Presentation

called ‘PRATIBHA’ Organized Ganapat university

2014

Jignesh Vidani Second Prize at Business Plan

Competition

2012

Tirth Patel Second Prize in Photography

contest at Gujarat university

2013

Ujjaval Rajput and LJIMS

Cricket Team

All Gujarat Cricket champion

at state level Organized by

2013

Page 146: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

P.D.P.U

Viral Brahmbhatta First Prize at Singing

Competition organized by JG

Institute of Fine Arts.

2010

Viral Brahmbhatta First Prize at Singing

Competition organized by JG

Institute of Fine Arts.

2011

Ravi Patel Second Prize at Singing

Competition organized by JG

Institute of Fine Arts.

2010

Ravi Patel Third Prize at Singing

Competition organized by JG

Institute of Fine Arts

2011

Maaz Saiyed First prize at Pharma model

Organized by LM Pharma

2014

LJIMS Team Second Prize at fashion Show

Organized by SLIMS

2011

5.3.3 How does the college seek and use data and feedback from its graduates and employers, to

improve the performance and quality of the institutional provisions?

The institute has an established mechanism to gets feedbacks from different stakeholders, mainly

students, employers and alumni. The feedback is used for improving institutional performance and

quality.

Students’ Feedback

Students provide feedback at the end of every semester about one, teaching of each subject faculty and

two, infrastructure and facilities provided by the institution. Students are given a well-designed feedback

covering parameters like communication, involvement of student, examples used in class, attitude

towards students, syllabus coverage, control over class and efficient use of the lecture hour. Students give

rank to each subject faculty on the scale of 1 to 5. Only the students having more than 60 percent

attendance record are allowed to give their feedback.

The feedback from students is used to improve the teaching performance of faculty members. The

director of the institute personally share students’ feedback with each faculty and discusses the ways to improvement.

The feedback related facility and infrastructure of institute is utilized to make better provision to students

and other stakeholders.

Employers’ Feedback

The institute has evolved a mechanism to obtain feedback from employers of students for summer

internship. The summer internship is audited by faculty members. They personally visit the organisation

where students are placed and interact with their mentors. A structured questionnaire is filled by the

faculty at the time of their visit. Students’ performance is evaluated on the scale of 1 to 5 on parameters

like subject knowledge, willingness to learn new things, participation level, professionalism, soft skills,

communication skills, etc.

Page 147: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

This feedback is utilised to design skill enhancement programmes like offered to students during third and

fourth semester EPDP (for soft skill development), MAX, FINEX, HRX (for enhancing professional

skills), and Immersion (for soft skills and presentation skills).

The institute has developed a databank of companies providing summer internship and final placement to

the students. The data bank contains information on various aspects of the company like their growth and

future plans, types of departments the company has, as well as the recruitment in near future. These data

help in carrying out placement process. Also institute invites company personnel as a guest lecture to

interact with students.

Alumni Feedback

Feedback from alumni is taken on different parameters like networking, placement efforts of institute,

career counselling, etc. This feedback is utilized for better networking with alumni, improve the

placement efforts, enhance infrastructural facility, etc.

5.3.4 How does the college involve and encourage students to publish materials like catalogues,

wall magazines, college magazines, and other material? List the publications/ material brought out

by the students during previous four academic sessions.

Students contribute in terms of collection of data to facilitate a faculty members in case

writing under ‘’VIKALP’ programme

Students prepare a quarterly e-newsletter “ANTRANG” which is circulated to alumni and

corporate highlighting academic achievement and activities that run round the year.

There is no formal list of publications by the students. However students are encouraged to

contribute towards ‘Kshitij’ – the wall paper magazine.

Students compile information for the placement brochure each year.

Faculty also involves academically bright students in writing research papers.

5.3.5 Does the college have a Student council or any similar body? Give details on its selection,

constitution, activities and funding.

Though there is no formal Student Council in the institute, there is no activity of the institute that is

carried out without student volunteers. At the time of the announcement of any activity, names of

volunteers are invited. All the volunteers are assigned the task that they have to execute. Students of the

institute are actively involved in all the activities through the mechanism of Class Representatives who

are responsible for generating active participation of students in every activity. In addition to this there are

student coordinators responsible for different activities like MAX, FINEX, HRX, Cultural events,

Adventure, CRADLE. Students are also given an opportunity to interact directly with the corporate.

Activities which are conducted by students are mentioned under 5.3.1 above.

Funding for conduct of these activities comes from two main sources. First, LJK allocates a fund to each

institute to carry out student activities. Second, students are also encouraged to get sponsorship from

business houses to finance various students activities.

5.3.6 Give details of various academic and administrative bodies that have student

representatives on them.

There is no activity at the LJIMS that is been carried out without support of students’ representative. Following are various Academic and Administrative bodies that have student representatives

Page 148: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Sr. No. Name of Academic &

Administrative Bodies Description

1 Class Representatives

Every class has two student representatives who reports

to the section heads and other faculty members of the

institute. He/ She is a one point contact between students

and the faculty. They communicate any problem faced by

the class that is obstructing their learning to the section

head or the dean.

2 Summer placement co-

coordinators

A group of students are selected as a part of summer

placement team. They are the representative of all

students. They help the faculty in-charge in coordinating

internship placements.

3 Final placement coordinator

A team of few selected students is formed for

coordinating final placement activities. All the activities

starting from making of the placement broacher,

distribution of the same to various companies, inviting

corporate for campus and conducting campus drives are

managed by placement coordinators.

4 Media cell

Here a team of students is formed who takes care of all

the affairs related to media and advertisement of major

events taking place in the institute. It’s their responsibility to communicate with media and report all

the institutional activities to receive appropriate coverage.

5 Cultural committee

As a part of cultural committee, students coordinate

various cultural activities of the institute like: Adventure,

Khel Sangram, Garba night, Youth festival competition,

etc. Students’ committee decides the activities to be

included in each festival, framing of their rules and

regulations, registration of participating students,

arranging for all necessary equipment etc.

6 Seminar and conferences

committee

Series of conferences and seminars MAX, FINEX, HRX,

CRADLE, etc. take place in the institute which are again

managed by the students committee under the faculty

guidance.

7 Grievance redressal

committee

Grievance redressal committee selects few students as

their representatives to communicate grievances to the

faculty and seek appropriate resolution of the issue.

8 CWDC committee

Collegiate Women’s Development Cell is established to create awareness & resolve problems related to sexual

harassment. Two representatives from each class are

invited. Their role is to bring any harassment related

Page 149: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

issue to the notice of the committee, participate in

institutional efforts towards awareness creation and

coordinate activities initiated by CWDC.

9 Khshitij committee

KSHITIJ is a wall paper magazine run by students. The

students representatives of Kshitij collects all

contribution from students, help the coordinating faculty

is finalizing the good contribution, display the

contributions decoratively on regular basis.

10 Vikalp - case study

committee

A case study forum is established to help students write

and solve the case study effectively. For the smooth

implementation of this forum, student representatives are

selected to coordinate the activity for their respective

classes.

11 Antarang - Alumni

committee

The student representatives of Antarang – Alumni

committee works for the networking and collaboration of

the alumni of the institute.

12 QAC – Quality assurance

Cell

Students from from 1st year and 2

nd Year are selected as

student representatives of the committee looking after

quality assurance.

5.3.7 How does the institution network and collaborate with the Alumni and former faculty of the

institution.

Alumni and former faculties of the institution remain in constant touch through social networking sites,

alumni meets.

The networking and collaboration of the Alumni and former faculty is in the following manner:

Alumni helps the institute in getting approvals for industrial and other educational visits to

industries;

Alumni generate effective leads for Summer Placements as well as for the final placements;

The institute invites Alumni and former faculties as guest in various events and also as experts for

conducting guest lecturers in series such as MAX, FINEX, HRX, CRADLE where they share

their knowledge, experience and expertise in their field and motivate the students to build

successful careers.

Alumni also give their services as mentors or judges in various students projects like the

management model competition etc;

Alumni participate as resource persons in various pre-placements training programmes including

mock interviews and Executive Personality Development Programme;

Help the institute conduct internal viva for the Comprehensive Project and the Global Country

Study Report project;

The institute organizes an alumni meet every year as a part of the annual event of the institution

with wholehearted participation of the alumni;

Page 150: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

An e-magazine, ‘Antarang’ is published and circulated to all alumni providing information

updates about the alumni as well the institute.

Former faculties and Alumni visit our institute to interact with students for career guidance and

for sharing experiences in respective specialization areas

Former faculties are invited for guest lectures, faculty development programme and they are

members of different academic and administrative activities like:

Sr. No. Name of Former

Faculty Contribution towards institute

1 Dr. Ashvin Dave Member of advisory committee for institute journal

2 Prof. Shubhra Anand Guest sessions

3 Prof. Ankit Sanghvi Guest sessions

CRITERION 6: GOVERNANCE, LEADERSHIP AND MANAGEMENT

6.1 Institutional Vision and Leadership

6.1.1 State the vision and mission of the Institution and enumerate on how the mission statement

defines the institution’s distinctive characteristics in terms of addressing the needs of the society, the students it seeks to serve, institution’s traditions and value orientations, vision for the future, etc.?

Lok Jagruti Kendra (LJK):

Lok Jagruti Kendra, the Trust which established the Institute, has a rich history of nurturing educational

institutes. It has achieved its mission mainly due to the visionary leadership provided by its founders -

Prof. B. M. Peerzada, eminent educationist and former Dean, Commerce faculty, Gujarat University,

Padma Bhushan Lord Meghnad Desai, internationally renowned academician and former Professor at the

London School of Economics, Prof. Gautam Appa, former Professor at the London School of Economics,

Late Prof. M. S. Trivedi, former Vice Chancellor, Veer Narmad South Gujarat University, Surat, the

renowned jurist Shri Girish C. Patel and Shri Subodh Shah.

The Vision and Mission of LJK are as follows:

Vision

Lok Jagruti Kendra will be a key player in education and social development by promoting and nurturing

creativity, scholarship, innovation and excellence through a chain of quality institutes.

Mission

To establish and manage institutions with an environment in which new ideas, delivery strategies and

scholarship flourish and from where leaders and innovators of tomorrow shall emerge.

The Vision and Mission of LJIMS emanate from the vision and mission of LJK.

Vision: L. J. Institute of Management Studies will be a key player in management education and

corporate development by promoting creativity, scholarship, innovation and excellence.

Page 151: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Mission: L. J. Institute of Management Studies will endeavour to create dynamic professionals equipped

with conceptual clarity, practical knowledge, effective soft skills, self confidence, innovativeness and

ethical concern.

Distinctive Characteristics of the Institute:

The distinctive characteristics of the Institute spring from three main premises.

1. Innovation 2. Intellectual Capability 3. Societal Concern

Innovation: Innovation is a prime driver for excellence. The Institute firmly believes that an approach of

innovation in all institutional activities shall inculcate superior values and skills amongst students and

faculty members.

Enhancing Intellectual Capability

The Institute wants to meet the educational needs of students at various levels and support faculty

members to enhance their intellectual capacity through teaching, research, and interactions with the

society. The Institute takes initiative for students to encourage intellectual curiosity and knowledge

transmission.

Societal Concern: Preparing Students for Corporate & Social Responsibility

The institute ventures to provide students with quality education and launch them as well equipped

management professionals in the corporate world and society as reflected in the mission and objectives.

The degree of management provides a platform for acquiring expertise in functional areas to fulfill the

requirements of the corporate world. Sincere encouragement and quality education enhances the students’ knowledge and outlook and even prepares student pursuing further education at foreign universities.

6.1.2 What is the role of top management, Principal and Faculty in design and implementation of its

quality policy and plans?

a. The Role in design of the quality policy:

The idea of the Quality Policy was initially mooted by the top management and the Director of the

institute and the first design of the Quality Policy was worked out. The first draft was discussed in a

meeting with the faculty and was finalised with inputs from them.

b. The role in implementation of the quality policy:

The role of the Trust, Director, Dean and the faculty members is to continuously work in line with and

never lose track of the tenets of the Quality Policy to posterity.

B.1. Role of the Top Management:

The top management works closely and in consultation with the Director and faculty members to

allocate resources and infrastructure for successful implementation of the quality policy.

B.2. Role of the Director:

The Director’s role is pivotal in implementation of the quality policy and plans. He operates at the strategic level.

Page 152: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

B.2.1 The Director ensures that the new entrants (faculty and students) are made aware of the quality

policy and its implications are adequately explained to them at appropriate time.

B.2.2 The Director implements the quality policy in a manner that meets the myriad requirements of

different stakeholders ranging from students, faculty, employers and top management to achieve

academic excellence.

B.2.3 The Director arranges necessary infrastructure facilities and sub-systems, including library and IT

resources necessary for proper implementation of different provisions of the quality policy.

B.2.4. Motivates faculty members to impart quality education by encouraging them to use innovative

pedagogical techniques while using the quality policy as a permanent point of reference.

B.2.5 In course of regular interactions with faculty members and students, the Director constantly focuses

on discipline, integrity, espousal of moral values, social issues and academic excellence.

B.3 Role of Faculty members:

The faculty operates at a tactical level to implement the quality policy.

B.3.1 To explore and exploit the potential of students by rigorous and innovative pedagogical methods to

facilitate better learning.

B.3.2 To create and maintain quality in the teaching-learning process through innovative and

experimental pedagogical tools and systems followed by rigorous monitoring.

B.3.3 To inculcate values of discipline, integrity and academic excellence among students.

B.3.4 To provide feedback to the Director on issues related to quality in all spheres of activities including

teaching, research, infrastructure and IT facilities, student activities and library.

6.1.3 What is the involvement of the leadership in ensuring:

• The policy statements and action plans for fulfilment of the stated mission

• Formulation of action plans for all operations and incorporation of the same into the institutional

strategic plan

• Interaction with stakeholders

• Proper support for policy and planning through need analysis, research inputs and consultations with the stakeholders

• Reinforcing the culture of excellence

• Champion organizational change

The leadership which consists of trustees and Director design the policy statement and detailed actions

plans for fulfilment of the mission of the Institute.

There is a conscious effort made by the leaders to interact regularly with all key stakeholders including

teachers, students and their parents, alumni, key persons from the industry, social organizations, eminent

individuals, government officials and regulators ensuring that students and teachers continue to excel in

all their endeavours. This exercise of consultation with stakeholders enables undertaking needs analysis

and getting appropriate research inputs.

Page 153: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

The President of the trust Prof. B.M Peerzada wanted to set up a system that shall not merely be an

institute but function as a centre for excellence. It was with this aim for achieving educational excellence

that the trust was established.

6.1.4 What are the procedures adopted by the institution to monitor and evaluate policies and plans

of the institution for effective implementation and improvement from time to time?

Several procedures are adopted to monitor and evaluate policies and plans of the institute.

At the beginning of each academic session, an activity allocation exercise is carried out and shared with

all faculty members. Based on the activities allocated to them, different faculty members prepare their

action plan (along with tentative dates) for the entire academic year. These action plans are then

submitted to the Director for scrutiny and approval.

During the beginning of the academic year and as part of student induction an Academic calendar

(specifying the tentative dates for all academic, curricular, co-curricular and extra-curricular activities) is

distributed among all the students. The academic calendar gives a snapshot of the number of working

days available and the schedule of all the activities planned for the entire academic year.

As and when the activities get completed the faculty members submit their report to the Director. The

Director evaluates the activity report based on the action plans submitted. After approval these reports are

then published on the institutional website. In case of any discrepancy, appropriate feedback and

suggestions are given to the concerned faculty members. A formal feedback is also given at the time of

the review exercise which is conducted every semester.

Apart from the above procedures, there are other mechanisms that are used to evaluate the policies and

plans of the institute. These include the formal feedback mechanism and performance appraisal system.

The feedback mechanism includes- Student feedback, Library feedback and Summer Internship Program

feedback. The performance appraisal system is a self-appraisal process of the faculty. Further as a part of

the Mentorship program; Mentor-Mentee feedback is also obtained to gather the information regarding

the effectiveness of the mentorship program.

Both these mechanisms of the feedback and performance appraisal help in gathering information

regarding the performance and impact of faculty, library facilities, training facilities in the institute and

the overall teaching and learning process.

Information is also collected from mechanisms other than the ones mentioned above. Information is also

gathered from institute-industry interactions and the alumni for improvement of the institute. The

information acquired is analyzed and necessary measures are taken from time to time.

6.1.5 Give details of the academic leadership provided to the faculty by the top management?

No stones have been unturned in providing opportunities of academic leadership to the faculty. Several

systems and committees consisting of faculty members have been introduced to handle and take lead in

the institutional activities.

One such system is the Academic Review Process. As a part of this process the faculty submits their

detailed session plan, information regarding components of the continuous evaluation, teaching material

and any other information pertaining to their respective subjects being taught. Discussions are later held

with the Director and changes (if any) are incorporated in the subject files. During the discussions with

the Director if any unique practice adopted by any faculty member is found, they are shared with other

colleagues. This leads to sharing of best practices.

Page 154: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Other such system is EPDP (Executive Personality Development Program) for improving the soft skills of

students. EPDP is primarily an institutional provision for providing industry specific training to the

students. Faculties play a pivotal role in providing customized training to students by assessing the

industry needs and accordingly training the students.

Apart from these systems there are several other committees that provide opportunities to faculty to

develop academic leadership.

The Committees are as under:

Academic Committees; Student Activity Committees; Project Committees – CP, GCSR, SIP; Initiatives

Committees – CRADLE, MAX, FINEX, HRX, Vikalpa, Antarang etc; Media Cell; Research &

Publication Committee; Library Development Committee; Discipline Committee; Faculty Seminar

Committee; EPDP Committee; Anti-Ragging Committee; Women Development Cell; Grievance

Redressal Committee; Feedback Mechanism Committee; and the Parivartan-Prayas Committee.

Faculty members are assigned responsibility and given autonomy to manage the functioning of their

respective committees within the institute’s policy. The management also encourages faculty members to take up or lead activities that are outside the institute. For example, faculty and Dean of the institute

coordinate with the directives and activities of the GTU. Another faculty is the COO of Antrapreneur, an

entrepreneurship development initiative.

6.1.6 How does the college groom leadership at various levels?

As a part of the activity allocation exercise, different committees are formed for various co-curricular and

extra-curricular activities. Initially each committee consists of a senior faculty member who acts as the

coordinator and is responsible for the overall performance of the committee. The coordinator assists and

guides other members of the committee and subsequently, a new person from the committee becomes

fully trained to take up the responsibility of the coordinator.

The coordinators act in a controlled environment where they are given independent responsibility for their

assigned academic, administrative and extra-curricular activity.

Mentorship programme is an institutional mechanism for grooming new faculty members. It is another

initiative that enables inculcating leadership qualities among faculty members. After the mentor-mentee

feedback is obtained, concern areas (if any) are discussed by the Director on one-to one basis.

6.1.7 How does the college delegate authority and provide operational autonomy to the departments

/ units of the institution and work towards decentralized governance system?

In view of the academic activities and operations, the governance of the institute is decentralized. The

academic operations of the institute are divided into the following specialized areas: marketing, finance,

human resources and general management. Complete authority is delegated to each specialized area to

work out their independent pedagogical system. While preparing their subject files and specific session

plans, faculty members are free to choose any component to be included in the comprehensive list of

internal evaluation components.

Based on the academic results and placements interviews, a gap analysis exercise is conducted for each

specialized area. To fill these gaps, specific programs namely MAX, FINEX and HRX have been

introduced. The details of these programs have been mentioned later in the SSR.

Faculty members are also given the responsibility to prepare schedules, activities, and calendar for the

smooth functioning of the institute. For instance, the time tables are prepared by a faculty who heads the

Page 155: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

scheduling of the sessions, section heads (senior faculties) look after the attendance record and guide

students through counselling and mentoring.

6.1.8 Does the college promote a culture of participative management? If ‘yes’, indicate the levels of participative management.

Yes, participative culture is promoted where faculty members are involved in decision-making process

and their views are invited for various functions of the institute management.

Participative management gets reflected at the following levels:

Decision making and Policy Planning

Implementation of the plans

Monitoring

Evaluation

The activities allocation to different faculty members during a particular academic year is

done after consultation with respective faculty and taking into consideration their

interests. Once activities have been allocated to different faculty groups, a detailed action

plan is decided in advance by the entire group and submitted for approval to the Director.

Any changes to the plan are done only after holding discussions with the concerned

group.

Also senior faculty members were invited to suggest relevant codes of discipline for the students and

staff. All faculty members collectively decide on issues regarding student attendance and regularity. In

faculty meeting, decisions were taken with regard to academic facilities concerning faculty needs like

LCD monitors, faculty notice boards etc.

6.2 Strategy Development and Deployment

6.2.1 Does the Institution have a formally stated quality policy? How is it developed, driven,

deployed and reviewed?

Yes, the institution has a formally stated Quality Policy. The Quality Policy is as follows.

“Recognising the limitations of individuals and the institution, LJIMS will continuously strive to

create and maintain quality in all spheres of activities including teaching, research, consultancy,

infrastructure, equipments, selection and development of staff, student activities and library to achieve

perfection within limits by exploiting the individual potential of each student through planned academic

and co-curricular activities and technology intervention and with the help of library resources and

competent and committed faculty and thereby providing the society in general and the corporate world in

particular dynamic and forward looking managers driven by values of discipline, integrity, merit,

academic freedom and excellence.”

It was developed after a series of interactions with the members of Trust and the teaching fraternity for

continuous improvement of the institute in all aspects of the field.

The Institute strives to translate quality to its various administrative and academic activities and thereby

convert its vision into reality.

In order to reinforce and create a permanent reminder to the espousal of the Quality Policy, the same has

been framed and displayed at various places in the institute.

Page 156: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

The quality policy has been uploaded on the website and printed in the brochure. It is explained by the

Director to all the students every year during the induction meeting of the new batch. Further, new faculty

member are given orientation to the quality policy by the Director.

The quality policy may be reviewed if warranted by changes in the future.

6.2.2 Does the Institute have a perspective plan for development? If so, give the aspects considered

for inclusion in the plan.

Yes. The institute does have a perspective plan for institutional development.

Initially the infrastructure of the institute was located in Vastrapur campus. Later in 2003, the institute

was shifted to its present campus. At the beginning, the program enrolment was 40 students. The institute,

in its plan specified that it shall make efforts to get increase in intake and try to get it to the maximum

limit. In 2006, the intake increased to 180. The plan also specified institute’s intention of applying for MBA in other institutes which were proposed to be established. That is how MBA program started at L.J

Institute of Computer Applications in 2007 and L.J Institute of Engineering and Technology in 2008.

Further, as part of the plan, 2nd

shift in LJIMS commenced from 2010. Correspondingly, number of

faculty rooms increased from 1 to 3 and the institute building was further constructed to include more

floors. The building that initially started as a single floor now operates as a 4 storey building (ground + 3).

As part of library aspect, the plan specified removing the cupboards and using the complete wall space for

maximum utilization.

As far as research development is concerned the institute has clearly specified in its plans that it shall

completely support any research initiative undertaken by the faculty.

As far as technology upgradation is concerned, the perspective plan made provisions for increasing the

number of computer labs, acquiring new and latest software, increasing the broadband from 1 Mbps to 2

Mbps and replacing the bulky desktop monitors by LCDs.

Finally there have been provisions to expand the institute’s international presence by signing MOUs with International Universities.

6.2.3 Describe the internal organizational structure and decision making processes

The organizational structure of the Institute consists of the President at the top followed by the Vice

President and then the Director and Dean. The institute follows a functional organizational structure

wherein there are 4 major departments: Marketing, Finance, Human Resources and General Management.

Each of these departments is headed by a Head of Department (HOD) who directly reports to the

Director. The operations of the institute are divided into two wings -Academic and Administrative. The

academic wing includes faculty and library and the administrative wing includes office and computer

laboratory.

The decision making process at the institute is quite amicable. There are certain decisions that are jointly

taken by senior faculty members, Director and Trust. For certain other decisions, all the faculty members

are involved. For issues concerning infrastructure, Trust and Director collectively take decisions. Issues

pertaining to the teaching and non-teaching staff are discussed and decisions are taken considering the

suggestions of the staff. Decisions regarding the issues where the staff is not directly affected are taken at

the top-level management.

Page 157: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

6.2.4 Give a broad description of the quality improvement strategies of the institution for each of

the following:

Teaching & Learning

All faculties conduct an academic planning exercise at the beginning of every semester. Based on the

academic plan, an academic review is conducted at the end of the semester. The review is conducted by

the Director wherein discussions with the faculty are held regarding the adherence to the academic plan.

Gaps (if any) are identified and remedial measures are suggested to the faculty. These measures are later

implemented.

Research & Development

For the improvement of quality and development of faculty, following initiatives have been taken by the

institute: Faculty Mentorship Program, Faculty Development Program, Faculty Seminars. Faculty are

encouraged to undertake research in form of publications, conferences and seminar participation, for

which institute provides complete financial and administrative support.

Community Engagement

The Institute is very keen and acknowledges its duty towards the community/society and has conducted

workshops for development of women through the Collegiate Women Development Cell (CWDC). The

institute has arranged a blood donation camp where the faculty members, students and the non-teaching

staff have participated actively. The Parivartan-Prayas Committee is working to uplift the under-

privileged and poor children by giving them a better opportunity to develop and progress in life.

Human resource management

The Institute cares for its staff. It provides food coupons to the non-teaching staff and provides free

medical services to its teaching and non-teaching staff. Dr. Sweta Patel is the Medical Officer taking care

of the health centre at L. J. Institute.

Industry interaction

The Institute organizes number of programs for students’ exposure to the corporate world with programs

like the Marketing Excellence Series (MAX), Finance Excellence Series (FINEX), HR Excellence Series

(HRX), CRADLE (Capability Recognition and Development Lessons for Entrepreneurship), National

seminars and visits to the industries. The students get full support from the Institute during their summer

internship placements and final placements.

6.2.5 How does the Head of the institution ensure that adequate information (from feedback and

personal contacts etc.) is available for the top management and the stakeholders, to review the

activities of the institution?

Information is made available to the top management and the stakeholders by the Head of the institution

through the feedback and appraisal mechanisms besides the collection of relevant information for various

areas of the institution.

In order to obtain feedback from the students, questionnaires are circulated amongst them to measure

effectiveness of various teaching methods adopted by the faculty members. This helps the management

and the faculty members to improve themselves. The result of the feedback is discussed with every

faculty on one to one basis. Overall information obtained from the feedback is also shared with the Trust.

Page 158: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

For acquiring information of the library, there is a library feedback system to understand the needs and

improvement of the same for development. There is also an Institution performance feedback system

undertaken by the students. The purpose of this system is for the improvement of the institute on a

continuous basis. The report generated from the library feedback is discussed with the trust.

As far as the self appraisal system is concerned, faculty members are required to appraise themselves at

the end of every academic year and submit the same at the designated date. Also the students' feedback is

taken from the companies where they go for summer internships. This helps in further developing the

students’ overall performance.

These mechanisms aim to gather information regarding the performance and impact of faculty, library

facilities, training facilities et al in the institute and the overall teaching and learning process. Information,

other than the mechanisms mentioned above, is also gathered from various areas like library procedures,

exams, co-curricular activities, institute-industry interactions and the alumni for improvement of the

institute.

6.2.6 How does the management encourage and support involvement of the staff in improving the

effectiveness and efficiency of the institutional processes?

Involvement of staff in improving the effectiveness and efficiency of the institutional processes is done by

providing all necessary support by the Institute. Apart from being actively involved in classroom teaching

activity, the teaching staff is invited to participate in the various functional activities like MAX, FINEX,

HRX, etc and their suggestions are always accepted by the management for further improvement. The

institute staff also supports the students in their entrepreneurial ventures through the Business Incubator -

Antrapreneur.

6.2.7 Enumerate the resolutions made by the Management Council in the last year and the status of

implementation of such resolutions.

Important resolutions made by the Management Council with regard to LJIMS in the last few years and

status of implementation thereof are as under:

Installation of CCTV cameras across the institute for better vigilance and security. Also as a

means to improve the use of audio-video aids, LCD projectors were installed in every classroom.

The management council also took the decision to expand the building and construct more floors

in the building.

Council decided to undertake library expansion wherein the cupboards were removed and entire

wall was utilized for accommodating more material. Some members of the Management Council

who are also part of the Library Advisory Committee, resolved to enhance the library’s efficiency by systematically categorizing various substantial student reports, besides the installation of more

computers and security systems.

• The Placement Committee under the aegis of the Management Council had resolved to target and invite more companies to the campus for recruitment of students. During the year 2013-14, the

institute secured the presence of Vodafone, TCS, ICICI Securities to name a few in the campus

for recruitment of students.

• The Management Council resolved to make aware and guide students about various competitive events related to inter-college competitions and GTU initiated sports and youth festivals.

• The Management Council resolved to organize industrial visits every year and last year the institute

organized visits under the aegis of EXPLORE to 28 companies.

Page 159: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

• The Management Council resolved to give the students an opportunity to come up with pioneering business ideas and exhibit their managerial and communication skills through the LJK's Business

Incubator known as the Antrapreneur – an entrepreneurship development initiative started in 2014.

The council resolved to give total support to entrepreneurial start ups.

Another resolution made by the management council was to organize national level seminars on

contemporary issues and provide necessary administrative and financial support needed for such

purpose

To support research management has resolved to publish its own journal. The trust will be coming out

with L.J. Journal of Research and Studies (LJJRS) which would be a peer-reviewed bi-annual inter-

disciplinary journal with a ‘double blind’ review process. It would invite the contribution of original papers (conceptual, empirical, experience-based, cases, interview papers, notes and commentaries) from

researchers, scholars, academicians, entrepreneurs and the industry. The first issue of the journal is in the

final stages of editing for publishing.

6.2.8 Does the affiliating university make a provision for according the status of autonomy

to an affiliated institution? If ‘yes’, what are the efforts made by the institution in obtaining

autonomy?

No. The affiliating university does not make a provision for according the status of autonomy to an

affiliated institution.

6.2.9 How does the Institution ensure that grievances / complaints are promptly attended to and

resolved effectively? Is there a mechanism to analyse the nature of grievances for promoting better

stakeholder relationship?

A Grievance Redressal Cell has been set up for the whole fraternity of students, faculty and members of

staff, so as to give everyone a chance to raise genuine grievances.

LJIMS is committed to establish and maintain a harmonious and supportive environment conducive to

study and personal development. The institute strives to ensure that students/staff are not subjected to

discrimination or harassment. The cell shall ensure that grievances are responded to promptly, with minimum stress and maximum protection for all concerned.

The grievance policy and set of procedures apply to all students (currently enrolled), faculty and other

staff members. It provides a mechanism for addressing grievances arising out of any kind of situation or

process affecting the student (both academic and non-academic) and staff. Fairness demands that these

and other concerns be responded to promptly and handled in a consistent and transparent manner

The committee proactively keeps track of general conduct of students and staff so the situation of

grievance rarely exists.

6.2.10 During the last four years, had there been any instances of court cases filed by and against

the institute? Provide details on the issues and decisions of the courts on these?

No. The institute has not faced any court cases.

6.2.11 Does the Institution have a mechanism for analyzing student feedback on institutional

performance? If ‘yes’, what was the outcome and response of the institution to such an effort?

Yes, the Institution has a mechanism for student feedback on institutional performance. There was a need

to understand and analyze what the students felt about the performance of the Institution.

Page 160: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

The feedback committee is headed by a senior faculty member who obtains feedback online from

students. The online feedback is analyzed through a program developed by a faculty of our sister institute

LJ Institute of Computer Application.

The findings and outcome of the analysis are then discussed with the Director who takes appropriate

measures for improvement in consultation with the management.

The feedbacks indicated general satisfaction, but certain areas of the institution needed attention for

which the matter was looked into promptly.

6.3 Faculty Empowerment Strategies

6.3.1 What are the efforts made by the institution to enhance the professional development of its

teaching and non teaching staff?

There is continuous encouragement by the top management including the Director for the teaching and

non-teaching staff to enhance their qualification and skills. For achieving this, the institute has taken

several initiatives like organizing FDPs, having provision for Faculty Mentorship Program, organizing

regular faculty seminars, encouraging faculty for pursuing PhD. At present almost all faculty members

have either completed their PhD or are pursuing it.

The institute also provides all necessary financial and administrative support for attending conferences

and seminars. Incentives are provided to faculty for presenting their papers in such events.

The institute also conducts mentorship programs for the newly joined faculties up to 2 years for

development of academic candidature. Library resources of the institute are very rich and play a vital role

in the professional development of its teaching and non-teaching staff.

6.3.2 What are the strategies adopted by the institution for faculty empowerment through training,

retraining and motivating the employees for the roles and responsibility they perform?

The institute adopts several strategies for empowering the faculties. Some of which include Faculty

Mentorship Program and several co – curricular activities like EXCEL, MAX, FINEX, HRX and

CRADLE.

The faculty mentorship program started with the objective of inducting and mentoring the new faculty

into the system. Its scope has now been widened. The senior faculty not only mentors and guides the new

faculty but the mentor and the mentee are also now involved in collaborative research, academic

guidance, developing teaching material and deciding on the delivery strategies. All this leads to faculty

empowerment.

As far as the co-curricular activities is concerned the faculty coordinating the activities not only envisage,

visualize, plan and execute the activity but also network with resource persons from industry and

academia. After the successful completion of the program the faculties are required to prepare activity

reports which are later uploaded on the institutional website. The faculties take complete ownership of

these activities.

In order to enhance knowledge and quality imparting of the same in the classroom, the Institute is also

encouraging the faculty members to join additional courses, thus creating motivation for improvement in

their educational qualifications.

The institute also arranges FDPs for academic learning and enhancement of the faculty’s teaching skills.

Page 161: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

6.3.3 Provide details on the performance appraisal system of the staff to evaluate and ensure that

information on multiple activities is appropriately captured and considered for better appraisal.

The institute has a formal performance appraisal system in place. The performance appraisal system is

conceived as an essential component of faculty development. This system is based on the data provided

by the faculty members themselves on the tasks and functions performed by them and their own

assessment of their performance. The appraisal data is kept confidential. Blank appraisal forms are

provided to each faculty who after filling up all the details submit the same to the Director.

The Director then conducts one to one discussion with each faculty on different criteria of assessment.

In case of non-teaching staff, reports of daily work-done in form of Log Books are regularly maintained

to keep the record of increments, higher scales selection grades, leaves taken and additional work done.

Based on this, an informal system for appraising the performance of the non-teaching staff is in practice.

6.3.4 What is the outcome of the review of the performance appraisal reports by the management

and the major decisions taken? How are they communicated to the appropriate stakeholders?

The feedback is personally discussed with faculty and based on it decision is taken by management to

assign greater responsibility to faculty member. Further, necessary suggestions are communicated to the

concerned faculties for improvement if required. The Director discusses the outcome of the review with

the faculties on a one to one basis. And if improvement is required support is provided by the

management to that effect.

6.3.5 What are the welfare schemes available for teaching and non teaching staff? What percentage

of staff have availed the benefit of such schemes in the last four years?

While the Institute expanded in terms of its infrastructure and number of students, there was a need to

introduce welfare schemes for the staff. Hence, formal welfare schemes are on the cards and are being

worked out for the teaching and non-teaching staff. The institute has provided the following assistance /

schemes.

Laptops are provided by the institute with the subsidized rate to the teaching staff.

Support provided to the non-teaching staff for purchase of food grains and other commodities

Mediclaim insurance premium paid by the institute for non-teaching staff.

Financial aid in form of interest free loans have been given to the non-teaching staff for housing

facilities or as a vehicle loan

It may be noted as per the above all the staff have availed the assistance given by the Trust.

6.3.6 What are the measures taken by the Institution for attracting and retaining eminent faculty?

Faculties are appointed as per the UGC norms. At present, all faculty members have full time and

permanent status in the institute.

Absolute academic freedom is given to all faculty members and the institute practices a culture of non-

interference in day to day functions. The institute has strived to create an overall environment conducive

for academic and research work.

Faculties are motivated to join further courses of academic renewal, learning, and advancement. Faculties

are also encouraged to participate in conferences/seminars/workshops by attending and presenting papers.

For that, all support within the norms prescribed, is provided by the management.

Page 162: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

As a token of appreciation as well as incentive, the management gives one extra increment to a faculty

member on award of a Ph. D. Degree.

“Director’s Award of Academic Excellence” is given to the faculty members registering consistently

excellent academic performance based on semester-wise student feedback on “The Quality of Teaching”.

These measures are communicated through notices and messages sent by email where all faculty

members have internet connection. The institute provides proper ambience to the faculties for their

academic work preparations and updating for academic excellence.

All the above measures adopted by the institute have led to a very low attrition rate.

6.4 Financial Management and Resource Mobilization

6.4.1 What is the institutional mechanism to monitor effective and efficient use of available

financial resources?

The institute is self financed and hence the funds are availed from the Trust. The surplus funds are

utilized for the development of the institution. e.g. New classes were built on the top floor and

technological facilities were also provided for the same.

6.4.2 What are the institutional mechanisms for internal and external audit? When was the last

audit done and what are the major audit objections? Provide the details on compliance.

The institute has a mechanism for internal and external audit. Internal audit is carried out by the institute's

qualified employees and external audit is done by an outsourced agency. Audited reports are submitted to

AICTE and the university. The last audit done was on March 31, 2015. There were no audit objections in

the audit conducted during the last period.

6.4.3 What are the major sources of institutional receipts/funding and how is the deficit managed?

Provide audited income and expenditure statement of academic and administrative activities of the

previous four years and the reserve fund/corpus available with institutions, if any.

Major sources of institutional receipts are through the Fees and miscellaneous income as indicated in the

balance sheet. Any deficit of the funds is borne by the Trust.

6.4.4 Give details on the efforts made by the institution in securing additional funding and the

utilization of the same (if any).

National seminar on ‘Entrepreneurship’ was conducted by the institute and the sponsorship for the same was received from the AICTE and GUJCOST. Annual cultural event known as “ADVENTURE” is also

conducted by the institute and its sponsors for t were as follows:

Year Name of the sponsors

2011-12 SBI, IOB, Prathama, IDBI, ADC, Midnight cake, Sharp, Gold spa, Ahmedabad

plus, Subway, Aircel, Lemon Eye, AEOM, Perfect Tours and Travels, Concept

3D

2012-13 IOB, Necked Jeans, God Father, Bank of Baroda, Khalista, Channel Y, Amore

design institute, Midnight cake, Monte Carlo, Ashwariya, Cipher media works

2013-14 God Father, Channel Y, Z-Blue, Khalista, Lemon Eye, Aishwarya, VTV,

Page 163: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Midnight cake

2014-15 Elem Events, Radio Mirchi, MAX (Lifestyle), God Father, Channel Y

6.5 Internal Quality Assurance System (IQAS)

6.5.1 Internal Quality Assurance Cell (IQAC)

a. Has the institution established an Internal Quality Assurance Cell (IQAC)? If ‘yes’, what is the institutional policy with regard to quality assurance and how has it contributed in

institutionalizing the quality assurance processes?

No. Since establishment of an Internal Quality Assurance Cell (IQAC) is a post-accreditation

quality sustenance measure and the institute is applying for first cycle of accreditation, IQAC is

yet to be established.

b. How many decisions of the IQAC have been approved by the management / authorities for

implementation and how many of them were actually implemented?

Not Applicable

c. Does the IQAC have external members on its committee? If so, mention any significant

contribution made by them.

Not Applicable

d. How do students and alumni contribute to the effective functioning of the IQAC?

Not Applicable

e. How does the IQAC communicate and engage staff from different constituents of the institution?

Not Applicable

6.5.2 Does the institution have an integrated framework for Quality assurance of the academic and

administrative activities? If ‘yes’, give details on its operationalisation.

In pursuance of the Quality Policy framed by the institute has taken proactive steps in ensuring quality

assurance of all institutional activities (both academic and administrative). An internal Quality Assurance

Committee has been constituted for developing a system for consistent improvement in the overall

performance of the institute.

The institute has strategically integrated framework for quality assurance at different levels of academic

and administrative activities too. The prime objective has been to develop mechanisms for ensuring

quality enhancement of institutional functioning.

In academics, formal feedback system is developed for faculty that is taken from students’ perspective. The faculty also submits their formal performance appraisal forms (developed by institute) annually.

Research and Publication cell is set up to provide necessary augment to the faculties for contributing

quality papers in seminars/conferences and publishing their research work. It also provides technical

assistance to the faculties doing their Ph.D. The information on upcoming

workshops/seminars/conferences etc. is also disseminated to the faculties through this research cell.

Besides, the faculty is involved in the case writing exercise also through our endeavor called VIKALP,

which emerges from EXPLORE, the industrial visit of the students.

Page 164: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

The new system of the Director’s Appraisal is also in pipeline whereby the monitoring will be done by the top management.

The administrative staff is required to fill the Log Book on daily basis to keep a quality check on the

assigned tasks. The log book is examined by the head of the institute on regular basis in order to

determine its accuracy and quality.

There are specially craved activities for the students to nourish quality management professionals in the

institute. The foundation stone of such KSA (Knowledge, Skill & Aptitude) based pursuit is a well

developed Summer Internship Feedback system to understand the company expectations from the

management students. In the process, we have a well designed Executive Personality Development

Programme (EPDP) wherein the focus remains on polishing their basic communication skills and subject

specialization knowledge. It involves activities to fine tune their GD (group discussion) and interview

skills and overall grooming of a student’s personality. The mock interviews are recorded for the interviewer to conduct a feedback session where the recorded video is replayed. Linked with EPDP, there

is another one week programme named “Immersion” to concentrate on the special company requirements

that need to be catered on the basis of feedback from the companies during campus placement drive. The

students are also made to gain good quality learning by aligning with corporate world through a job-

training programme under the initiative ‘Prashikshan’. Through networking, the companies which need

project-based assistance for their business are identified and the students take up part-time assignment

under ‘Prashikshan’ for one-two weeks. The students are evaluated on the basis of their report which is

treated as project work.

The system of Library Feedback System has also been developed to make the resource more productive

and useful for the students. A separate library committee is also shaped to have constant eye on the library

requirements and development.

Besides, there are several formal committees formed for various functional areas like - Academic

excellence, Examination, Extracurricular activities, Time Table, Educational/Industrial visit, Women

Empowerment cell, Summer training and Placement Cell, Anti ragging etc. The work for the same is

assigned with due responsibility and authority. All committees comprise of teaching and non-teaching

staff as per the nature of tasks involved.

To oversee any grievances, there is also a Grievance Redressal Cell headed by the Dean of the institute.

6.5.3 Does the institution provide training to its staff for effective implementation of the Quality

assurance procedures? If ‘yes’, give details enumerating its impact.

Yes, guidance is given from time to time as and when required to the concerned faculty (s) by organizing

FDPs and Faculty Seminars. For instance, the institute had organized a FDP on SPSS (a software package

used for statistical analysis). The resource persons were internal, having in-depth knowledge and practical

experience in handling data and applying statistical tools for research purposes.

The faculties also share their research experiences and results in “Faculty Seminars”. This practice gives

valuable inputs to the researchers for their research work and provides clarity in conceptualization. More

importantly, it improves the interaction level among the faculties on academic front.

At different times, the administrative staff also gets the guidance on the operational aspects from the Dean

and Director of the institute.

Page 165: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

6.5.4 Does the institution undertake Academic Audit or other external review of the academic

provisions? If ‘yes’, how are the outcomes used to improve the institutional activities?

Yes, the institution undertakes Academic Audit. The ARP (Academic Review Process) is constituted in

the institute to undertake the Academic audit. The panel constitutes the Director and Academic Dean of

the Institute and a Professor Emeritus. The review is taken and the recommendations on the submissions

are made on individual basis to the faculty by the panel.

The outcome of the Academic Audit comes broadly in the areas of student attendance and pedagogical

tools used by faculties in their respective subjects. As a result, a disciplinary committee is formed which

is monitoring students’ attendance on regular basis. The faculties also came out with new pedagogy in certain subjects like cue cards, flash cards and subject quizzes etc.

Other functional committees have a coordinator that remains in touch with the Director and implements

all the plans and ensures their effectiveness.

6.5.5 How is the internal quality assurance mechanisms aligned with the requirements of the

relevant external quality assurance agencies/regulatory authorities?

To ensure that the internal quality assurance mechanisms are aligned with requirements of the external

quality assurance agencies, the institute conducts quality audits at institutional level and develops

performance indicators for various academic and administrative activities of the institute. Relevant quality

benchmarks and parameters are applied for assessment of institutional activities.

6.5.6 What institutional mechanisms are in place to continuously review the teaching learning

process? Give details of its structure, methodologies of operations and outcome?

In order to review the teaching learning process, the institute has formulated a mechanism called

Academic Review Process (ARP). A committee comprising of senior faculty members evaluates the

academic plan and give suggestions wherever required to improve the teaching learning process. During

the semester, the committee monitors the status of each and every subject covered by the respective

faculty members. It also gives suggestions for improving the means and methods adopted to teach the

subject. Towards end of the semester, an audit is done by the committee followed by an expert committee.

A qualitative analysis of how the syllabus has been communicated to the students, activities in which

students were involved as per the syllabus requirement and other such related matters are discussed.

There is also a qualitative feedback mechanism where the senior faculty members take feedback of the

faculty from a group of students. They identify what are the strength and the weakness of the faculty

member and how can the teaching learning process be improved. There is also a Student Feedback

Mechanism, at the end of every semester, where all students are required to rate the faculty on various

dimensions related to effective teaching. A feedback is also taken from parents on the quality of teaching,

infrastructure of the institute and the learning processes at the institute. The institute also takes measures

in order to improve the educational processes based upon the student and parent feedback. This

mechanism has brought about remarkable improvement in the quality of teaching learning.

6.5.7 How does the institution communicate its quality assurance policies, mechanisms and

outcomes to the various internal and external stakeholders?

Quality assurance policies, mechanisms and outcomes are communicated internally through the Quality

Policy framed by the institute that applies to all spheres of activities including teaching, research,

Page 166: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

consultancy, infrastructure and development of students and staff as well. The institute puts special

emphasis on documentation and report writing. All the coordinators of different activities (both academic

and administrative) are required to submit activity completion reports for their respective activities. The

outcomes are disseminated to the team through coordinators and further to the Dean and Director of the

institute to make improvements, if any and take necessary action. If required, one to one meeting with the

concerned faculty/staff is also arranged for discussion. To communicate with the external stakeholders,

the institute has embraced technology. All the important alerts, information, creativity, achievements and

outputs are disseminated to the various stakeholders through the LJ website and LJIMS blog. The

facility of email and print media is also utilized for the purpose, whenever and wherever required.

CRITERION 7: INNOVATIONS AND BEST PRACTICES

Environment Consciousness

The institute has engaged itself in various environmental management initiatives that have

improved its environmental performance and has also led to other benefits like financial savings

and reduced risk of liability. These environmental management initiatives or “Green Initiatives”

as we call them primarily seek to deepen students’ understanding of today’s environmental challenges and assist them in developing effective solutions.

7.1.1 Does the Institute conduct Green Audit of its campus and facilities?

Green Audit is the process of accessing the environmental impact of an organization process,

project, product etc. The institute arranged Green audit inspection on 5th

June, 2014 with the help

of more than 20 students and 2 faculty members. Professionals were hired who focused on three

types of audit covered under Green Audit as mentioned below.

Page 167: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

1. Plant audit: where plant mapping of whole plantation in the campus was done. This data

can be utilized to meet the standards of green campus.

2. Water audit: where the council will audit the requirement of water per student. It will also

assess the need and lay down standards pertaining to that.

3. Energy audit: where total no. of fans, lights and other equipments/apparatus of whole

campus, run on electricity to be calculated and the actual need as well as the issue of

wastage, if happens, can be addressed.

Students collected data of entire plantation. More than 900 plants in campus were surveyed by

students and information such as their botanical names, medicinal uses and their height, radius

and age were calculated. From the data compiled, the actual number of plants to be grown was

also calculated.

7.1.2 What are the initiatives taken by the college to make the campus Eco-Friendly?

Energy Conservation

It has been the dictum of the LJK trust that “Energy saved is as important as energy

produced.”

The college building is designed and constructed in a manner that there is

sufficient light and ventilation in almost all classes resulting into minimal use of

electricity.

All the students and staff members are expected to switch off lights and fans

before leaving the classes.

For effective utilization of electricity, Institute is planning to shift to CFL lights.

Electricity cut off problem is minimal in Ahmedabad. Back up energy usage is

kept minimal. Only in cases of emergency like examination and important events

the backup is used

LCD monitors are used that consume less energy. Most of the computer

peripherals are modernized and updated.

Students and staff members use one side printed paper for taking trial print out.

Stationery material wastage, torn and worn out books and discarded papers is sent

for recycle process.

Further to save consumption of papers, to protect environment and to reduce

deforestation of forest at micro level, all official communication is made to

students and faculties through online media.

There is optimal use of water in whole premises. Grey water is treated and the

same is used for gardening.

To reduce excess volume of water usage and save energy, sprinklers are used for

irrigating gardens and lawns.

Use of Renewable Energy Institute has a huge campus of 2.5 acres and it strongly believes in sustainable

development. In Ahmedabad, there is enough sunlight throughout the year the institute is

Page 168: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

therefore planning to use solar energy for street lights which is non-polluting energy

source. By this the non-renewable sources of energy can be preserved for future

generation and more focus can be given to renewable sources of energy.

Solid Waste Management Effective solid waste management system has been introduced. Objective of waste

management system is reduction and management of waste. Segregation of waste is done

at source by putting five different coloured dustbins indicating its use at different places

within the campus.

Blue: Plastic Waste

Red: Food Wrappers and other waste

Yellow: Paper Waste

Green: Garden and Food Waste

Metallic Grey: Recyclable Waste

Food waste, garden waste which are collected from green dustbins are sent to compost

tank and sometime animal droppings, saw dust and crumbled papers are used for

composting. Every month Institute gets approximate 200Kg compost which is used in

gardening.

Percolation Well A percolation well is used to manage storm water runoff, prevent flooding and

downstream erosion, and improve water quality in an adjacent river, stream, lake. It is a

shallow excavated trench filled with gravel or crushed stone that is designed to infiltrate

storm water through permeable soils into the ground water aquifer. Surface run-off and

roof top water is diverted to four percolation wells which have been developed within

campus. Water accumulating in the well percolates in the solid to augment the ground

water.

There are 10 percolation wells

Efforts for Carbon Neutrality The institute has taken steps for creating a non-polluting environment so as to achieve

carbon neutrality. Burning of wastage emitting smoke is strictly prohibited in and outside

college premises. The institute recommends pooling of vehicles for students and staff

members and encourages use of public transport. Even instruction has been given in

canteen that no coal and smoke emitting fuel is to be used for cooking by institute.

Institute does not use back up energy except in case of emergency such as examination

and important events.

Plantation

The institute not only insists for tree plantation but also advocates nurturing and

conserving vegetation on the campus. Students have actively participated in Plantation

Day celebration organized in the past. This type of event motivates students to participate

actively for such a noble cause.

Hazardous waste management

Page 169: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Institute does not generate hazardous waste.

7.2 Innovations

Give details of innovations introduced during the last four years which have created a

positive impact on the functioning of the college.

The innovative initiatives introduced by the institute during the last four years are as

follows:

7.2.1 Executive Personality Development Programme (EPDP)

After a day-long brainstorming by the faculty, the institute had launched a programme

‘Personality Development Drive’ (PDD) in 2006 with the objective of developing soft skills among students. It was delivered in the first week of the academic year (6 hours a day for 7 days)

to the students of MBA II year. It was made compulsory for students to be eligible for the

placement. The programme, which was designed and conducted by the entire in-house faculty,

increased employability of students so much so that even during the recession year 2007, the

institute recorded100% placement. In the year 2010, the programme was reviewed, its scope was

extended to include students of first year also, new areas were added and it was re-launched as

Executive Personality Development Programme (EPDP).

Objectives:

To enhance the skills , abilities and overall personality development of the students so

that they will be better equipped for placement and ready to face the challenges of the

corporate world

To impart and develop career related skills like communication skills, soft skills,

analytical skills, reasoning and verbal aptitude

Duration: 2 weeks

Areas covered:

For a week students are exposed to following different areas:

Choice of Specialization

Choice of Electives

General Awareness

Knowing Oneself

Personality Etiquettes and grooming

Conflict Handling

Speed Reading and Comprehension

Time Management & Negotiation skills

Stress management

GD and PI

Management Games

SIP Related Interviews

Mind Games

Page 170: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Introduction to Business Idea

Developing Emotional Quotient

Aptitude and Verbal skills

a. Arithmetic training

b. Verbal training

c. Fundamentals of project management

d. Entrepreneurship Basics

e. Johari Window

f. Workplace culture

`

o Pedagogy:

To ensure an understanding of the above listed areas and development of

these skills in students and prepare them for their final placement mixed

methodology and teaching techniques are used to conduct EPDP. The

learning process involves a blend of classroom teaching and self learning

exercise. This includes class room lectures, case analysis, simulation

exercises, role plays, individual and group tasks.

o Feedback

On completion of a 2 week long EPDP, a detailed feedback is obtained

from student stakeholders about the entire programme. Students are

encouraged to give a fair and honest feedback on the following areas:

Learning from EPDP

Relevance of EPDP

Areas in which students feel they would require

further intervention

Suggestions pertaining to overall improvement of

the programme

Over and above the process of obtaining the feedback from students an elaborate attendance

analysis exercise is undertaken. A list of students and number of sessions attended is prepared.

From this list, attendance percentage is calculated. Separate meetings and discussions are later

held with those students who had severe shortfall in their attendance. The discussion pertains to

not only finding out reasons for absenteeism but also working out solutions to any specific

problems they encounter which may be preventing them for attending the EPDP sessions

regularly.

Follow up

Once the feedback is obtained from students a detailed area wise/criterion wise analysis of

the feedback form is undertaken. The major outcome of such an exercise is the list of areas

which students feel requires further inputs and intense practice on their part. The list of areas

then becomes an important input to the subsequent EPDP. The comprehensive schedule

along with the tracks for the next EPDP incorporates most of those where students require

more practice.

Further all unique and feasible suggestions given by students are also incorporated in

upcoming EPDP sessions.

Page 171: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Impact of the programme EPDP has played a crucial role in guiding and orienting students to become effective

communicators, nurture and develop winning personalities, become more aware of their

personality shortcomings and improve on those areas. Overall the programme has enabled

students in developing communication and leadership skills which helps them perform better

in job interviews and prepares them to face the challenges of the dynamic corporate world.

Students believed that the programme was particularly very useful in removing their

inhibitions and improving their confidence while communicating with others or in public.

A new initiative under EPDP- Placement Immersion Programme

Based on the current scenario and industry trends, the institute decided to take a

leap into Training and Development of its students. The programme was

structurally designed so as to train students to enhance their communication skills,

confidence level, interviews, subject content, etc. The programme was scheduled

for 7 days, each day focusing on development of various skills. There were

approximately 230 students who took part in the immersion programme. Associate

Professors shared their expertise in this programme through various practical

exercises. These activities were conducted on group as well as individual basis.

The students were rated by expert faculties on scale of 1 to 10 on the basis of their

performance wherein 1-3 = Excellent Performance, 4-6 = Average Performance /

Needs Improvement and 7-10 = Poor Performance / Full Intervention.

The students benefited enormously from it. They learnt what is the corporate culture

how to behave and what are the skills one has to develop to be successful MBA

professional.

EPDP has enhanced the employability of the students.

7.2.2 Capability Recognition And Development Lessons for Entrepreneurship (CRADLE)

With the increase in competition and rapidly changing industry dynamics and to

encourage and support entrepreneurship among students, the institute designed and

launched in the year 2011, the innovative programme CRADLE. This initiative of

LJIMS has active inputs from the trust Lok Jagruti Kendra, where participants learn

about entrepreneurship from entrepreneurs who successfully run small and medium

enterprises and dream really big.

OBJECTIVES:

To recognize the entrepreneurship capabilities of students and create opportunities for

development of entrepreneurship skills.

To build long-term mutually beneficial relationships with the SMEs and provide

opportunities for experiential learning to students.

ACTIVITES:

Interactive Sessions

Interactive sessions with the Chief Executive Officers/ Promoters of highly reputed Small

and Medium Enterprises will be organized regularly to promote entrepreneurship among

Page 172: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

students. Such sessions will not be in the form of formal lectures, but more as informal

interactions in which the CEO/Promoter will share his/her experiences, especially at the

initial stages of the enterprise, familiarize students with the Company through a PPT, and

also respond to queries of the students.

Workshop (Under Process)

Three types of workshops will be conducted under CRADLE:

Workshop for development of entrepreneurship skills for students as well as faculties

will be conducted with the help of resource persons drawn from academic as well

industrial fields.

Need based Bridge Workshops could be conducted for the students of MBA to

bridge the gap between university syllabus and the actual industry requirements in

collaboration with SME units.

MDP workshops could be conducted to address SME needs in specific areas, either at

LJMBA or at the premises of a particular SME.

Best SME Award (under process)

Small and Medium Enterprises are rapidly growing with the development of

entrepreneurship in Gujarat. Systemic research will be conducted about the SMEs

operating in different sectors, parameters will be developed for evaluation of their

performance, and the Best SME Award will be given in one sector every year by the Lok

Jagruti Kendra under the CRADLE. The details of the Award Scheme and the mechanism

for its operationalization will be worked separately.

Industrial Visits

Industrial Visit for LJMBA students are regularly organized to different SMEs to provide

students an opportunity for experiential learning and research.

Summer/Final Placements

Regular linkages with different SMEs facilitate summer placements of the large number

of students of the first year MBA. It is also of great help in obtaining final placements for

students wanting to get placed in Gujarat only.

Projects

CRADLE facilitates students in their Global Country Study Report (GCSR) Project as

well as the Comprehensive Project (CP) which are compulsory components of the second

year MBA. Faculty members could also take up research projects which could be of use

to SMEs, and the interested SMEs could also commission research projects to LJMBA

faculty as per their specific needs.

7.2.3 Employability Enhancement Programme (EEP):

In order to bridge the gap between the academic learning through pre designed course

curriculum and corporate expectations which arises due to time and resources constraints,

LJMBA launched Employability Enhancement Programme (EEP) in 2009-10. The

Employability Enhancement Programme is designed to assist students to invest in

Page 173: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

improving their career prospects. It shows them how to assess your values, business

cultural preferences, skills and interests so that they can make positive and realistic steps

towards subsequent career changes. EEP with suggestions, connections and networking

opportunities help them to achieve vital goals.

The key components of the EEP

• A special session is conducted with all the students where all of them are

thoroughly interviewed and student mapping happens where students are classified as per

their knowledge, skills and aptitude. It helps them understand their strengths and areas of

improvement

Classroom sessions (including guest speakers), sector skills and current information

• Practical sessions for skills development

• One-to-one career discussions with an adviser

• Networking – including events with employers, alumni

• Resources

After a review in 2011, MAX, FINEX and HRX were conceived and launched in 2012 to

provide specialization specific focus on gaps.

7.2.3.1 Marketing Excellence Series (MAX)

MAX stands for Marketing Excellence Series and represents a platform for meaningful

interactions between industry/ academia professionals and LJMBA students.

(a) Objectives:

To sensitize the participants of LJMBA with the realities of the marketing work

place

To assist them in adopting and performing to the best of their potential in the

industry/ work place.

(b) Areas to be covered:

As a part of our efforts to promote marketing skills at work place among our students,

LJMBA created MAX, under which a series of interactions have been undertaken

(2012 and 2013) with successful marketing professionals from the industry and

academia who shared their experiences of marketing successes and failures. The

speakers shared their experiences related to several marketing areas like;

New Launches

Product and Brand Management

Marketing strategies and programmes

IMC strategies

Branding Strategies

Sales and Distribution Management

Positioning Strategies

CRM Strategies

Marketing Research

(c ) Activities

Page 174: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

i) INTERACTIVE SESSIONS: Interactive sessions with the experts of highly

reputed enterprises of the industry will be organized. Such sessions will not be in

the form of formal lectures, but more as informal interactions in which the experts

will share his/her experiences, familiarize students with the concept, and also

respond to queries of the students.

ii) WORKSHOP (under process)

Need based Bridge Workshops could be conducted for the students of MBA to bridge the

gap between university syllabus and the actual industry requirements.

iii) SUMMER/FINAL PLACEMENTS

Regular linkages with different experts of industry as outlined above facilitate summer

placements of the large number of students of the first year MBA. It is also of great help

in obtaining final placements for students wanting to get placed.

7.2.3.2 Finance Excellence Series (FINEX)

The institute conceived the idea of organizing FINEX series in order to bridge the gap

between the academic learning through pre designed course curriculum and corporate

expectations which arises due to time and resources constraints. In order to strengthen the

domain knowledge of finance and to expose the students to practices in the arena of

financial markets and services, LJMBA has initiated an innovative programme the

“Finance Excellence Series” (FINEX).

FINEX is a structured lecture series, designed to include interactive sessions delivered by

industry experts, spread over a few days catering to Corporate Finance, Banking,

Insurance and Capital Market respectively.

(a) Objectives

To provide a platform for the holistic development of budding financial managers.

To give an exposure to the finance students of financial market and different finance

industries.

To create a platform for interaction between students and experts from the different areas

of finance.

(b) Areas covered

The speakers shared their experiences related to several marketing areas like;

Universal Banking

Equity Market

Debt Market

Life-Insurance

Non-Banking finances

Personal Finance

Behavioural Finance

Page 175: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

International finance

Re- Insurance

Equity research and analysis

Merger and Acquisition

(c ) Activities

i) Interactive Sessions: Interactive sessions with the experts of highly reputed

enterprises of the industry will be organized. Such sessions will not be in the form

of formal lectures, but more as informal interactions in which the experts will

share his/her experiences, familiarize students with the concept, and also respond

to queries of the students.

ii) Workshop (under process)

Need based Bridge Workshops could be conducted for the students of MBA to bridge the

gap between university syllabus and the actual industry requirements.

iii) Summer/Final Placements

Regular linkages with different experts of industry as outlined above facilitate summer

placements of the large number of students of the first year MBA. It is also of great help

in obtaining final placements for students wanting to get placed.

7.2.3.3 HR EXCELLENCE SERIES (HRX)

With the rapidly changing technological, socio- economic and politico – legal environment and

the trend towards globalization of business and industry, effective management of human

resources has become a very challenging job. The fact cannot be denied that human element is at

the centre stage in all economic activities. No organization can think of viability of operations

and effectiveness without the efficient utilization of Human Resources. This requires the present

day managers to be deeply concerned with the performance of human resource management

functions.

The organizations need to have a human capital advantage as well as human process advantage

to distinguish itself in this competitive world.

(a) Objective :

To expose students towards the dynamics of HR field

To help them understand and strengthen various concepts of HR through direct

interaction with HR experts.

(b) Areas covered

The speakers shared their experiences related to several marketing areas like;

Recruitment

HR policies and practices

Labour laws and labour protection rights

HR skills and abilities

HR strategies

Page 176: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

(c ) Activities

i) Interactive Sessions: Interactive sessions with the experts of highly reputed

enterprises of the industry will be organized. Such sessions will not be in the form

of formal lectures, but more as informal interactions in which the experts will

share his/her experiences, familiarize students with the concept, and also respond

to queries of the students.

ii) Workshop (under process)

Need based Bridge Workshops could be conducted for the students of MBA to bridge the

gap between university syllabus and the actual industry requirements.

iii) Summer/Final Placements

Regular linkages with different experts of industry facilitate summer placements of the

large number of students of the first year MBA. It is also of great help in obtaining final

placements for students wanting to get placed.

7.2.6 ARCHETYPE – the Management Model Competition

“ARCHETYPE” is the unique activity, which is an integral part of LJMBA. The initiative was

taken in 2005 to identify the creativity and business acumen among the students, since then

“ARCHETYPE” has become the key feature of first semester curriculum. The ARCHETYPE

was started as a simple classroom activity as a management model competition to showcase the

theoretical management concept in the form of physical models, almost 10 years back. It shaped

up and upgraded consequently in the better versions over a span of time. The professionalism

and the depth of research had been to next level every year. The informal presentations of model

have been transformed to very professional and research based formal audio-visual form in the

state of the art auditorium of the institute. The model based on simple theoretical concepts is now

evolved in the real business situations and business ideas. The participants come up with the

innovative business ideas, they are subject to strict scrutiny before the approval. The presentation

is supported by the Business Model Canvas(BMC) and Product Model Canvas(PMC) and

prototypes.

The feasible business ideas are further taken to the “Antraprenar – The Business Incubator” of

Lok Jagruti Kendra for further fine tuning and funding opportunities.

THE FORMAT:

Each class is divided into a group of 6 members each.

Each group explores and submits their business idea in prescribed format.

The preliminary screening is done by faculty panels for each idea.

The inputs and suggestions are given to the groups by the faculty panels in preliminary

presentation of the business idea.

Each group is required to prepare a Model, which describe their business idea. A detailed

presentation regarding the feasibility analysis is also the prerequisite of the competition.

On the day of competition, the groups present their models and analysis in front of

eminent jury members from corporate and academic world.

Page 177: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

The models are kept for public display and for the interactive session.

The models are thoroughly examined on prescribed criteria and top 5 models are

awarded.

The awarded models further goes for very fine scrutiny in the business incubator cell of

LJK, where the deserving models are facilitated for funding.

7.2.7 Vikalp – the Case Study Forum

Vikalp was initiated with the goal of challenging management students to relate and

make connections with academic studies and practical management situations. It

functions as a simulator for real-world problem management where students will be

exposed to cope with taking on roles in the boardroom or crisis team of a major

corporation.

Vikalp – the case study forum was formed in the year 2009. While it’s Phase I activity of ‘identification, analysis and discussion’ of cases in respective classes/subjects has been going on since 2009, its Phase II, involving ‘Research and Case Writing’, was introduced in the year 2013. For this all students of the 1

st year of MBA are divided into groups of 12

to 15, and each group is assigned a faculty guide. Each group identifies an industry, visits

it to do a comprehensive study of its strategies, products, processes and functions. Each

group collects data of the industry relating to the parameters decided by the institution.

After data analysis and extensive research the faculty guide of each group does the case

writing with active involvement of students.

7.3 Elaborate on any two Best Practices which have contributed to the achievement of the

institutional objectives and/or contributed to the quality improvement of the core activities

of the college.

Best practices are those strategies or specific activities that have shown to be effective over time

and often at multiples sites/places where they are implemented. The institute has many such

activities whose effectiveness have been proven over time. Based on inputs sought from

different stakeholders these best practices were identified. From the list two of the top best

practices were chosen. These practices enable the institute in evolving, competing and

succeeding in a highly competitive market of business schools. They also ensure accountability

and promote quality consciousness. The two best practices are as follows:

I. Summer Internship Programme Audit

1. Title of the Project : Summer Internship Programme Audit

2. Goal

To increase the rigor of summer internship programme by ensuring that the

projects that students pursue are valuable and lead to knowledge and skill

enhancement.

To evaluate the performance of the students by obtaining first-hand information

regarding their progress, learning and problems encountered (if any).

Page 178: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

To network with the company, understand their requirement in terms of skills and

knowledge from the students and provide an opportunity for final placement.

3. The Context

In the past summer internships it was found that there were difficulties to company and

students both in terms of projects that were provided and the way students worked on it.

Also the projects that students did were not found to be value additional in terms of their

knowledge enhancement and skills imparted..Hence, to overcome these challenges, SIP

Audit mechanism was designed to add spark to the programme. The SIP audit was also

significant in the light of the fact that in the past it was found that there were final

placements generated from summer internship. A deeper understanding of final

placement requirements and developing a strong network with the company provided a

relevant context for the design of audit mechanism by institute.

4. The Practice

Summer Internship Programme Audit: A Unique Initiative

Faculty members are allocated different companies by the SIP team for conducting

personal visits to obtain the feedback from the employers about the students’ progress and general conduct during the entire internship period of 6-8 weeks. The feedback is

taken on various aspects of knowledge and skill development in the students have

obtained and exhibited during the tenure of their internship. Further the project mentors

of company are also asked to suggest areas of improvement for each of the students they

have guided. The feedback is obtained both through a written feedback form and also

through verbal conversations. The idea is to gather as much detailed information as

possible regarding the students learning and scope for further improvement.

Over and above this, two other separate feedback forms are designed; one that gathers

detailed information about the company and its future expansion/growth plans and other

is the students’ feedback form where students give details of the project undertaken and feedback about the company. This helps in ensuring whether the SIP objectives of

practical learning and industry exposure have been met.

After the feedback is obtained from the company report is submitted by each faculty

which is consolidated and uploaded on the website.

5. Evidence of Success

The practice has generated a highly positive response from all its stakeholders including

employers, parents and students in particular.

Employers have appreciated and welcomed this practice saying that it ensures

transparency in the students’ performance and a general attitude of seriousness in work. Employers are of the view that such practice also improves the employability of the

students when they finally prepare themselves for final placements. They believe that

such a practice should be replicated by all B-schools.

Parents believe that such a practice reflects personal interest on the part of the institute in

ensuring and monitoring the progress of each student. Students themselves have felt that

such audits make them more sincere and regular in their internship. Companies like

Page 179: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Sharp Electronics, Havmor, IMRB International, Central mall, Vadilal, Croma, Cargo

Energy, Azilen Technology, Wish tree Technology, Aditya Birla FinanceLtd.,etc have

revisited the institute for further taking students for SIP.

There are many companies who have offered stipend to the students, Wish Tree

Technology, SBI and Synersoft technology who offered highest stipend of Rs. 8000 per

months. Moser Baer offered Rs. 4000 as allowances. Havmoras such has no policy of

offering stipends to interns but based on exceptional performance they offered a token of

appreciation through a stipend of Rs. 2100.

Because of SIP audit students work sincerely in the respective companies which in turn

has helped students for getting the final placements.

6. Problems Encountered and Resources Required

There have been instances where during the audit it was found that students were not

regular in their projects and were not visiting the company at all in certain cases. There

were problem with students’ communication skills, attitude towards work and professionalism exhibited by them. Such issues have a negative influence on institutes’ relationship and rapport with certain organization. Employers felt dissatisfied with

institute and refused to revisit the institute for further recruitments.

Resources required:

Human: Faculty members’ time (since they have to personally visit the company) Funds for meeting expenses towards conveyance are reimbursed by the

management

Other: Cost of Memento. Project mentors from the company are given memento

as a token of regard from the institute.

7. Contact Details

Name of the Director: Dr P.K Mehta

Name of the institution: L.J Institute of Management Studies

City: Ahmedabad

Accredited Status: Applying for the first time

Work phone: 29096840

Website: www.ljinstitutes.org

II. Developing an Entrepreneurial Ecosystem

1. Title of the Practice : Developing an Entrepreneurial Ecosystem

2. Goal

The goal of LJIMS is to "develop institutional mechanism to create entrepreneurial culture

among the stakeholders and to foster growth entrepreneurship amongst the students, faculty and

the society at large”. The aim of the activities is expected to act as a tool to promote

entrepreneurship and self-employment amongst management students as an attractive and viable

career option and changing their mindset from becoming job creators rather than job seekers.

3. The Context:

Page 180: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

LJIMS over the years has launched many entrepreneurial activities over the years with an aim

that management students should become job creators rather than job seekers. annual

entrepreneurial event Archetype The Management Model Competition in 2005,

CRADLE(Capability Recognition And Development Lessons for Entrepreneurship) in 2012,

National Level Seminar for Developing Entrepreneurial Ecosystem in the campus in 2014,

Antrapreneur The Business Incubator in 2014.

The activities are mandatory for all students to participate and have been invariably implemented

for Semester 1 students. Also Gujarat state been know as the, ‘land of entrepreneurs’ the activities assist many management students who are having their own family business.

The activities have been introduced to address and help students assess their entrepreneurial

potential and develop the confidence to venture into challenging career of entrepreneurship. One

of the prominent features of the activities is the management students visiting the startups and

understanding the entire process of business formation, challenges faced and operational

strategies. This addresses the development of mindset of students to frame and develop start up

strategies, understand issues and problem pertaining to growth stage including delegation,

formalization of system and HR issues. It also helps them understand and appreciate challenges

of starting and managing new ventures. With the implementation of the entrepreneurial activities

like Archetype it helps the management students on how to prepare a bankable business plan

which can be considered prerequisite for starting and obtaining finance particularly from venture

finance, public issue etc. and start their own venture.

4. The Practice

Over the years the management model competition introduced in 2005 was later renamed as

Archetype The Management model competition which proved to be a successful initiative where

it became a source of starting a new venture for LJIMS management students. In 2010 we

thought there was a need to integrate learning’s and make this a more robust and feasible

mechanism to start a new venture. We introduced market research, customer validation, visit to

startups to understand their business processes, interaction with first generation entrepreneurs,

workshops, progress reports checkpoints, mock presentations in front of faculty members and

alumni’s, presentations in front of VCs and integrated it as part of the practical module of academics.

Our success in the activities was very much recognized by our management Lok Jagruti Kendra

and sister concern institutions and with an aim in inculcating the entrepreneurial mindset across,

LJIMS with the help of other institutions and HODs sensitized more than 10,000 students and

300 faculty members across the campus and 463 business ideas was submitted by the students.

The management was so much enthused by the response that they launched Antrapreneur The

Business Incubator to create and support entrepreneurial ecosystem in the campus which is

housed in the premises of LJIMS and a faculty member of LJIMS, Dr. Abhijeet Singh is the

COO of the Business Incubator.

In 2014 with an aim of creating entrepreneurial ecosystem in conceptual and practical context we

conducted a National Level seminar partly sponsored by AICTE, DST and GUJCOST. To

address the conceptual concerns eminent academicians from Indian Institute of Management-

Page 181: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Ahmedabad (IIMA), Entrepreneurship Development Institute (EDI), Mudra Institute of

Communication and Advertising (MICA), Pandit DeenDayal Petroleum University (PDPU) were

invited. And for practical context government institutions like Industries commisionerate, Centre

for Entrepreneurship Development, MSME and successful practitioners likes of Mumbai

Dabbawalas, CEO of International corporations like Connectica, dropbox were invited.

We have many eminent academicians, industrialist, and government officials in our team with

competencies in various areas like sensitization, ideation, IPR, research, acceleration, and

commercialization. Our management team brings in huge experience from industry, R&D and

practical experience of working with young student start-ups.

We have made series efforts to convert student and faculty research to products and services

which can serve some real life purpose. We with help of local industry, design experts from

industry, subject experts are validating these proofs of concepts and converting proof of values

and later on products. In half a dozen cases we have bootstrapped with various stakeholders and

help the faculty members and students setting up start-ups around them. We believe in the motto

of Mind to Market / Research to Revenue to sustain and scale further efforts.

5. Evidence of Success

LJIMS through Antrapreneur The Business Incubator funds the student ideas to make prototype

at initial stage. We have sensitized more than 3000 management students and 15000 students

across different institutes of LJK till date. More than 35 business ventures have come out of

LJIMS in last 10 years with the advent of the entrepreneurial activities. Since last 5 years, from

500 student projects till date we are making efforts to see that nearly 50 projects get converted

into 50 productive solutions. In next 10 years we will equally emphasize on skill development

and student start-ups. LJIMS in next 10 years aims to create nearly 300 student start-ups from its

campus, which will create 15,000 direct and indirect jobs for the state and country. Currently 3

projects of students of LJIMS is incubated in Antrapreneur The Business Incubator. Prominent

startups like Mokshshil which has got national recognition by national media across has nation

addressing the Social concerns of the society has come out of LJIMS.

6. Problems Encountered and Resources required

To implement our practices for developing entrepreneurial ecosystem in the campus there was a

need for inviting corporate speakers, changing the mindset of students and faculty members, seed

capital, infrastructure, labs, mentoring services, acceleration, and well connected network. LJK

management has been supporting by providing seed capital to feasible business ideas and

launched Antrapreneur The Business Incubator in 2014 with an aim to foster entrepreneurship

for generation of wealth and employment by addressing the challenges mentioned above.

Antrapreneur by means of investment and training provides the necessary resources to the ones

are passionate enough to follow their dreams and carve a niche of their own in a world full of

people who are willing to mingle with the crowd because of their inability to take risks.

Antrapreneur brings together students, faculty of across universities, academic institutions which

will consists of alumni, budding entrepreneurs, industrialists and mentors from across sectors,

who are dedicated to the cause of endorsing the zest of entrepreneurship amongst individuals.

Notes

Page 182: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Other prominent entrepreneurial activities we have implemented as the best practices in our

institution

CRADLE: This initiative is a unique of its kind through which CEOs of reputed industries and

start-ups are invited to interact with LJ campus students. This triggers the aspiration of young

students who want to initiative new projects and skill based start-ups by our MBA and other

professional students.

Antrapreneur The Business Incubator

LJIMS has launched Antrapreneur The Business Incubator as part of our vision towards

excellence in imparting quality education which aims at institutionalizing mechanism, which

could act as support system for entrepreneurs. The Incubator set up is expected to act as a tool to

promote entrepreneurship and self-employment amongst technical students as an attractive and

viable career option with support of seed capital, mentoring services, Antar Laab-Accelerator,

Antar Drishti Demo Day.

Antrapreneur The Business Incubator is now an official nodal institution under

STARTUP/INNOVATION SCHEME GOVERNMENT OF GUJARAT Government Resolution

No. MIS-102014-924909-I, Dt 27-01-2015 with an aim to support upcoming entrepreneurs.

LJ Innovation Village: This is largest innovation/project prototype exhibition in the state in our

campus. LJ innovation village brings together all student innovations annually and showcase

them to all students, faculty members, industry experts and local start-ups.

Startup Week 24x7: Startup 24x7 was a week-long hands-on experience training program

where student entrepreneurs as well as aspiring student entrepreneurs put their entrepreneurial

skills to test and launch their startups.

This program helped students to set up and prepare their venture within a week.

A team focuses on:

Idea improvisation,

Business Model Canvas Development

Product development and testing,

Customer validation,

Practicing LEAN Startup Methodologies and

Building a minimal viable product with help from mentors belonging to diverse

background.

"Project to Product” initiative: LJIMS has systematically developed innovation processes

through which all of the management students are working on real life challenges from market,

Page 183: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

industry and society in the market. Each project is monitored by expert faculty and

best projects in every department are given prototyping fund through college.

Contact Details

Name of Principal: Dr. PK Mehta

Name of Institution: LJ Institute of Management Studies

City: Ahmedabad

Pin Code: 382210

Accredited Status:

Work Phone: 079-29096840

Website: www.ljinstitutes.org

Email: [email protected]

Mobile: +919426511132

Page 184: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

3.Evaluative

Reports of the

Departments

Page 185: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

3. Evaluative Report of the Departments

1. Name of the department: MANAGEMENT

2. Year of Establishment: 2001

3. Names of Programmes / Courses offered (UG, PG, M.Phil., Ph.D., Integrated

Masters; Integrated Ph.D., etc.)

PG: MBA

DUAL DEGREE: MAM

7. Names of Interdisciplinary courses and the departments/units involved

1. MASTER OF BUSINESS ADMINISTRATION

2. .BACHELOR OF APPLIED MANAGEMENT , MASTER OF APPLIED MANAGEMENT

5. Annual/ semester/choice based credit system (programme wise)

All courses are based on semester system.

6. Participation of the department in the courses offered by other departments

Faculty from each department are invited to other departments for guest sessions and

faculty development programs.

7. Courses in collaboration with other universities, industries, foreign institutions, etc.:

The Management department conducts short terms programs like Marketing Excellence

Series, Finance Excellence Series and HR Excellence Series in collaboration with

corporate wherein sessions, practical training and field visits are conducted.

8. Details of courses/programmes discontinued (if any) with reasons:

Not applicable

9. Number of Teaching posts

Sanctioned

Filled

Professors

2 3

Page 186: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Associate Professors

7 7

Asst. Professors

28 25

10. Faculty profile with name, qualification, designation, specialization, (D.Sc./D.Litt.

/Ph.D. / M. Phil. etc.,)

Name

Qualificati

on

Designation

Specialization

No. of Years

of

Experience

No. of Ph.D.

Students guided for the

last 4 years

Dr P.K Mehta PhD Director Business

communication

40+ 0

Prof Dhawal

Mehta

Post

Graduate

Professor

emeritus

Economics,

Strategy

40+ 2

Dr Mithani PhD Professor

emeritus

Economics 40+ 2

Dr Siddarth Bist PhD Dean Marketing, Strategy 15 1

Dr Siddharth Das PhD Associate

Professor

25+ 4

Dr Neha Shah PhD Associate

Professor

Economics 25+ 0

Dr Manisha Jalla PhD Associate

Professor

Strategy,

International

Business

15 0

Dr Abhinava

Singh

PhD Associate

Professor

Marketing, Strategy 15 0

Dr Priyanka

Pathak

PhD Associate

Professor

Finance 13 4

Dr Anitha Sunil PhD Associate

Professor

Marketing,

Statistics

13

Dr Bilva Desai PhD Assistant

Professor

Marketing 9

Dr Abhijeet Singh PhD Assistant

Professor

Marketing,

Information

Technology

8

Page 187: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Dr Sweta Patel PhD Assistant

Professor

HRM 7

Dr Sushant

Nagpal

PhD Assistant

Professor

Finance 13

Dr Archan Mehta PhD Assistant

Professor

HRM 10

Ranjana Dureja PG Assistant

Professor

HRM 9

Mehul Yogi PG Assistant

Professor

Marketing 10

Monica Kapoor PG Assistant

Professor

Finance 10

Kiran Khatri PG Assistant

Professor

Finance 9

Neha Mehta PG Assistant

Professor

Marketing 6

Kumar

Ramchandani

PG Assistant

Professor

Finance 9

Meetali Saxena PG Assistant

Professor

Information

Technology

7

Apurva Bhagat PG

Assistant

Professor

Marketing 2

Rutuja

Bhramabhatt

PG Assistant

Professor

Marketing 5.5

Preeti Pillai PG Assistant

Professor

Marketing 5

Indra Meghrajani

PG Assistant

Professor

Marketing 7

Dhrupa Trivedi PG Assistant

Professor

HRM

3

Ravi Thakkar PG Assistant

Professor

Finance 9

Reshma Pillai PG Assistant

Professor

Finance 6

Akshit Gandhi

PG Assistant

Professor

Finance 7

Garima Sharda PG Assistant

Professor

Marketing 8

Rinal Shah PG Assistant

Professor

Marketing 8

Rajni Shah PG Assistant

Professor

Finance, Statistics 6

Sweety Shah PG Assistant

Professor

Finance 10

Ramzan Sama PG Assistant

Professor

Marketing, HRM 9

Page 188: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

11. List of senior visiting faculty

NONE

12. Percentage of lectures delivered and practical classes handled(programme wise)

by temporary faculty

All sessions are conducted by full time faculty

13. Student -Teacher Ratio (programme wise)

MBA 1:15

MAM 1:18

14. Number of academic support staff (technical) and administrative staff; sanctioned and filled

Technical support staff : 1

Administrative staff: 14

15. Number of teaching faculty with DSc/ D.Litt/ Ph.D/ MPhil / PG.

PhD: 13

PG: 22

16. Number of faculty with ongoing projects from a) National b) International funding agencies and

grants received

NONE

17. Departmental projects funded by DST - FIST; UGC, DBT, ICSSR, etc. and total grants received

NONE

18. Research Centre /facility recognized by the University

NONE

19. Publications:

∗ Publication per faculty Average 2 publications/faculty member

∗ Number of papers published in peer reviewed journals (national /

international) by faculty and students

Over 90 papers

∗ Number of publications listed in International Database (For Eg: Web of Science,

Scopus, Humanities International Complete, Dare Database - International Social

Sciences Directory, EBSCO host, etc.)

LJMBA faculties have published over 90 research papers out of which more than 10 papers are

listed in Ulrich’s Periodicals Directory, 5 papers are listed in International ISSN directory, 3

papers are listed in EBSCO host Database and 2 Papers are listed in Pro Quest Database.

∗ Monographs

∗ Chapter in Books

Chapter in Books Authored and Published by LJMBA Faculty

Page 189: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Books Edited

None

Books with ISBN/ ISSN numbers with details of publishers

Books Authored and Published by LJMBA Faculty

Sr.

No.

Name of

faculty Book Published Total

`

Name of Book Publication

1 Dr.

Abhinava

S. Singh

A Study of the Indian Pharmaceutical

Industry in the New Patent Regime:

Untangling Sources of Competitive

Advantage in Unpredictable

Environments

LAP Lambert Academic

Publishing, Germany,

ISBN: 978-3-8494-9693-8 2

A Study of Modern Blood Banking in

India: Creating a Cause for Donating

Blood

LAP Lambert Academic

Publishing, Germany,

ISBN: 978-3-659-20029-8

2 Dr.

Siddharth

G. Das

A Study of Modern Blood Banking in

India: Creating a Cause for Donating

Blood (Co-authored)

LAP Lambert Academic

Publishing, Germany,

ISBN: 978-3-659-20029-8 2

Elements of Banking & Insurance Sri Gajanan Publications,

Surat 1997

3 Dr.

Priyanka

Pathak

Global India and World Trade

Organization; Effects and Issues on

Indian Agribusiness Industry

Everest Publication House,

Pune, April 2007. 1

Sr.

No.

Name of

faculty Book Published Total

Name of Book Chapter Name in Book

1 Dr. Neha

Shah

An Edited Book - "Tribal

Development in Western India" by

Amita Shah and Jharna Pathak,

Routledge, New Delhi, ISBN - 978-0-

415-71006-0

Health Status of the Tribal

Population

2

An Edited Book - "Growth or

development - which way is Gujarat

going", Oxford university Press,

India, ISBN 13: 978-0-19-945118-0)

Political Economy of

Subsidies and Incentives to

Industries in Gujarat-Sun

Issues

Page 190: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

4 Dr.

Sushant

Nagpal

Psychology of Investments and

Investor’s Preferences

Regal Publications, New

Delhi; 2007 edition, ISBN:

81-89915-63-0

1

5 Ms.

Meetali

Saxena

ICT in Rural India: e-Governance IUP, ISBN - 978-81-314-

20782 1

Citation Index

Over 30 citations have been observed through google scholar for research papers by the institute

faculty members.

SNIP

None

SJR

None

Impact factor

h-index

Over 2 h –index have been observed through google scholar for research papers by the institute

faculty members.

20. Areas of consultancy and income generated

The broad areas identified by LJMBA for consultancy and training are based on the area of

specialization/ interest of the faculty. They include Marketing, Finance, HR, General

Management & IT, Managerial Communication, Business Law & Ethics, Strategic Management

and Economics. The institute is involved in consultancy and training for a number of companies

since 2014.

Maksteel Wire Healds Pvt. Ltd, Baroda (August 2014 – Present): We are working on

an assignment to help Maksteel expand/ improve in terms of market, production

capacity, R&D and design. The management wishes to become a leading player in

Jacquard harness parts in the world (from current position of No. 2 in the world). The

institute conducted a 1 day staff training programme for the managers and supervisors of

Maksteel in Baroda on the 19th September, 2015. The trainer team included the Director,

Dean, Professor Emeritus and Associate Professor from LJIMS. The details of the

programme are mentioned below:

Mighty Group of Companies, Mumbai (October 2014 – Present): The task was to help

Mighty group in framing their vision, mission, values, strategic positioning and strategic

intent. Mighty group wanted to move from current 1-2 projects to 5-50 projects in 1-3 years

timeline.

Shubham Buildmart Pvt. Ltd (November 2015 to present):

A leading distributor and retailer of steel, cement, paint, and other building materials has

engaged us to create system & structure for their HO and retail outlets so as to help them

achieve their 2020 target/ objective.

CareTree Wellness (December 2014 to present):

We are consulting them for marketing of ayurvedic/ herbal brands in the online arena.

The brands have been exclusively launched and are available at Amazon, India and one

of the brands became the no.1 best seller in its category.

Page 191: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Ofzone Digital Marketing, Ahmedabad (December 2014 – April 2015): We provided

marketing and strategy related advise to Ofzone, a digital marketing company planning

to launch a mobile application which would provide businesses with an alternative

medium for marketing (targeted advertising)

The institute is also keen to take up more such assignments and it is in advanced stages of negotiations

with some of the well known industrial organizations in the state and country. No significant revenue has

been generated from the above assignments as in most cases; it has been undertaken as a gesture of

goodwill.

21. Faculty as members in

a) National committees b) International Committees c) Editorial

Boards…. 1. Dr. P.K. Mehta

2. Dr. D.M. Mithani

3. Prof. Dhawal Mehta

22. Student projects

a) Percentage of students who have done in-house projects including

inter departmental/programme

N.A.

b) Percentage of students placed for projects in organizations outside the

institution i.e.in Research laboratories/Industry/ other agencies

10%

23. Awards / Recognitions received by faculty and students

Dr. Siddarth Bist, Dean – LJIMS was conferred the Innovation-best pedagogy

award in recognition for the CRADLE initiative by GTU in 2013

Prof. Sweety Shah and Prof. Amola Bhatt contributed a research paper titled,

“Factors Affecting risk tolerance capacity of Investors: An Empirical study in

Ahmedabad” at National Conference- National Institute of Co-operative

Management (NICM), Gandhinagar in May 2013. Their paper won the 2nd

prize in the area of finance in the conference.

Prof. Sweety Shah contributed a research paper titled, “Financial Literacy: An

Outcome of Global Economic Crisis” at the International Conference by GTU

and Parul group of Institutes in January, 2013. Her paper won the 3rd

prize in

the finance category at the conference.

Prof. Rajani Shah won the 1st prize in general category in paper presentation

on “ Challenges and Opportunities faced by Higher Education System with

Special reference to management Institutions” (2nd

International conference on

Global markets by GTU & Parul Group of Institutes, Jan 2013, ISBN- 978-93-

82062-90-5).

Prof. Amola Bhatt was awarded best paper in the category of Ethics at the 3rd

International Conference on Business Ethics and Corporate Governance

organized by GTU in collaboration with CKSVIM, Baroda in February 2013

Page 192: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

for the research paper “Factors influencing Budding Managers’ Perceptions on Ethics: An Empirical Study in Ahmedabad and Gandhinagar”.

Name of Student Activity Year

Ishan Surani and Group Second Prize in Mime at GTU

Youth Festival

2011

Rutvik Karnik Second Prize Solo singing

western song at GTU Youth

Festival

2011

Rutvik and group First prize for Group singing

at GTU Youth Festival

2012

Ishan Surani and Group First Prize in Mime At GTU

Youth festival

2012

Karishma Gawai Clay modeling at GTU Youth

Festival

2012

Karishma Gawai Poster making at GTU Youth

Festival

2012

Maaz Saiyed And Tirth Patel First Prize at

Summer Project Presentation

called ‘PRATIBHA’ at Ganapat university

2014

Dilip Pandey Second Prize in Cross country

marathon, at state level, Surat

First Prize in Cross country

marathon at Cochin,

Organised by AIU

2014

Arohi Second runner up at fresh face

2013 at state level Organized

by Clean and Clear Face wash

2013

Dhruvee Bhatta First Prize at

Summer Project Presentation

called ‘PRATIBHA’ Organized Ganapat university

2014

Jignesh Vidani Second Prize at Business Plan

Competition

2012

Tirth Patel Second Prize in Photography

contest at Gujarat university

2013

Ujjaval Rajput and LJIMS

Cricket Team

All Gujarat Cricket champion

at state level Organized by

P.D.P.U

2013

Viral Brahmbhatt First Prize at Singing

Competition organized by JG

Institute of Fine Arts.

2010

Viral Brahmbhatt First Prize at Singing 2011

Page 193: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Competition organized by JG

Institute of Fine Arts.

Ravi Patel Second Prize at Singing

Competition organized by JG

Institute of Fine Arts.

2010

Ravi Patel Third Prize at Singing

Competition organized by JG

Institute of Fine Arts

2011

Maaz Saiyed First prize at Pharma model

Organized by LM Pharma

2014

LJIMS Team Second Prize at fashion Show

Organized by SLIMS

2011

24. List of eminent academicians and scientists / visitors to the department

1. Lord Meghnad Desai, Professor

Emeritus, London School of

Economics

2. Dr Gautam Appa, Professor

Emeritus, London School of

Economics

3. Dr G S Gupta, Ex IIMA Professor

4. Dr Abraham Koshy, Professor,

IIMA

5. Mr Arvind Patwari, Director,

MSME-DI, Ahmedabad

6. Dr Chandan Chatterjee, Director,

Centre for Entrepreneurship DIC,

Govt. of Gujarat

7. Dr Arbind Sinha, Director

General, Shanti Business School,

Ex- Professor and HOD MICA

8. Mr Ajay Umat, Bennett, Coleman

and Co. Ltd.

9. Mr H D Shrimali, Additonal

Industries Commissioner, Govt. of

Gujarat

10. Dr Hemant Trivedi, Director-

Institute of Petroleum

Page 194: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Management, PDPU

11. Dr Rakesh Basant, Professor,

IIMA

12. Prof S B Sareen, Professor, EDI

13. Prof Pradyumna Vyas, Director,

NID

14. Mr Rajen Jaswa, CEO, Dyyno

Selectica, USA

15. Dr V G Patel, Chairman CERC,

Founder Director of EDI

16. Dr. Nagesh Rao, President &

Director, MICA

17. Dr Sunil Shukla, Director EDI

25. Seminars/ Conferences/Workshops organized & the source of funding a) National

1. National seminar on entrepreneurship conducted in 2014. The seminar was funded

by Lok Jagruti Kendra, AICTE and GUJCOST.

26. Student profile programme/course wise:

Name of the

Course/programme

(refer question no. 4)

Applications

received

Selected Enrolled

Pass

percentage *M *F

MBA 323 248 158 90 RESULT

AWAITED

MAM 62 48 29 19 RESULT

AWAITED

*M = Male *F = Female

27. Diversity of Students

Name of the

Course

% of

students

from the

same state

% of students

from other

States

% of

students

from

abroad

Page 195: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

MBA 95 5 Nil

MAM 98 2 Nil

28. How many students have cleared national and state competitive examinations such as NET, SLET,

GATE, Civil services, Defense services, etc.?

22%

29. Student progression

Student progression

Against % enrolled

UG to PG NA

PG to M.Phil. 0

PG to Ph.D. 1

Ph.D. to Post-Doctoral 0

Employed

• Campus selection

• Other than campus recruitment

90

80

10

Entrepreneurship/Self-employment 10

30. Details of Infrastructural facilities

a) Library

The institute has a rich library containing over 20000 books, 35 magazines 69 journals and

659 CDs & DVDs. All these resources are effectively used by the faculties as well as students

for the teaching and learning process. The Library is maintained in a regular and prompt

manner. The Librarian guides the students to the relevant sections where books of different

subjects are kept. The College has formed a Library Development committee comprising

faculty members who regularly keep the library updated with the necessary resources. The

Committee actively monitors provision of services at the Library and enrichment of resources

by acquisition of new titles and subscription of required journals.

Total area of library ( in Sq. Mts. ) : 200 sq meters

Total seating capacity: 100

Working hours:

On working days: 8 AM to 9 PM

Before Examination days: 8 AM to 9 PM

During examination days: 9 AM to 8.30 PM

During vacation: 9 AM to 2 PM

On holidays: Generally remains closed

Page 196: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Layout: The library has comfortable seating arrangements for students and faculty with separate

space being provided for internet browsing, accessing e-resources and catalogue search.

b) Internet facilities for Staff & Students

Dedicated computers are made available to every faculty with internet connection on the

campus.

For students there are six computer labs with internet facility.

c) Class rooms with ICT facility

All classrooms have computers with internet connection and projectors for use by faculty

members and students helping in better student faculty interaction and knowledge

exchange. High end LCD projectors are installed with the computer systems in the classes

to give enhanced learning experience to the students.

d) Laboratories

The institution provides dedicated computer systems with latest configuration and un-

interrupted internet access. One computer lab out of the five labs is dedicated to internet access

by students to enumerate research activities involving computer systems. In order to make the

environment more conducive, Wi-Fi connectivity is provided. The students get access to

computing and internet facility through a computer lab which houses many computers.

31. Number of students receiving financial assistance from college, university,

government or other agencies

The following table provides details of the number students enrolled in different categories that

receive scholarship either from State government, Central government or other national agencies.

Eligibility of students for scholarship is evaluated after the application. Only the deserving

students from economically weaker backgrounds are awarded scholarship. The administrative

assistance required to complete the procedure is provided by the institute.

YEAR CATEGORY % OF STUDENTS

RECEIVING

SCHOLARSHIP

2012-13 SC

ST

SEBC

MINORITY (JAIN AND

MUSLIM)

11

NIL

12

1

2013-14 SC

ST

SEBC

12

NIL

20

Page 197: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

MINORITY (JAIN AND

MUSLIM)

5

2014-15 SC

ST

SEBC

MINORITY (JAIN AND

MUSLIM)

12

1

17

10

32. Details on student enrichment programmes (special lectures / workshops /

seminar) with external experts

In order to provide an exposure of practical knowledge to the students, experts in different fields

are invited to the institute to share their experiences and views in respective areas. Faculty

members regularly attend and present research papers on varied subjects in seminars/conferences

at state, national and international level. The details of such activities and programmes conducted

at the institute are as follows:-

Marketing Excellence Series (MAX) The Institute wanted to promote marketing skills at work place among students, and as a part of

that initiative, the institute created MAX, under which, the institute planned a series of

interactions with successful marketing professionals from the industry and academia, sharing

their experiences of marketing successes and failures. The speakers shared their experiences in

the following areas: New Launches, Product and Brand Management, Marketing strategies and

programmes, IMC strategies, Branding Strategies,Sales and Distribution Management,

Positioning Strategies, CRM Strategies and Marketing Research.

Finance Excellence Series (FINEX) LJMBA conceived the idea of organizing FINEX series in order to bridge the gap between the

academic learning through pre designed course curriculum and corporate expectations which

arises due to time and resources constraints. In order to strengthen the domain knowledge of

finance and to expose the students to practices in the arena of financial markets and services,

LJMBA has initiated an innovative programme the “Finance Excellence Series” (FINEX).

Human Resource Management Excellence Series (HRX)

In order to give an experiential learning to the management students about common HR practices

as well as a proper knowhow on how the corporate world functions, LJMBA came up with the

idea of HRX in which various dignitaries holding a strong position in the HR department from

various companies are invited to share their experiences and knowledge with our students.

Capability Recognition and Development Lessons for Entrepreneurship (CRADLE)

It is an initiative where the participant learns about entrepreneurship from successful

industrialists. Its broad objectives are to recognize the entrepreneurship capabilities of students

and create opportunities for development of entrepreneurship skills besides building long-term

mutually beneficial relationships with the SMEs and provide opportunities for experiential

learning to students.

Seminars The institute understands the needs for advanced learning not only for students to shape them as

better professionals, but also for faculty members to make them well equipped with the latest

Page 198: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

developments and knowledge in the field of management. As a result, the institute focuses on

organising such seminars that not only add value, but also necessary skills among students and

faculties for their growth.

The Institute conducted a National seminar on Entrepreneurship which was sponsored by All

India Council of Technical Education (AICTE), Gujarat Council for Science and Technology

(GUJCOST) and Department of Science and Technology (DST). The seminar consisted of

interesting themes like New Age Entrepreneurship, Successful Models in Entrepreneurship, Role

of Incubators in promoting Entrepreneurship, Role of Government Institutions in promoting

Entrepreneurship, Role of Academic Institutions in promoting entrepreneurship and Role of

Media in promoting Entrepreneurship. Experts from different institutions and streams had come

to share their views with the participants.

33. Teaching methods adopted to improve student learning

With the motive of making learning more student centric, the institute provides various hardware

& software resources to cater to various needs of students and faculties as well as a good

infrastructure that acts as a platform for interactive, collaborative and independent learning.

Besides the basic methods of class room teaching like delivering lectures, power point

presentations, case studies, group discussions and role plays, other interesting methods like live

projects for students and activities that give real time practical exposure to students are being

regularly conducted at the institute. This enables students to develop the interactive and

collaborative learning related skills. Students are also constantly motivated to read current articles

from various magazines/journals available in the rich college library as well as from other sources

and then make presentation in the class room. This caters to the independent learning skills.

34. Participation in Institutional Social Responsibility (ISR) and Extension activities

The institution understands its responsibility towards the society and in order to fulfill that it has

designed several extension activities with an objective to reach out to the community. The

Institute has created a platform through which it can inculcate a citizenship role in its students and

enable their overall development. For the holistic development of students, the institute

encourages students and teachers to participate in community welfare activities. Students are

guided to contribute to exhibit good citizenship behaviour, develop service orientation and

thereby enable overall development. The institute runs a programme, ‘Parivartan’ in which students under the guidance of a faculty member, teach the kids of the nearby locality and the

slum dwellings. In addition they also make visits to the Orphanage, Old Age home, Remand

Home Blind People’s Association, contributing to their welfare through services and sometimes financially also. They also participate in Blood Donation Camps organized every year. The

details of these activities are as under.

Parivartan

LJ Institute of Management Studies have started an initiative, ‘Parivartan’, for bringing about change in the lives of people of the disadvantaged sections living in its neighbouring areas.

Parivartan’s focus is to provide literacy and also generate awareness about various social, environmental, health and hygiene as well as political issues faced by them. Under this initiative,

25 children have been imparted basic education. The students of the institute even volunteer to

collect donation of stationary items, books, toys and clothes and distribute them among these

children.

Page 199: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Blood Donation Camp– As a mark of celebrating humanity, LJ Institute of Management Studies,

frequently organizes Blood Donation Camp with hand in hand with Prathama Blood Centre&

Red cross society, Ahmedabad . Seven such camps have been organized in which a total 502 units

of blood was donated. Both faculty and students have participated in large numbers in these

camps and supported the event.

Training Programmes –The institute collaborated with the Gujarat Chamber of Commerce and

Industries and the Ahmedabad Traffic Police for conducting a 10-day management training

programme for over 1500 personnel of the Ahmedabad Traffic Police in 2013 providing its

infrastructure facilities and expertise free of cost.

Plantation Drive –The students of the institute have conducted a plantation drive on 11-02-2010,

which was celebrated as ‘Go Green Day’ to increase the green cover in and around the campus

and make it more eco –friendly.

35. SWOC analysis of the department and Future plans

The SWOC analysis of the department is discussed as under

Management:

Strengths

Excellent infrastructure

Well qualified and experienced faculty members

Rich library and well equipped computer laboratories

2500 plus alumni base

Rigorous academic process that focuses on conceptual learning and skill development

Weakness

No control over quality of student intake as the admission process is controlled by ACPC (A

Committee of Professional Courses)

No autonomy of deciding syllabus as it is controlled by the affiliating University

Opportunity

To tie up with corporate and develop industry ready management graduates.

Establish international footprints by tie up with top foreign universities.

Challenges

Bridging the gap between management education and the ever changing and dynamic requirement

of the corporate world.

Page 200: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

3. Evaluative Report of the Departments

1. Name of the department:Master in Computer Applications (MCA)

2. Year of Establishment:2007

3. Names of Programmes / Courses offered (UG, PG, M.Phil., Ph.D., Integrated

Masters; Integrated Ph.D.,etc.)

PG: Master in Computer Applications (MCA)

4. Names of Interdisciplinary courses and the departments/unitsinvolved

NIL

5. Annual/ semester/choice based credit system (programme wise)

MCA course is based on semestersystem.

6. Participation of the department in the courses offered by otherdepartments

Faculty members from each department are invited to other departments for guest sessions

and faculty development programs.

7. Courses in collaboration with other universities, industries, foreign institutions, etc.:

NIL

8. Details of courses/programmes discontinued (if any) with reasons:

NIL

Page 201: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

9. Number of Teachingposts

Sanctioned

Filled

Professors 0 0

Associate Professors 2 2

Asst. Professors 3 3

10. Facultyprofilewithname,qualification,designation,specialization,(D.Sc./D.Litt.

/Ph.D. / M. Phil. etc.,)

Name

Qualification

Designation

Specialization

No. of Years

of

Experience

No. of Ph.D.

Students

guided for the

last 4 years

Dr. Bhavin Shah PhD, MCA Associate

Professor

Computer

application 12+

NIL (Recently

Completed PhD)

Dr. JigneshDoshi PhD, MCA Associate

Professor

Computer

application 23+

NIL (Recently

Completed PhD)

Monica Darji MCA, PhD

Pursing

Assistant

Professor

Computer

application 8

N.A.

Meetu Joshi PhD pursuing,

MCA

Assistant

Professor

Computer

application 7

N.A.

Sheenu Singh MCA Assistant

Professor

Computer

application 6

N.A.

11. List of senior visiting faculty

Page 202: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Prof. DiptiChudgar

Prof. AlokManke

Prof. Tejash Mehta

12. Percentage of lectures delivered and practical classes handled(programme wise) by

temporaryfaculty

All sessions are conducted by full time faculty only.

13. Student -Teacher Ratio (programme wise)

MCA1:15

14. Numberofacademicsupportstaff(technical)andadministrativestaff;sanctionedand filled

Technical support staff : 1

Administrative staff: 14

15. Number of teaching faculty with DSc/ D.Litt/ Ph.D/ MPhil / PG.

PhD:2

PG (MCA): 3

16. Numberoffacultywithongoingprojectsfroma)Nationalb)Internationalfunding agencies

and grantsreceived

NIL

17. Departmental projects funded by DST - FIST; UGC, DBT, ICSSR, etc. and total grants

received

NIL

18. Research Centre /facility recognized by the University

NIL

19. Publications: ∗ Publication per faculty Average6 publications/facultymember ∗ Number of paperspublished in peer reviewed journals (national/

international) by faculty andstudents

Over 30 papers

∗Number of publications listed in International Database (For Eg: Web

ofScience, Scopus,HumanitiesInternational Complete, Dare Database - International Social Sciences Directory, EBSCO host, etc.)

IEEE Xplore Digital Library : 11

Pro Quest : 1

DBLP: 4

Google Scholar: 27

Page 203: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

∗ Monographs ∗ Chapter in Books

Chapter in Books Authored by MCA Faculty

Sr.

No.

Name of

faculty Book Published Total

Name of Books with ISBN/ ISSN

numbers

Chapter Name in Book

1 Dr.

JigneshDoshi

Fundamentals of Computers

IISBN#9789381265567

Introduction to HTML,

Web Page Development

Using HTML

2

Programming in C – I

IISBN#9789381265567

Control Statements,

Functions

BooksEdited

Books Edited By MCA Faculty

Sr.

No.

Name of

faculty Book Published Total

Name of Book Chapter Name in Book

NIL

Books with ISBN/ ISSN numbers with details ofpublishers

Books Authored and Published by MCA Faculty

Sr.

No.

Name of

faculty

Book Published

Total

Page 204: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

`

Name of Book Publication

NIL

CitationIndex

Over 37citations have been observed through Google scholar for research papers by the

institute faculty members.

SNIP

SJR

Impactfactor

H-index

Sr. No. Name of faculty H-Index

1 Dr. Bhavin Shah 3

2 Dr. JigneshDoshi 1

20. Areas of consultancy and incomegenerated

NIL

21. Faculty as membersin

a) National committees b) International Committees c)EditorialBoards…. Dr. Bhavin Shah

1. Senior Member of IACSIT (International Association of Computer Science &

Information Technology), Singapore.

2. Member of CTES (Computer Theory and Engineering Society)

, Singapore.

3. Editor of International Journal IJCTE (International Journal of Computer Theory and

Engineering), (Bimonthly) ,ISSN Print : 1793-8201 ISSN Online: 1793-821X.

4. Editor of International Journal IJET (International Journal of Engineering and

Technology), (Bimonthly) ISSN Print : 1793-8236 ISSN Online: 1793-8244.

5. Editor of International Journal IJCEE (International Journal of Computer and

Electrical Engineering),(Bimonthly) ISSN Print : 1793-8163, ISSN Online: 1793-

8198.

6. Program Committee Chair of ICCEA 2010 (2nd International Conference on

Computer Engineering and Applications), Bali Island, Indonesia 26th-29th March,

2010.

7. Program Committee Member of ICKD 2010 (2nd International Conference on

Knowledge Discovery), Indonesia, March 26-29, 2010.

8. Program Committee Member of ICIII 2011 (International Conference on Industrial

and Intelligent Information), April 1-3, 2011, Bali Island, Indonesia Indonesia,

March 26-29, 2010.

9. Program Committee Member of FCCE 2009 (International Conference on Future

Computer and Communication Engineering), Chengdu, China, November 6-8, 2009.

10. Program Committee Member of ICTTA 2010 (2nd

International Conference on

Telecom Technology and Applications) ,Bali Island, Indonesia, March 26-29, 2010.

Page 205: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

11. Chaired a Session of Database & Data Mining Track of the ICDEM-2008

(International Conference on Data Engineering and Management), organized by

Bishop Heber College, Tiruchirappalli.

22. Studentprojects

a) Percentage of students who have done in-house projects including

interdepartmental/programme

NIL

b) Percentage of students placed for projects in organizations outside the institution

i.e.in Research laboratories/Industry/ other agencies

100%

23. Awards / Recognitions received by faculty andstudents

Dr. Bhavin Shah

1. Patent Filed at India Patent Office. Application Number : 1794/MUM/2015.

Patent is in “Awaiting for Examination” stage.

2. 18 Research papers presented or published.

3. One of paper has 21 citations count.

4. H-Index=3

5. Machine Learning course completed from Stanford University (via coursera)

with 100% marks.

6. Excellent Reviewer award by IJCEE, international journal.

7. Outstanding Reviewer award by IJCEE, international journal for the 2010-11.

8. 2nd

Rank in CCNSP exam conducted by Elite Core Technologies, Ahmedabad.

9. Best Patent Award : Awarded “Best Patent Award” at patent presentation event,

organized by GTU.

10. Best Paper Award in IEEE conference ACCT-2015.

11. Best Paper Award in IEEE conference ICRDPET-2013.

12. Senior Member of IACSIT (International Association of Computer Science &

Information Technology), Singapore.

13. Member of CTES (Computer Theory and Engineering Society)

, Singapore.

14. Editor of International Journal IJCTE (International Journal of Computer Theory

and Engineering), (Bimonthly) ,ISSN Print : 1793-8201 ISSN Online: 1793-

821X.

15. Editor of International Journal IJET (International Journal of Engineering and

Technology), (Bimonthly) ISSN Print : 1793-8236 ISSN Online: 1793-8244.

16. Editor of International Journal IJCEE (International Journal of Computer and

Electrical Engineering),(Bimonthly) ISSN Print : 1793-8163, ISSN Online:

1793-8198.

17. Program Committee Chair of ICCEA 2010 (2nd International Conference on

Computer Engineering and Applications), Bali Island, Indonesia 26th-29th

March, 2010.

Page 206: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

18. Program Committee Member of ICKD 2010 (2nd International Conference on

Knowledge Discovery), Indonesia, March 26-29, 2010.

19. Program Committee Member of ICIII 2011 (International Conference on

Industrial and Intelligent Information), April 1-3, 2011, Bali Island, Indonesia

Indonesia, March 26-29, 2010.

20. Program Committee Member of FCCE 2009 (International Conference on Future

Computer and Communication Engineering), Chengdu, China, November 6-8,

2009.

21. Program Committee Member of ICTTA 2010 (2nd

International Conference on

Telecom Technology and Applications) ,Bali Island, Indonesia, March 26-29,

2010.

22. Chaired a Session of Database & Data Mining Track of the ICDEM-2008

(International Conference on Data Engineering and Management), organized by

Bishop Heber College, Tiruchirappalli.

24. List of eminent academicians and scientists / visitors to the department

Sr. No. Expert

1 Lord Meghnad Desai,

Professor Emeritus,

London School of Economics

2 DrGautamAppa,

Professor Emeritus,

London School of Economics

3 Mr. Hemal Patel,

CEO,

Elite Core Technologies, Ahmedabad. 4 Mr. Varun Parikh,

Trainer,

Elite Core. 5 Mr. Ashikali M Hasan,

CEO,

CELNET. 6 Mr. Prajose John,

Head, Training Department,

EInfochips Ltd, Ahmedabad

7 Mr. SandeepVasant,

Assistant Professsor,

8 Mr. S.Jagadish

COO,

BSP Information Technology,

Technology, Alterian New Horizon Muscat, and many more…..

9 Mr. Prabhjot Singh Bakshi

Director,

BSP Information Technology,

Corporate Trainer of : Microsoft, Intel ,IBM, Accenture, Infosys, Wipro,

Cap Gemini, ICICI, and many more …

Page 207: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

10 Mr.Sanket Shah

Director,

Fresh Breeze Software Consultancy Service.

Ranked in top 1000 Coders | MCA |PGDBA 11 DilipAngom

Physical Research Laboratory, Ahmedabad

12 Mr.Abhijit

Director,

Dzireworx

13 Mr. Pravin Jain

Director - Technical

Zen Softech Private Limited

25. Seminars/ Conferences/Workshops organized & the source of funding

1. Faculty Development Progamme on Data Mining

(AICTE Sponsored)

Abstract Data mining is also termed as knowledge discovery. Data mining is the garnering

of useful patterns and terms from data sources, such as texts, databases, and the

internet. Data mining is very important as various fields like science, business and

other areas deal with a humungous amount of data. As these data needs to be

converted into meaningful content; and that's where data mining come into the

picture. Many organizations all over have recognized the importance of data

mining and have been using it to add a splurge to their income. This staff

development program (SDP) was aimed to enhance the knowledge and capability

of faculty and staff participants.

Topics Data Mining

Knowledge Pattern

Data Mining Technique & Algorithm

Web Mining

Text Mining

Time series Data Mining

Application & Trends in Data Mining

Page 208: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Recent Trends in Research Direction

Number of

Participants

35 Participants from all over the Gujarat

Speaker 10 Experts from industry, research organization and academic institutes.

2. Faculty Interaction Programme : Einfochip

Aim To bridge the GAP between industry and academic.

Number of

Participants

15+

Specially Design for MCA Faculty Members

Industry

Expert

Mr. Prajose John,

Head, Training Department,

EInfochips Ltd, Ahmedabad

3. Faculty Interaction Programme : Elitecore, MCA

Aim To bridge the GAP between industry and academic.

Number of

Participants

15+

Specially organized for LJIET Faculty

Speaker Mr. Hemal Patel,

CEO, Elite Core Technologies, Ahmedabad.

4. Faculty Interaction Programme : Elitecore, LJIET

Aim To bridge the GAP between industry and academic.

Number of

Participants

40+

Specially organized for LJIET Faculty

Speaker Mr. Hemal Patel,

CEO, Elite Core Technologies, Ahmedabad.

5. Industrial Training

Aim To learn the current practice in the field of Computer Networks

Number of

Participants

4

Speaker Mr. Varun Parikh,

Page 209: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Trainer,

CEO, Elite Core.

26. Student profile programme/course wise:

Name of the

Course/programme

(refer question no. 4)

Applications

received

Selected Enrolled

Pass

percentage *M *F

MCA 7 7 4 3 RESULT

AWAITED

*M = Male *F = Female

27. Diversity ofStudents

Name of the

Course

% of

students

from the

samestate

% of

studentsfrom

other States

% of

studentsf

rom

abroad

MCA 98 2 Nil

28. HowmanystudentshaveclearednationalandstatecompetitiveexaminationssuchasNET, SLET,

GATE, Civil services, Defense services,etc.?

NIL

29. Studentprogression

Page 210: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Student progression Against % enrolled

UG to PG NA

PG to M.Phil. 0

PG to Ph.D. 0

Ph.D. to Post-Doctoral 0

Employed

• Campusselection

• Other than campus recruitment

178

148

Entrepreneurship/Self-employment 120

30. Details of Infrastructural facilities

a) Library

The institute has a rich library containing over 20000 books, 35 magazines 69 journals and

659 CDs & DVDs for MBA and MCA students. Apart from this, for MCA students, the

institute also have 600 titles with 2500 volumes, 4000 books. All these resources of MCA

and MBA are effectively used by the faculties as well as students for the teaching and

learning process. The Library is maintained in a regular and prompt manner. The Librarian

guides the students to the relevant sections where books of different subjects are kept. The

College has formed a Library Development committee comprising faculty members who

regularly keep the library updated with the necessary resources. The Committee actively

monitors provision of services at the Library and enrichment of resources by acquisition of

new titles and subscription of required journals.

Total area of library ( in Sq. Mts. ) : 200 Sq. Mts.

Total seating capacity:100

Workinghours:

Onworkingdays: 8 AM to 9PM

Before Examination days: 8 AM to 9PM

During examination days: 9 AM to 8.30PM

During vacation: 9 AM to 2PM

On holidays: Generally remainsclosed

Layout: The library has comfortable seating arrangements for students and faculty with separate

Page 211: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

space being provided for internet browsing, accessing e-resources and catalogue search.

b) Internet facilities for Staff &Students

Dedicated computers are made available to every faculty with internet connection on the

campus.

For students there are six computer labs with internet facility.

c) Class rooms with ICTfacility

All classrooms have computers with internet connection and projectors for use by

faculty members and students helping in better student faculty interaction and

knowledge exchange. High end LCD projectors are installed with the computer systems

in the classes to give enhanced learning experience to the students.

d) Laboratories

The institution provides dedicated computer systems with latest configuration and un-

interrupted internet access. One computer lab is dedicated to internet access by students to

enumerate research activities involving computer systems. In order to make the environment

more conducive, Wi-Fi connectivity is provided. The students get access to computing and

internet facility through a computer lab which houses manycomputers.

31. Number of students receiving financial assistance from college, university, government or

otheragencies

The following table provides details of the number students enrolled in different categories that

receive scholarship either from State government, Central government or other national

agencies. Eligibility of students for scholarship is evaluated after the application. Only the

deserving students from economically weaker backgrounds are awarded scholarship. The

administrative assistance required to complete the procedure is provided by the institute.

YEAR CATEGORY % OF STUDENTS RECEIVING

SCHOLARSHIP

SC 12

2012- ST

NIL

13 SEBC

MINORITY(JAINAND

MUSLIM

NIL

2013-

14 SC 5

ST NIL

SEBC 1

Page 212: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

MINORITY

MUSLIM

(JAIN AND 1

SC

10

2014- ST NIL

15 SEBC 5

MINORITY

MUSLIM

(JAIN AND 1

32. Details on student enrichment programmes (special lectures / workshops /

seminar) with externalexperts

1. Workshop on PHP

Topics Apache Web Server : Installation of WampSever, Configuration and

Deployment

PHP: Open Source Introduction,Need of Open Source, Designing using

DreamWeaver, Introduction to PHP, Programming using PHP, OOP

using PHP, Sending Emails Using PHP, Creating PDF File using PHP

MySql: Overview of MySql, Database connectivity from PHP Script

Case Study: PHP application Development using Industry Standards

Hands On: Mini Project Work

Number of Participants 230+ Participants from all over the Gujarat

Speaker Mr. SandeepVasant,

Assistant Professor,

Ahmedabad University.

2. Workshop on Android

Topics Android Framework

Dalvik Virtual Machine

Building Applications in Android using

Activities and Intents

Database

Content Providers

Services

Accessing Native Code (C or C++) from Java Application

Number of Participants 170+ Participants from all over the Gujarat

Page 213: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Speaker Mr. Prajose John,

Head, Training Department,

EInfochips Ltd, Ahmedabad

3. Seminar on Ethical Hacking

Topics What is Hacking, What is Ethical Hacking, Types of Hacking, Various tools of

hacking, How to secure your computers.

Number of Participants 150+

Specially Organized only for the L J Trust Students

Speaker Mr. Ashikali M Hasan,

CEO of CELNET.

4. Workshop on IPhone & Windows Phone 7

Topics Apple I phone and I pad

Introduction to Xcode

Creating a Simple iOS App in Xcode

Understanding Interface Builder

Storyboard

Animation

Compiling iOS Apps

Various controls in iOS

Running iOS Apps on the Simulator

Running iOS Apps on iOS Devices

Developing a Game in Iphone

Windows Phone 7

Understanding Windows Phone 7

Different Types of Application (xna or Silverlight)

Silverlight for Windows Mobile

Windows Phone Animation

Data Visualization

Storing and Synchronizing Data

Navigation

Debugging Tools

Deployment

Live Demos and Lab sessions for Hands on Experience

Page 214: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Number of Participants 150+

From all over the Gujarat.

Speaker Mr. S.Jagadish

COO, BSP Information Technology,

Corporate Trainer of : Accenture, HCL, Nokia, Ceridian-Mauritius, Tops

Technology, Alterian New Horizon Muscat, and many more…..

5. Lecture on “Best Coding Techniques”

Topics Improving Methods Execution

Hidden Constructors / Destructors Cost

Optimizing memory and execution in Statements Declaration

Optimizing Stream Character Output

Using bit-shifts for faster operations

Removing unnecessary calculations within loops

Rewriting mathematical expressions for performance

Passing objects by Parameters

Initialization vs Assignment

Return Value Optimization

Managing Local Variables

Prefer int over char and short

When to use if..else and when to use switch…case

Case values and order in switch…case

Optimizing Loops

Number of Participants 200+

Specially Organized for the MCA Students.

Speaker Mr.Sanket Shah

Director, Fresh Breeze Software Consultancy Service.

Ranked in top 1000 Coders | MCA |PGDBA

MCTS - .NET 2.0 Windows Applications

MCTS - .NET 2.0 Web Applications

BrainBench C# Certified

Google Apps .NET Developer and Integrator AutoTask API Implementer

PIDX Implementer

Page 215: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

6. Workshop on Exploring Mobile Technologies

Topics Why and what are smart phones?

The Technologies, Architecture used by mobile phones.

What is Android, its development platform, developing applications,

shortcomings ,App hubs.

What is Iphone its development platform, developing applications ,short

comings, App hubs.

What is Windows Phone 7 its development platform, developing applications

,short comings, App hubs,

Live Game Development.

A brief intro on Windows 8.

Future Growth of the Mobile Technology

Number of Participants 150+

Students from all over the Gujarat has participated.

Speaker Mr. Prabhjot Singh Bakshi

Director, BSP Information Technology,

Corporate Trainer of : Microsoft, Intel ,IBM , Accenture, Infosys, Wipro,

Seimens, HCL, L&T, Patni, Polaris, ONGC,BPCL,HPCL, 3i Infotech, Cap

Gemini, ICICI, and many more …

Mr. S.Jagadish

COO, BSP Information Technology,

Corporate Trainer of : Accenture, HCL, Nokia, Ceridian-Mauritius, Tops

Technology, Alterian New Horizon Muscat, and many more…..

7. Expert Lecture: Power of Alignment

Abstract The presentation was about understanding the real meaning of the corporate

elements like Vision, Mission, Strategy, Goal, Metrics, Culture, Structure and

much more. If they are aligned together then how powerful it becomes to

make a successful corporation. Presentation covered deeply in to the role of

right strategy and culture in various types of businesses.

Number of Participants 200+ LJMBA Students

Specially Organized for LJ MBA Students

Speaker Mr. Hemal Patel,

CEO, Elite Core Technologies, Ahmedabad.

Page 216: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

8. Expert Lecture on How to be Successful

Topics Reasons of Failure

How to overcome from the failure

How to avoid failure

Things to do for becoming successful

Case study

Number of Participants 330+

Specially Organized for LJ Engineering Students

Speaker Mr. Hemal Patel,

CEO, Elite Core Technologies, Ahmedabad.

9. Industry Visit : DivyaBhaskar Press

Objective To understand how the computes are used in the new paper industry.

Number of Participants 15 Students + 2 Faculty members

10. Industry Visit : Amul

Objective To understand how the computes are used in Amul.

Number of Participants 15 Students + 2 Faculty members

11. Industry Visit : ONGC

Objective To understand how the computes are used in ONGC

Number of Participants 15 Students + 2 Faculty members

12. Industry Visit : Vibrant Gujarat

Objective To elaborate the development in the area of the science, technology,

infrastructure, urban & rural sectors.

Number of Participants 35 Students & 5 faculty members

33. Teaching methods adopted to improve studentlearning

With the motive of making learning more students centric, the institute provides various

hardware & software resources to cater to various needs of students and faculties as well as a

good infrastructure that acts as a platform for interactive, collaborative and independent

learning.

Page 217: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Besides the basic methods of class room teaching like delivering lectures, power point

presentations, case studies, group discussions and role plays, other interesting methods like live

projects for students and activities that give real time practical exposure to students are being

regularly conducted at the institute. This enables students to develop the interactive and

collaborative learning related skills. Students are also constantly motivated to read current

articles from various magazines/journals available in the rich college library as well as from

other sources and then make presentation in the class room. This caters to the independent

learningskills.

For the improvements in the results, the department had implemented the On- Demand

Examination.

On-Demand Examination

Preamble:

As a part of MCA initiative to improve quality of continual learning and measurement of

student performance, series of On-Demand Examinations are conducted. The successive

sessions were focusing on discussing model answers of university question papers along with

teaching. The students were given liberty to choose the subject for appearing in examination

during the specified duration. The evaluated answer books along with local and global

comments for improvement were handed over to students within two days of conduct of

examination.

Implementation mechanism:

An on-demand examination system (ODE) has been implemented by the Institute in MCA

course that allow the students to appear for examination of various subjects on a date of their

preference within a stipulated duration. Three to four ODEs are conducted every semester.

Each ODE is conducted for two weeks and a gap of one week is maintained between two

consecutive ODEs. A committee comprising of faculty members has been formed in order to

coordinate various activities of on-demand examination. Faculty members and student

volunteers have designed and developed a software application for automating various tasks

related to on-demand examination.

Faculty members submit syllabus of their respective subjects a couple of weeks prior to the

scheduled duration of the each examination. Subject faculty members announce the syllabus

in the class and the ODE committee displays the same on the notice board. Students register

themselves along with their preferred dates for appearing in examination of each subject

using the software. The faculty members send six question paper sets to the ODE committee

at least one week prior to the scheduled examination period. Each question paper is of twenty

eight marks with time duration of fifty five minutes.

The examinations are conducted from 8:55 am to 9:50 am on the scheduled dates. After the

examinations, the ODE committee allocates the answer sheets to faculty members of

respective subjects for evaluation. The faculty members evaluate the answer sheets and return

them along with the mark sheets to administrative office within two working days of

allocation. At the end of each semester, the faculty members receive a remuneration of Rs.

2.5 from the Institute for evaluating each paper.

Page 218: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

The marks are entered into the ODE software by the administrative staff and evaluated

answer sheets are returned to the students. In case of any discrepancy in the evaluated answer

sheets, the students contact the ODE committee, and the committee get those answer sheets

reevaluated by subject faculty members. Mark sheets are displayed on the notice board after

one week of completion of each examination.

34. Participation in Institutional Social Responsibility (ISR) and Extensionactivities

The institution understands its responsibility towards the society and in order to fulfill that it has

designed several extension activities with an objective to reach out to the community. The

Institute has created a platform through which it can inculcate a citizenship role in its students

and enable their overall development. For the holistic development of students, the institute

encourages students and teachers to participate in community welfare activities. Students are

guided to contribute to exhibit good citizenshipbehavior, develop service orientation and

thereby enable overall

development.Theinstituterunsaprogramme,‘Parivartan’inwhichstudentsunderthe guidance of a

faculty member, teach the kids of the nearby locality and the slum dwellings. In addition they

also make visits to the Orphanage, Old Age home, Remand Home Blind People’s Association, contributing to their welfare through services and sometimes financially also. They also

participate in Blood Donation Camps organized every year. The details of these activities are as

under.

Parivartan

LJ Institute of Management Studies have started an initiative, ‘Parivartan’, for bringing about change in the lives of people of the disadvantaged sections living in its neighbouring areas.

Parivartan’s focus is to provide literacy and also generate awareness about various social, environmental, health and hygiene as well as political issues faced by them. Under this

initiative, 25 children have been imparted basic education. The students of the institute even

volunteer to collect donation of stationary items, books, toys and clothes and distribute them

among these children.

Blood Donation Camp– As a mark of celebrating humanity, LJ Institute of Management

Studies, frequently organizes Blood Donation Camp with hand in hand with Prathama Blood

Centre& Red cross society, Ahmedabad . Seven such camps have been organized in which a

total 502 units of blood was donated. Both faculty and students have participated in large

numbers in these camps and supported the event.

Training Programmes –The institute collaborated with the Gujarat Chamber of Commerce

and Industries and the Ahmedabad Traffic Police for conducting a 10-day management training

programme for over 1500 personnel of the Ahmedabad Traffic Police in 2013 providing its

infrastructure facilities and expertise free of cost.

Plantation Drive –The students of the institute have conducted a plantation drive on 11- 02-

2010, which was celebrated as ‘Go Green Day’ to increase the green cover in and around the campus and make it more eco –friendly.

35. SWOC analysis of the department and Futureplans

The SWOC analysis of the department is discussed as under

Page 219: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

Management:

Strengths

Excellentinfrastructure

Well qualified and experienced facultymembers

Rich library and well equipped computerlaboratories

500 plus alumnibase

Rigorous academic process that focuses on conceptual learning and skilldevelopment

Weakness

No control over quality of student intake as the admission process is controlled byACPC (A

Committee of ProfessionalCourses)

No autonomy of deciding syllabus as it is controlled by the affiliatingUniversity

Opportunity

To tie up with corporate and develop industry ready computer technocrats.

Establish international footprints by tie up with top foreignuniversities.

Challenges

Bridging the gap between technical education and the ever changing anddynamic

requirement of the corporateworld.

Future Plans:

The Institute has several future plans to make student learning process more rigorous and skill based

which are mentioned below

To develop industry ready computer technocrats through constant and dynamic interaction

withindustries.

To develop the spirit of entrepreneurship among students by training and mentoringthem

through the Institute’s business incubator. To set a corporate training and consultation cell to provide training and consultancy to the

corporateworld.

To set up an independent unit for regular conduct of faculty development programs, seminars

andconferences.

To constitute a “Best SME Award” wherein an award shall be given by the Institute to the best

small and medium enterprise on the basis of certain predeterminedparameters.

To development extension with the corporate world by arranging faculty sessions on

industrypremises.

To develop a center for Academic and Applied Research in order to promote research activities

amongst the students andacademia.

To develop innovative and rigorous teaching and evaluation processes to enhance learning and

skills amongst students.

To tie up with foreign universities for student and faculty exchange in order to generate

opportunities for better learning and exposure through the Institute’s center for

Page 220: NAAC – Self Study Report (SSR)

internationalaffairs.

To create centers for skill development in order to inculcate various skills (Analysis Skills,

Design Skills, Coding Skills, Testing Skills, Communication Skills etc) necessary to be a good

computer professional.